Metodos Generales de Analisi Fao Jecfa
Metodos Generales de Analisi Fao Jecfa
Metodos Generales de Analisi Fao Jecfa
The Joint FAO/WHO Expert Committee on Food Additives (JECFA) was established pursuant to the recommendations of the first Joint FAO/WHO Conference on Food Additives in 1955 (Joint FAO/WHO Conference on Food Additives, Report. FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 11; WHO Technical Report Series, No. 107, 1956.). The terms of reference of this Committee are to deal with, and to advise the two Organizations on, the technical and administrative aspects of problems of food additives, and specifically: 1. to formulate general principles governing the use of food additives, with special reference to their legal authorization, based on appropriate consideration of their harmlessness, standards of purity, limits of tolerance, and the social, economic, psychological, and technological reasons of their use; and taking into account the work already done in this field by national and international bodies; 2. to recommend, as far as practicable, suitable uniform methods for the physical, chemical, biochemical, pharmacological, toxicological, and biological examination of food additives and of any breakdown products formed from them during processing, for the pathological examination of experimental animals, and for the assessment and interpretation of the results. A second Joint FAO/WHO Conference on Food Additives was held in 1963 (Second Joint FAO/WHO Conference on Food Additives, report. FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 34; WHO Technical Report Series, No. 264, 1963.) and a third Conference in 1973 (Third Joint FAO/WHO Conference on Food Additives and Contaminants Report. Misc. Meeting Reports Series - ESN:MMS 74/6; WHO/Food Add./74.43, 1974.). The Conferences have set or ratified policy guidelines and direction for the work of the Expert Committee. Sessions of JECFA have been held annually since 1956. General principles for evaluation of food additives as to their safety-in-use have been laid down and continually modified or updated by the Committee in the light of advances in knowledge concerning the nature and effects of food additives. Detailed information on the identity and purity of food additives are a prerequisite for evaluation. This need is met by the specifications regularly established by JECFA according to the guidelines laid down in its Reports (see particularly Annex 4 of the 10th Report and Section 2.3, page 8 of the 23rd Report), and updated continually. The specifications are developed mainly for the use of toxicologists and others concerned with the safety and quality of food additives, and to prescribe an adequate degree of purity. The substance of the annual sessions of JECFA has been recorded in 84 publications, mainly Reports containing its deliberations and recommendations, Toxicological Monographs, and Specifications of Identity and Purity. A list of these publications may be found in Annex 2. It is emphasized that specifications must be read in conjunction with the relevant evaluation of JECFA for each substance, as reflected in the Reports. These Reports may indicate inter alia the acceptable daily intake (ADI) of the substance and any special considerations or limitations in regard to safety or use. With reference to specifications, the Report may indicate why these are published bearing the designation ("tentative"). In many instances such a designation is applied because the toxicological evaluation has led to decisions either of "temporary ADI" (usually where information is adequate for a decision valid for a few years until the required further information is provided) or of "No ADI" (usually where information is inadequate). In
other instances specifications are designated ("tentative") for lack of adequate technical data on the substance, such as complete composition, manufacturing materials or process, levels of contaminants, or lack of suitable methods to characterize adequately the purity of the substance or its identity. At its Twenty-third Session (1979) the Committee had, however, decided to use the qualifier "tentative" only in those instances where information on identity, purity, technology of products and residue levels would be insufficient. Such technical deficiencies may at times be indicated in the published specifications only, and not reflected in the Report. Published specifications of JECFA refer to General Methods, Test Solutions and other general reference material contained in its earlier publications. There was a need to collect and complete all such general reference material pertaining to the proper reading, interpretation and use of specifications, to bring it up to date, and to present it in a single volume for ease of reference. A guide, Food and Nutrition Paper No. 5, design to fill the need expressed in the previous paragraph was published in 1978. The publication was revised and up-dated for the first time in 1983. The present publication presents the second revision. The items have been re-grouped, hopefully in a more concise manner, out-dated information has been deleted and some newer techniques, e.g. Headspace Gas Chromatography, have been added. Comments and information bearing on the contents should be sent to: Chief Food Quality and Standards Service Food Policy and Nutrition Division FAO, 00100 Rome, Italy.
ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS
FAO is grateful to Mrs. Harriet Wallin and her colleagues at the Food Research Laboratory of the Technical Research Centre of Finland, Espoo, Finland, who prepared this present revision. FAO also appreciates the final editing and review of the draft manuscript by Dr. Juhani Paakkenan of the Bureau for Food Affairs, Ministry of Trade and Industry, Finland.
SPECIAL NOTE
The methods and analytical procedures described in this Manual are designed to be carried out by properly trained personnel in a suitably equipped laboratory. In common with many laboratory procedures, the methods quoted frequently involve hazardous materials. For the correct and safe execution of these methods it is essential that laboratory personnel follow standard safety procedures for the handling of hazardous materials.
While the greatest care has been exercised in the preparation of this information, FAO expressly disclaims any liability to users of these procedures for consequential damages of any kind arising out of or connected with their use. The methods are also not to be regarded as official because of their inclusion in this Manual. They are simply methods which have been found by experience to be usable in the average laboratory.
GENERAL NOTICES o Function of General Notices o Component Parts of Individual Specifications 1. Substances other than enzyme preparations 2. Enzyme preparations o General Comments and Definition of Terms Applying to Tests and Assays o The units and their abbreviations commonly used are as follows: o Other abbreviations commonly used in this publication
GENERAL NOTICES APPLYING TO THE STANDARDS, TESTS, AND ASSAYS OF THE SPECIFICATIONS PREPARED BY THE JOINT FAO/WHO EXPERT COMMITTEE ON FOOD ADDITIVES
Function of General Notices
These General Notices provide in summary form a commentary on how the specifications of the Joint FAO/WHO Expert Committe on Food Additives (JECFA) are to be interpreted. Where, occasionally, exceptions to the General Notices are necessary, the language in the individual specification or General Methods Chapter takes precedence and specifically indicates the directions or intent. Otherwise, the General Notices apply.
TITLE
The title selected for individual specifications is the name of the additive or group of additives which, in the view of JECFA, most appropriately identifies the substance or
substances defined by the specifications. The name used for the title is not necessarily the chemical name of the additive, nor the name used by the International Union of Pure and Applied Chemistry (IUPAC). Furthermore, the titles of the specifications in this document may differ from the titles used in the toxicological monograph, which sometimes apply to large groups of additives (e.g. acetates, phosphates) for which specifications are established separately.
SYNONYM(S)
Listed in this section are names, acronyms, and abbreviations under which the additive is widely known, other than those used for the Title or Chemical name (see below). The International Numbering System (INS) number which was adopted by the Codex Alimentarius Commission, the European Economic Community (EEC) number and the FD and C number are also listed here where applicable. Common or trivial names may be included. However, registered trade names will not be a title or a synonym.
DEFINITION
This section defines the additive, and for this purpose the Chemical name, Chemical formula, Structural formula, Molecular or Formula weight and Assay are usually given and sometimes, where appropriate, items such as, C.A.S. number, Class name and/or Colour Index (C.I.) number for colour are also given. For some substances, such as those of natural origin or those with mixed components, detailed descriptions, necessary to define the additives, are given.
Chemical name
Where an IUPAC (IUPAC, Nomenclature of Inorganic Chemistry (Recommendations 1990), 1990, Blackwell Scientific Publications.) (IUPAC, Nomenclature of Organic Chemistry (Sections A, B, C, D, E, F, and H, 1979 Edition), 1979, Pergamon Press.) or IUB(IUB, Biochemical Nomenclature and Related documents, 1978, The Biochemical Society.) (the International Union of Biochemistry) name exists for an additive (whether systematic name or recommended common name), it is listed first among the chemical names. Other chemical names may also be provided.
ASSAY
A quantitative assay requirement is provided where applicable to indicate the minimum acceptable content, or acceptable range, of the chemical component(s) of an additive. When an upper limit is not given, the assay should show the equivalent of not more than 100.5%. Sometimes the minimum acceptable content or the range of the constituent relating to the content of the component of the additive is given.
DESCRIPTION
Information pertaining to physical appearance and other properties such as stability, odour, taste and special caution in usage and/or storage is provided in this section. Such information should not be interpreted as rigidly as measurable characteristics and does not constitute standards or tests of identity or purity.
FUNCTIONAL USE(S)
Functional uses are provided in each monograph to indicate the principal and secondary recognized technological application(s) of the additive in foods or in food processing. The statement, however, is not intended to indicate that the additive has no other utility than the functional use(s) listed. (In this connection it should be noted that vitamins, minerals, nutrients, and dietary supplements are considered by JECFA to be foods rather than food additives.)
CHARACTERISTICS
Identification Test
These tests are provided only as an aid to substantiate identification. Regardless of their specificity, the tests are not necessarily sufficient to establish proof of identity. However, failure of a substance to meet the requirements of the prescribed identification tests is an indication that the substance may be mislabelled and that it will not meet the overall specifications of the monograph.
Purity Tests
Tests for trace impurities as well as for other parameters, such as physical properties, are based on current knowledge of the manufacturing process at the time the specifications are prepared. Limits for such constituents are provided at levels that are consistent with current good manufacturing practice and are deemed to be safe and otherwise unobjectionable under conditions in which the additive is customarily employed (including recognition of the Acceptable Daily Intake established for the additive by JECFA).
TESTS
Methods and conditions of Identification Tests and Purity Tests other than those appearing in General Methods are generally presented in this subsection. However, in cases where these narrations can be given in brief, they may be presented at the section of Characteristics.
METHOD OF ASSAY
Assay methods such as principle, apparatus, reagents, procedure and calculation are provided at the end of each specifications or referred to General Methods where available.
2. Enzyme preparations
Enzyme preparations used in food processing whether from animal, vegetable or microbial sources have to meet the general specification, "General Specifications for Enzyme Preparations used in Food Processing" which consists of the following sections: Definition, Active components, Source materials, Carriers and other Additives and Ingredients, Hygiene and contaminants (Part V of this volume). In addition, enzyme preparations have to meet individual specifications which generally consist of the following sections discussed below in the order in which they occur in the specifications.
TITLE
The name of the active principle(s) which most accurately characterizes the preparation defined by the specification is selected. The name used for the title is not necessarily the systematic name recommended by the Nomenclature Committee of the IUB(IUB, Enzyme Nomenclature (Recommendations 1984), 1984, Academic Press.). Where appropriate, let the sources appear as a component of the title.
SYNONYM(S)
Listed in this section are names and abbreviations under which the preparation is widely known, other than those used for the Title or Systematic Names (see below). The INS number is also listed where applicable.
SOURCE
Described in this section are animal tissues, plant material or microbial sources used. Species, strains or variants, strain numbers and plasmid numbers if from recognized culture collections/depositories (e.g. ATCC) where appropriate are also given here. In case where the source organism is derived from genetic manipulation, a description of the derivation should be given. This should include the identity of the host organism and characterization of all introduced DNA.
ACTIVE PRINCIPLE(S)
Listed in this section are principle enzyme activities demonstrated by the preparation. IUB's recommended names are generally listed first. Other names may also be provided.
REACTION CATALIZED
Listed in this section are the specific substrates acted upon, the reactions catalyzed and the products formed by the active principles.
DESCRIPTION
Information pertaining to physical appearance, solubility in water and in organic solvents and other properties such as manufacturing process, diluents, carriers, stabilizers, preservatives, immobilization agents is presented here.
FUNCTIONAL USES(S)
Listed in this section are principal and secondary technological applications of the enzyme preparation in food or in food processing.
GENERAL SPECIFICATION
A statement that all preparations have to conform to the "General Specifictions for Enzyme Preparation used in Food Processing" is noted here.
CHARACTERISTICS
Assay methods for enzyme activities are provided here as the identification test of the active principles. Where applicable assay methods can be referred to General Methods. Listed in this section also are tests for trace impurities resulting from, for example, leakage of carriers and immobilization agents other than those noted by the General Specifications.
Analytical Standards
Certain procedures (e.g. chromatographic and spectrophotometric instrumental analyses, and antibiotic and enzyme assays) require the use of analytical reference standards. Where suitable standards are available from recognized international bodies, these are specified. In the absence of international standards, it has been necessary in some cases to specify the use of reference standards available from such organizations as the British Pharmacopoeia (BP), Food Chemical Codex (FCC), National Formulary (NF) of the United States, or the United States Pharmacopeia (USP). The addresses of these organizations may be found in the individual monograph.
Apparatus
With the exception of volumetric flasks and other exact measuring or weighing devices, directions to use a certain size or type of container or other laboratory apparatus are intended only as recommendations, unless otherwise specified. In certain unavoidable cases, the Committee has found it necessary, for accurate description, to use a proprietary name to indicate a certain type of instrument (e.g. spectrophotometer or chromatograph) that is known to give satisfactory results in a particular analytical procedure. Such listing in these specifications does not necessarily constitute endorsement of the specified instrument by the Committee, nor does it imply that similar instruments from other sources cannot be used with equal or better satisfaction, or thay they are of lesser quality or utility than the instrument named.
Blank Tests
The term "perform a blank determination", or other similar words, indicates that a reagent blank determination should be conducted, wherein the same quantities of the same reagents are used and the same procedure is repeated in every detail except that the substance being tested is omitted.
Constant Weight
A direction that a substance is to be "dried to constant weight" means that the drying should be continued until two consecutive weighings differ by not more than 0.5 mg per g of sample taken, the second weighing to follow an additional hour of drying time at the temperature specified. The direction to "ignite to constant weight" means that the ignition should be continued at a temperature of 450-550, unless otherwise specified, until two consecutive weighings do not differ by more than 0.5 mg per g of sample taken, the second weighing to follow an additional 30 min ignition period, depending upon the nature of the sample tested.
Indicators
The quantity of an indicator solution used should be 0.2 ml (approximately 3 drops), unless another quantity is specified.
Odourless
The term "odourless" applies to the examination, after exposure to air for 15 min, of between 1 and 25 g of the substance that has been transferred from the original container to an open evaporating dish of about 100 ml capacity.
Reagents
Reagents used in tests and assays should be of appropriate analytical grade and should contain no interfering impurities.
Significant Figures
Where tolerance limits are expressed numerically, the values are considered to be significant to the number of digits shown. Thus, "not less than 99.0%" means 99.0 but not 99.00. Values obtained in tests and assays should be rounded-off to the nearest indicated digit according to the commonly used practice of rejecting or increasing numbers less than or greater than 5. For example, a requirement of not less than 96.0% would be met by a result of 95.96% but not by a result of 95.94. When the digit to be dropped is exactly 5, the value should be rounded-off to the closest even digit. Thus, both 1.4755 and 1.4765 would be rounded-off to 1.476. When a range is stated, the upper and lower limits are inclusive, so that the range consists of the two values themselves, properly rounded-off, and all intermediate values between them.
Solubilities
Approximate solubilities, as specified in the Identification Tests in the Characteristics section of monographs, are to be interpreted according to the following general descriptive terms:
Parts of Solvent required for 1 part of Solute Less than 1 From 1 to 10 From 10 to 30 From 30 to 100
Practically insoluble or insoluble More than 10,000 Unless otherwise specified, the solubility test is to be conducted after transferring a sample into the specified solvent and shaking for no less than 30 sec and no more than 5 min.
Solutions
All solutions, unless otherwise specified, are to be prepared with distilled or deionized water. Directions for the preparations of "TS" (test solutions), "TSC" (colourimetric solutions) and "PbT" (lead free solutions) are provided in the chapters on General Methods. Where volumetric solutions of definite concentration are directed to be used in quantitative determinations, standardized solutions of other concentrations may be employed, unless otherwise specified, if allowance is made for the calculation factor and if the error of measurement is known not to be increased significantly thereby. Unless otherwise specified, it should be understood that concentrations of solutions prepared from liquids only are expressed in terms of volume in volume (v/v), and solutions of solids in liquids are expressed in terms of weight in volume (w/v). Thus, expressions such as "1 in 10" or "10%" mean that 1 part by volume of a liquid, or 1 part by weight of a solid, is to be dissolved in a volume of the diluent or solvent sufficient to make the finished solutions 10 parts by volume. For other types of solutions (e.g. gases in liquids), and where the above guidelines do not apply, the directions will specify the basis on which the concentration is determined (e.g. w/w, v/w).
Temperatures
Unless otherwise specified, temperatures are expressed in centigrade (Celsius) degrees, and all measurements are to be made at 20. Ordinary procedures not involving precise instrumental measurements may be conducted at room temperature (approximately 15-30) unless a particular temperature is specified in a test or assay.
Turbidity
The terms "clear", "almost clear", "very slightly turbid", and "turbid", as specified in Purity Tests for "Clarity and colour of solution", are defined in the individual monographs. The term "no turbidity is produced" means that the clarity of the solution does not change.
Vacuum
The unqualified use of the term "in vacuum" or "in vacuo" means a pressure at least as low as that obtainable by an efficient aspirating water pump (i.e. not higher than about 20 mm of mercury).
Water
See "Solutions".
Water-bath
The term "water-bath" means a bath of boiling water, unless water at some other temperature is indicated. An alternative form of heating may be employed, provided that the required temperature is approximately maintained and not exceeded.
A = micro amperes N = normality (gram equivalent per liter) M = molarity (mole per liter) cm-1 = wave number mmHg = mm of mercury, unit of pressure atm = one atmosphere (760 mm Hg) bar = unit of pressure (kgm-1 sec-2) psi = unit of pressure (pounds per square inch) Rf = ratio distance spot moved/distance solvent moved rpm = revolution per minute drop = approx. 0.05 ml meq = milli equivalent mV = millivolt
INS International Numbering System (for Food Additives) IP International Pharmacopoeia IR Infra Red ISO International Organization for Standardization IUB International Union of Biochemistry IUPAC International Union of Pure and Applied Chemistry LC Liquid Chromatography MW Molecular Weight NF National Formulary (USA) NMR Nuclear Magnetic Resonance o.d. Outer diameter Soln Solution sp.gr.Specific gravity TLC Thin-Layer Chromatography USP United States Pharmacopoeia UV Ultraviolet
surface area, while the other, the mobile phase or "eluant", is a fluid that moves constantly through, or over the surface of, the fixed phase. Chromatographic systems achieve their ability to separate mixtures of chemicals by selectively retarding the passage of some compounds through the stationary phase while permitting others to move more freely. Therefore, the chromatogram may be evaluated qualitatively by determining the Rf, or retardation factor, for each of the eluted substances. The Rf is a measure of that fraction of its total elution time that any compound spends in the mobile phase. Since this fraction is directly related to the fraction of the total amount of the solute that is in the mobile phase, the Rf can be expressed as Rf = VmCm/(VmCm + VsCs), where Vm and Vs are the volumes of the mobile and stationary phase, respectively, and Cm and Cs are the concentrations of the solute in either phase at any time. This can be simplified to Rf = Vm/(Vm + KVs), where K = Cs/Cm and is an equilibrium constant that indicates this differential affinity of the solute for the phases. Alternatively, a new constant k', the capacity factor, may be introduced, giving another form of the expression: Rf = 1/(1 + k'), where k' = KVs/Vm. The capacity factor, k', which is normally constant for small samples, is a parameter that expresses the ability of a particular chromatographic system to interact with a solute. The larger the k' value, the more the sample is retarded. Both the retardation factor and the capacity factor may be used for qualitative identification of a solute or for developing strategies for improving separation. In terms of parameters easily obtainable from the chromatogram, the Rf is defined as the ratio of the distance traveled by the solute band to the distance traveled by the mobile solvent in a particular time. The capacity factor, k', can be evaluated by the expression k' = (tr - to)/to, where tr, the retention time, is the elapsed time from the start of the chromatogram to the elution maximum of the solute, and to is the retention time of a solute that is not retained by the chromatographic system. Retardation of the solutes by the stationary phase may be achieved by one or a combination of mechanisms. Certain substances, such as alumina or silica gel, interact with the solutes primarily by adsorption, either physical adsoption, in which the binding forces are weak and easily reversible, or chemisorption, where strong bonding to the surface can occur. Another important mechanism of retardation is partition, which occurs when the solute dissolves in the stationary phase, usually a liquid coated as a thin layer on the surface of an inert particle or chemically bonded to it. If the liquid phase is a polar substance (e.g. polyethylene glycol) and the mobile phase is nonpolar, the process is termed normal-phase chromatography. When the stationary phase is nonpolar (e.g. octadecylsilane) and the mobile phase is polar, the process is reversephase chromatography. For the separation of mixtures of ionic species, insoluble polymers called ion exchangers are used as the stationary phase. Ions of the solutes contained in the mobile phase are adsorbed onto the surface of the ion exchanger
while at the same time displacing an electrically equivalent amount of less strongly bound ions in order to maintain the electroneutrality of both phases. The chromatographic separation of mixtures of large molecules such as proteins may be accomplished by a mechanism called exclusion, chromatography or gel chromatography. The stationary phases used are highly cross-linked polymers that have imbibed a sufficient amount of solvent to form a gel. The separation is based on the physical size of the solutes; those that are too large to fit within the interstices of the gel are eluted rapidly, while the smaller molecules follow an irregular path through the pores of the gel and are eluted later. In any chromatographic separation, more than one of the above mechanisms may be occurring simultaneously. Chromatographic separations may also be characterized according to the type of instrumentation or apparatus used. The types of chromatography that may be used are column, paper, thin-layer, gas and high-performance liquid chromatography.
COLUMN CHROMATOGRAPHY
Apparatus
The equipment needed for column chromatography is not elaborate, consisting only of cylindrical glass or Teflon tube that has a restricted outflow orifice. The dimensions of the tube are not critical and may vary from 10 to 40 mm in inside diameter and from 100 to 600 mm in length. for a given separation, greater efficiency may be obtained with a long narrow column, but the resultant flow rate will be lower. A fritted-glass disk may be seated in the end of the tube to act as a support for the packing material. The column is fitted at the end with a stopcock or other flow-restriction device in order to control the rate of delivery of the eluant.
Procedure
The stationary phase is introduced into the column either as a dry powder or as a slurry in the mobile phase. Since a homogeneous bed free of void spaces is necessary to achieve maximum separation efficiency, the packing material is introduced in small portions and allowed to settle before further additions are made. Settling may be accomplished by allowing the mobile phase to flow through the bed, by tapping or vibrating the column if a dry powder is used, or by compressing each added portion using a tamping rod. The rod can be a solid glass, plastic, or metal cylinder whose diameter is slightly smaller than the column, or it can be a thinner rod onto the end of which has been attached a disk of suitable diameter. Ion-exchange resins and exclusion polymers are never packed as dry powders since after introduction of the mobile phase they will swell and create sufficient pressure to shatter the column. When the packing has been completed, the sample is introduced onto the top of the column. If the sample is soluble, it is dissolved in a minimum amount of the mobile phase, pipetted onto the column and allowed to percolate into the top of the bed. If it is not soluble or if the volume of solution is too large, it may be mixed with a small amount of the column packing. This material is then transferred to the chromatographic tube to form the top of the bed. The chromatogram is then developed by adding the mobile phase to the column in small portions and allowing it to percolate through the packed bed either by gravity or under the influence of pressure or vacuum. Development of the chromatogram takes place by selective retardation of the components of the mixture as a result of their interaction with the stationary phase. In column chromatography, the stationary phase
may act by adsorption, partition, ion exchange, exclusion of the solutes, or a combination of these effects. When the development is complete, the components of the sample mixture may be detected and isolated by either of two procedures. The entire column may be extruded carefully from the tube, and if the compounds are coloured or fluorescent under ultraviolet light, the appropriate segments may be cut from the column using a razor blade. If the components are colourless, they may be visualized by painting or spraying a thin longitudinal section of the surface of the chromatogram with colour-developing reagents. The chemical may then be separated from the stationary phase by extraction with a strong solvent such as methanol and subsequently quantitated by suitable methods. In the second procedure, the mobile phase may be allowed to flow through the column until the components of the mixture successively appear in the effluent. This eluate may be collected in fractions and the mobile phase evaporated if desired. The chemicals present in each fraction may then be determined by suitale analytical techniques.
PAPER CHROMATOGRAPHY
In this type of chromatography, the stationary phase ordinarily consists of a sheet of paper of suitable texture and thickness. The paper used is made from highly purified cellulose, which has a great affinity for water and other polar solvents since it has many hydroxyl functional groups. The tightly bound water acts as the stationary phase, and therefore the mechanism that predominates is liquid-liquid or partition chromatography. Adsorption of solutes to the cellulose surface may also occur, but this is of lesser importance. Papers especially impregnated to permit ion-exchange or reverse-phase chromatography are also available.
Apparatus
The essential equipment for paper chromatography consists of the following: Vapour-tight chamber. The chamber is constructed preferably of glass, stainless steel, or porcelain. It is provided with inlets for the addition of solvent or for releasing internal pressure, and it is designed to permit observation of the progress of the chromatographic run without being opened. Tall glass cylinders are convenient if they are made vapour-tight with suitable covers and a sealing compound. Supporting rack. The rack serves as a support for the solvent troughs and antisiphoning rods. It is constructed of a corrosion-resistant material about 5 cm shorter than the inside height of the chamber. Solvent troughs. The troughs, made of glass, are designed to be longer than the width of the chromatographic sheets and to contain a volume of solvent greater than that required for one chromatographic run. Antisiphoning rods. Constructed of heavy glass, the rods are placed on the rack and arranged to run outside of, parallel to, and slightly above the edge of the glass trough. Chromatographic sheets. Special chromatographic filter paper is cut to length approximately equal to the height of the chamber. The sheet is at least 2.5 cm wide but
not wider than the length of the trough. A fine pencil line is drawn horizontally across the filter paper at a distance from one end such that when the sheet is suspended from the antisiphoning rods with the upper end of the paper resting in the trough and the lower portion hanging free into the chamber, the line is located a few cm below the rods. Care is necessary to avoid contaminating the paper by excessive handling or by contact with dirty surfaces.
inlet to the trough in excess of the quantity of solvent required for complete moistening of the chromatographic sheet. The chamber is resealed. When the solvent front has reached the desired height, the chamber is opened and the sheet is removed, the location of the solvent front is quickly marked, and the sheet is dried. Small cylinders may be used without troughs so that only the mobile phase is placed on the bottom. The chromatographic sheet is suspended during equilibration with the lower end just above the solvent, and chromatography is started by lowering the sheet so that it touches the solvent.
Identification of Solutes
Since the chromatographic mobilities of the solutes may change from run to run due to varying experimental conditions, presumptive identification of a substance should be based on comparison with a reference standard. The Rf values of the unknown substance and the standard on the same chromatogram must be identical. Alternatively, the ratio between the distances traveled by a given compound and a reference substance, the Rr value, must be 1.0. Identification may also be made by mixing a small amount of the reference substance with the unknown and chromatographing. The resulting chromatograph should contain only one spot. Definitve identification of solutes may be achieved by eluting them from the paper and subjecting them to IR, NMR, or mass spectrometry.
THIN-LAYER CHROMATOGRAPHY
In thin-layer chromatography (TLC), the stationary phase is a uniform layer of a finely divided powder that has been coated on the surface of a glass or plastic sheet and that is held in place by a binder. The capacity of the system is dependent on the thickness of the layer, which may range from 0.1 to 2.0 mm. The thinner layers are used primarily for analytical separations, while the thicker layers, because of their greater samplehandling ability, are useful for preparative work. Substances that are used as coatings in TLC include silica gel, alumina powdered glass, or cellulose. Separations occur due to adsorption of the solutes from the mobile phase onto the surface of the thin layer. However, adsorption of water from the air or solvent components from the mobile phase can give rise to partition or liquid-liquid chromatography. Specially coated plates are available that permit ion-exchange or reverse-phase separations.
Apparatus
Acceptable apparatus and materials for thin-layer chromatography consist of the following:
Glass plates. Flat glass plates of uniform thickness throughout their areas. The most common sizes are 20 x 20 cm and 5 x 20 cm. Aligning tray. An aligning tray or other suitable flat surface is used to align and hold plates during application of the adsorbent. Adsorbent. The adsorbent may consist of finely divided adsorbent materials for chromatography. It can be applied directly to the glass plate, or it can be bonded to the plate by means of plaster of Paris or with starch paste. Pretreated chromatographic plates are available commercially. Spreader. A suitable spreading device that when moved over the glass plate applies a uniform layer of adsorbent of desired thickness over the entire surface of the plate. Storage rack. A rack of convenient size to hold the prepared plates during drying and transportation. Developing chamber. A glass chamber that can accomodate one or more plates and can be properly closed and sealed as described under Paper Chromatography. It is fitted with a plate-support rack that can support the plates when the lid of the chamber is in place. An ultraviolet light source suitable for observations with short (254 nm) and long (360 nm) ultraviolet wavelengths may be required.
Procedure
Clean the plates scrupulously, as by immersion in a chromic acid cleansing mixture, and rinse them with copious quantities of water until the water runs off the plates without leaving any visible water or oily spots, and then dry. Arrange the plate or plates on the aligning tray, and secure them so that they will not slip during the application of the adsorbent. Mix an appropriate quantity of adsorbent and liquid, usually water, which when shaken for 30 sec gives a smooth slurry that will spread evenly with the aid of a spreader. Transfer the slurry to the spreader, and apply the coating at once before the binder begins to harden. Move the spreader smoothly over the plates from one end of the tray to the other. Remove the spreader, and wipe away excess slurry. Allow the plates to set for 10 min, and then place them in the storage rack and dry at 105 for 30 min or as directed in the monograph. Store the finished plates in a desiccator. Equilibrate the atmosphere in the chamber as described under procedure for Descending Chromatography in the section on Paper Chromatography. Apply the Sample Solution and the Standard Solution at points about 1.5 cm apart and about 2 cm from the lower edge of the plate (the lower edge is the first part over which the spreader moves in the application of the adsorbent layer), and allow to dry. A template will aid in determining the spot points and the 10 to 15 cm distance through which the solvent front should move. Arrange the plate on the supporting rack (sample spots on the bottom), and introduce the rack into the developing chamber. The solvent in the chamber must be deep enough to reach the lower edge of the adsorbent, but must not touch the spot points.
Seal the cover in place, and maintain the system until the solvent ascends to a point 10 to 15 cm above the initial spots, this usually requiring from 15 min to 1 h. Remove the plates, and dry them in air. Measure and record the distance of each spot from the point of origin. If so directed, spray the spots with the reagent specified, observe, and compare the sample with the standard chromatogram.
Quantitative Analysis
Two methods are available if quantitation of the solute is necessary. In the first, the bands are detected and their position marked. Those areas of adsorbent containing the compounds of interest are scraped from the surface of the plate into a centrifuge tube. The chemicals are extracted from the adsorbent with the aid of a suitable strong solvent, the suspension is centrifuged, and the supernatant layer is subjected to appropriate methods of quantitative analysis. The second method involves the use of a scanning densitometer. This is a spectrophotometric device that directs a beam of monochromatic radiation across the surface of the plate. After interaction with the solutes in the adsorbent layer, the radiation is detected as transmitted or reflected light and a recording of light intensity versus distance traveled is produced. The concentration of a particular species is proportional to the area under its peak and can be determined accurately by comparison with standards.
GAS CHROMATOGRAPHY
This type of chromatography differs from the others in that the mobile phase is a gas and therefore the solutes must be vaporized in order to allow movement through the column. The stationary phases that are used are solids (gas-solid chromatography, GSC) or liquids coated as a thin layer on an inert solid or on the walls of the column (gas-liquid chromatography, GLC). In gas-solid chromatography, the passage of a solute through the column will be retarded by adsorption or exclusion mechanisms. In gas-liquid chromatography, the solutes will partition between the gaseous mobile phase and the stationary liquid. In either case, if the rate of flow of the mobile phase is constant throughout the chromatogram, all solutes will spend the same time in the gas phase. Therefore, the efficiency of a separation depends on the time spent in the stationary phase, and those solutes that have a greater affinity for the stationary phase (larger K or k') will elute later in the chromatogram (lower Rf). The value of the k' and therefore the success of the separation depend on a number of parameters that are within the control of the analyst. These include (1) carrier gas flow rate, (2) column length and diameter, (3) particle size of the solid support or adsorbent, (4) the particular liquid phase used, (5)
the amount of liquid phase relative to the amount of solid support, and (6) the temperature.
Apparatus
The essential components of a basic gas chromatograph are a carrier gas supply, a sample injection port, a column, a detector, and a suitable data-recording device. The carrier gas supply system consists of a tank of highly compressed inert gas, a pressure regulator to reduce the pressure to operating levels, and a flow meter to permit reproducible flow rates to be achieved. Because of their inertness and availability, the gases most commonly used are helium or nitrogen. The regulated carrier gas then flows through an injection port into which the analytical samples are introduced. Since the solutes to be chromatographed must be vaporized, the injection port is heated to a temperature high enough to cause rapid vaporization but not thermal degradation. Samples are introduced into the gas stream through a silicone rubber septum with the aid of a microliter syringe. The samples may be injected into a mixing area within the injection port or, in certain instances, directly onto the head of the column. The vaporized sample is carried into the column, where it is separated into its various components. The column is contained in an oven that is usually maintained at a constant temperature suitable to the particular analysis. Where a mixture contains solutes of widely diverse volatility, a temperature-programming device may be used to vary the oven temperature during the run. When the solutes leave the end of the column in the effluent, they enter a detector that produces an electrical signal proportional to the mass or concentration of the solute in the eluate. In order to prevent condensation of the solutes, the detector is heated. The two types of detectors most commonly used are the thermal conductivity detector, which detects changes in the thermal conductivity of the gas stream as solutes are eluted, and the flame-ionization detector, in which the eluting solutes are burned in a hydrogen flame, producing a small electrical current. After amplification, the electrical signal is conducted to a suitable recording device, which produces the chromatogram as a detector response versus time plot. The chromatogram consists of a series of bell-shaped curves, each representing a particular solute. The areas under the curves are proportional to the concentrations of the solutes.
Columns
Gas chromatographic columns consist of tubes of stainless steel, aluminum, copper, tin, or glass filled with stationary phase. Glass, tin or Teflon-lined metal columns are used where degradation of sensitive compounds might occur on hot metal column walls. Columns of various dimensions may be used, but they range usually from 0.6 to 1.8 m in length and from 2 to 4 mm in inside diameter. Capillary columns, whose inside diameters may be 0.25 mm and whose lengths may be 50 m or more, are sometimes used for separations where very high efficiencies are required. Solid support materials must be as inert as possible in order to prevent interaction of the solutes with active surfaces, resulting in degradation, rearrangement, or loss of peak symmetry (tailing). The most commonly used supports are derived from silicates, usually diatomaceous earth. Before use they are acid-washed, calcined, and treated with a silanizing reagent to render surface hydroxyls inactive. They are available in various particle sizes from 30- to 120-mesh, with the 80- to 100-mesh and 100- to 120mesh fractions most often used. Porous polymeric materials, which may be coated if desired or used as supplied, are available for the separation of low-molecular-weight compounds.
Liquid phases for partition chromatography may be chosen from a large variety of compounds, ranging from the very polar polyethylene glycols to the nonpolar methyl silicone gums. The choice of a liquid phase for a particular separation is mainly empirical, but usually polar phases are used for the analysis of mixtures of polar compounds. Before use, a packed column should be conditioned in the chromatograph to reduce the level of extraneous detector signals produced by the bleeding of volatile substances from the support and the liquid phase. This can be accomplished by heating the column at a temperature slightly above its expected operating temperature while maintaining a low flow of carrier gas through it. During this process, the column should be disconnected from the detector to prevent its contamination.
Qualitative Analysis
Since it is impracticable in gas chromatography to measure the Rf, presumptive identification of a solute should be done by comparing its position on the chromatogram with that of a reference standard. The position of a solute is characterized by its retention time, the time from injection to the peak maximum; its retention volume, the product of retention time and carrier gas flow rate; or its retention distance, the distance from injection to the peak maximum. Since conditions may vary between determinations, it is more appropriate to identify a substance by its relative retention, a = (x2 - x0)/(x1 - x0), where x2 is the retention time, volume, or distance of the desired chemical, x1 is that of the reference compound, preferably determined on the same chromatogram, and x0 is the retention of an inert compound that is not retarded by the column. A method of definitive identification is to trap and condense the effluent for each peak and subject the condensate to analysis by IR, NMR, mass spectrometry, or other suitable methods. A measure of the efficiency of the separation of two adjacent peaks is given by the dimensionless constant R, the resolution factor, which can be calculated by the equation R = 2(t2 - t1)/(w1 - w2), where t2 and t1 are the retention times of the two peaks, and w1 and w2 are the baseline widths determined by the intersection of the tangents of the inflection points of the peaks with the baseline. A resolution of 1.0 corresponds to a peak overlap of approximately 2% and is usually considered to be adequate for analytical purposes. A measure of the efficiency of a column is the number, N, of theoretical plates it contains for a given compound: N = 16(tr/wb)2, where tr is the retention time of the peak, and wb is its width in units of time at the baseline.
Quantitative Analysis
In a gas chromatogram, the parameter that is proportional to the concentration of any solute is the area under its peak. The determination of exact areas requires the use of an automatic electronic integrator or computer. For economic reasons, manual methods, based on the approximately triangular shape of the peak, are used more frequently. The most common of these calculates the area as the product of the peak height times its width at half the height. For isothermal systems, where the experimental parameters can be rigorously controlled, peak heights may be substituted for areas. In order to convert the peak areas to the amount or percentage of the solute in the sample, three diferent methods may be used.
Area normalization
This method is based on the assumption that a peak is obtained on the chromatogram for each component of the mixture. The areas of all the peaks, each corrected by multiplying by its response factor, are added together to obtain the total area. Then the percentage of any component is equal to its corrected area divided by the total area and multiplied by 100. This method is reliable only if all components of the sample give a peak and if the various response factors are known.
External standard
A series of samples containing known amounts of the analyte are chromatographed under identical conditions. From the data obtained, a standard or working curve can be constructed by plotting area versus amount of standard. After chromatographing the unknown under the same conditions, the area is measured, and by interpolation using the standard curve the amount of the unknown in the sample can be determined. This method is highly reliable if the volume of sample injected is controlled precisely.
Internal standard
In order to correct for errors that might occur when injection volumes vary or the chromatographic conditions change slightly from run to run, the internal standard method may be used. In this method, another standard, which is chemically similar to the unknown component and which elutes separately from all other peaks, is added in a constant amount to all standard and test solutions of the analyte. After chromatographing, a calibration curve is constructed by plotting the area ratios of the standard solutions (area of analyte standard per area of internal standard) versus the weight or concentration ratios of each standard. The unknown is then chromatographed, its area ratio is determined, and the corresponding weight ratio is found by interpolation using the calibration curve. Since the amount of internal standard is constant and known, the concentration of the unknown component can be calculated.
HEADSPACE-GAS CHROMATOGRAPHY
Headspace-gas chromatography (headspace-GC) is an analytical technique in which the extraction of the sample into the gas phase and its GC analysis have been combined. The method can be applied to the analysis of compounds with a low boiling point, which therefore vapourize easily at low temperatures.
Both liquid and solid samples can be analyzed with head-space-GC technique. Liquid samples may be analyzed directly; solid samples are either dissolved in an appropriate solvent or pulverized and added to a headspace vial. After incubation at a specified temperature a gas sample from the head-space vial is injected into the gas chromatograph and a normal GC analysis performed. There are two different forms of headspace-GC: static and dynamic headspace-GC. In static headspace-GC the gaseous sample is taken from a sealed headspace vial and is injected into the gas chromatograph. In dynamic headspace-GC the gaseous sample is forced out of the headspace vial with the help of a gas flow from an external source, usually the same gas as that used as the carrier gas in the gas chromatograph.
Apparatus
The basic components of a liquid chromatograph are a solvent delivery system, a sample injection device, a column, a detector, and a suitable data-recording device. The solvent delivery system consists of one or more pumps capable of delivering a pulseless flow of mobile phase at pressures ranging from 6,81 to 340,23 atm. In the isocratic mode, where a mobile phase of constant composition is used throughout the run, a single pump and solvent reservoir are required. For the separation of mixtures where the k' values vary over a wide range, gradient-elution analysis may be used. In
this method, two pumps, each delivering a separate component of the mobile phase to a mixing chamber, are used. By varying the rate of delivery from each pump throughout the analysis, a solvent mixture of constantly changing composition will be delivered to the column. Injection of the sample into the chromatograph may be done by means of a syringe or by using a rotary valve injector. Syringe injection is done through a rubber septum as in gas chromatography or since diffusion of the sample in the mobile phase is negligible in HPLC, the flow may be stopped and a cap removed from the head of the column so that the sample may be directly deposited on the stationary phase. The cap is then replaced and the flow restarted. In the rotary valve injector, the sample is loaded into a calibrated loop of tubing by syringe or suction while the mobile phase is diverted so that it flows only through the column. When the injection valve is rotated, the mobile phase then flows through the calibrated tube and deposits the sample on the column. The columns usually used for analytical separations have internal diameters ranging from 2 to 4 mm and lengths from 25 to 100 cm. The longer, narrower columns (2.1 mm x 100 cm) are packed with pellicular stationary phase material that has particle sizes ranging from 37 to 50 m. Totally porous microparticulate packings, which are available in 5, 10, and 20 m sizes, are used in the shorter columns (4 mm x 25 cm). Satisfactory columns containing the larger particles (>30 m) can be obtained by dry packing, using vibration or tapping to settle the bed after each addition of stationary phase. However, due to the static charge on the smaller particles, which causes them to clump together, dry packing is not feasible. Instead columns are filled using the balanced density slurry technique, in which the stationary phase material is suspended in a solvent mixture that has the same density as the solid. The slurry is then forced into the column under pressure. Microparticulate packings can give efficiencies of up to 40,000 plates per m, while 500 to 1,000 plates per m can be expected from columns packed with pellicular phases. The types of detectors most frequently used in HPLC are spectrophotometric, fluorometric, and refractometric detectors. The spectrophotometric detectors are fixedor variable-wave-length photometers that operate in the ultraviolet and visible portions of the spectrum. The most commonly employed detectors of this type are those that use the mercury line at 254 nm as their source of radiation, since solutes containing benzenoid functions absorb strongly at this wavelength. In order to prevent remixing of separated solutes, the volume of the detector cell is very small, usually 8 l. Detectors of this type are sensitive to as little as 1 ng of a strong ultraviolet absorber. Fluorometric detectors are extremely sensitive to small quantities (< 1 ng) of naturally fluorescing compounds. They may also be used for the detection of nonfluorescent compounds after reaction with suitable fluorimetric reagents either prior to chromatography or after separation on the column. In the case of chemicals that neither absorb effectively in the ultraviolet or visible regions nor fluoresce, the differential refractometer may be used. This instrument, which detects differences between the refractive index of the pure mobile phase and of the mobile phase, containing the solutes, is less sensitive than the other detectors but responds to a wider range of chemicals. However, since refractive index varies significantly with temperature, drift is a problem and the detector must be thermostated. Moreover, it is not useful for gradient-elution chromatography.
The signals delivered by HPLC detectors to the data-recording devices produce a chromatogram that is a plot of detector response versus time or distance, as in gas chromatography. Therefore the methods used for identifying and quantitating the various solutes in the sample are the same as those discussed under Gas Chromatography.
Colorimetry
Has been commonly accepted as the measurement of "filtered" light in the visible region; however, it is more prudent to restrict its use to those applications where human perception of colour is involved, i.e., the visible region.
Fluorescence spectrophotometry
Or "fluorometry", is the measurement of light emitted from a chemical substance while it is being exposed to electromagnetic radiation. The maximum intensity of the emitted fluorescence is usually at a wavelength longer (i.e., of lower energy) than the exciting radiation.
measurement being made in the axis of the transmitted beam. Nephelometry involves the measurement of the light scattered by the suspended particles, the measurement being made at right angles to the incident beam.
Terminology
Radiant power, P
Is the energy of radiation per sec that reaches certain areas of a detector. Incident radiant power is usually given the symbol Po. Alternate terminology is radiation intensity with symbols I and Io.
Transmittance, T = (P/Po)
Is the quotient of the radiant power transmitted by a specimen divided by the incident power upon the specimen. Transmittance is often expressed as a percentage and is related to the absorbance by the equation Log10T = A, or A = 2 - Log10%T. Other terms are transmission and transmittancy.
Absorptivity, a = A/bc
Is the quotient of the absorbance, A, divided by the product of the absorption pathlength, b, in cm, and the concentration, c, of the specimen, expressed in g per 1,000 ml. In general, the absorptivity of a substance is a constant and is independent of the intensity of the incident radiation, pathlength, and concentration.
Molar absorptivity,
Is the quotient of the absorbance, A, divided by the product of the absorption pathlength, in cm, and the specimen concentration, expressed in moles per L. Former terms were molar absorbancy index, molar extinction coefficient and molar absorption coefficient.
Absorption spectrum
Is a graphic representation of the absorbance of a specimen or any of its functions, e.g., transmittance, as the ordinate and the wavelength of the incident radiation as the abscissa.
Fluorescence intensity, I
Is a descriptive term for the fluorescence activity of a substance and is commonly expressed in units related to the detector response. An alternate term is fluorescence power, with the symbol F.
Turbidance
Is the light-scattering effect of the suspended particles in a turbid medium.
Turbidity
Is a measure of the attenuation in the incident beam power per unit length of a turbid medium. The former term is turbidity coefficient.
medium and the concentration of the absorbing species encountered in that medium. This decrease in energy can be described quantitatively by the Beer-Lambert law: Log10(Po/P) = Log10(1/T) = A = abc. Therefore if the absorptivity and the cell thickness are kept constant during a specific determination, a plot of the absorbance as the ordinate versus concentration as the abscissa should yield a linear relationship. The practical application of the BeerLambert law, however, necessitates the use of a reference standard solution of known concentration in order to compare its absorbance with that of the sample solution of unknown concentration. If absorption measurements are conducted in two matching cells having the same pathlengths, the absorptivity, a, and the cell thickness, b, will be the same. Therefore the following general formula can be used for the calculation of the unknown concentration of the sample solution, Cu = Cs (Au/As), where Cu = the concentration of the sample solution Cs = the known concentration of the standard solution Au = the absorbance of the sample solution and As = the absorbance of the standard solution. The Beer-Lambert law is usually satisfactory, provided a thorough understanding of its limitations is taken into consideration. Some of these are of such a fundamental nature that they constitute a real limitation of the law; they are due to the fact that the law does not take into consideration the effects of temperature, wavelength, or solute-solvent and solute-solute interactions, e.g., association, dissociation, chemical reaction, etc. Due to these limitations, the law usually applies only to dilute solutions, where these interactions are insignificant. Another limitation to the Beer-Lambert law is due to the inability of most instruments to provide monochromatic radiation. Fluorescence can be observed in a number of gaseous, liquid, or solid substances. However, it is only applied analytically to a relatively small number of organic compounds. Fluorescence occurs when a molecule absorbs sufficient radiation at a certain wavelength to promote it to an excited singlet state with higher levels of energy. The gained energy is released as radiation or "fluorescence" of wavelengths longer than the incident radiation. In most cases, in order for fluorescence to occur the electronic transition involved is a pi pi* system. To a lesser extent, pi pi and pi sigma* transitions occur. There is a delay between the absorption and emission of radiation of about 10-9 sec. This short delay period distinguishes fluorescence from phosphorescence, which has a delay period of about 10-3 sec and is due to release of weaker radiations from an excited triplet state and not a singlet state as is true of fluorescence. The effect of concentration on the fluorescence intensity can be described by a slightly modified version of the Beer-Lambert law. A linear relationship exists between the fluorescence intensity, I, of the solution and the concentration of the emitting species: I = 2.3K x bcPo,
where K is a constant dependent upon the quantum efficiency of the fluorescence process and instrumental parameters. At constant Po, a simple relationship as in the Beer-Lambert law can be obtained: I = Kc. Thus a plot of the fluorescence intensity of a solution as the ordinate versus concentration of the emitting species as the abscissa should be linear at low concentrations. When light passes through a transparent medium containing a suspended particulate phase, scattering occurs in all directions, and as a result the beam loses power along its axis of travel. For dilute suspensions and under fixed conditions (particles, shape, size, refractive index, wavelength of radiation), the loss in radiation intensity can be related to the number of particles (or concentration, c) by an equation similar to the Beer-Lambert law. Log10(Po/P) = kbc, where tau = kc/2.303. Therefore, in turbidimetric analysis a plot is constructed with standard solutions with Log10(Po/P) as the ordinate and c as the abscissa (Po is determined by using the solvent as reference). In nephelometric analysis, the radiation intensity scattered at right angles to the incident beam is plotted as the ordinate versus concentration as the abscissa.
Apparatus
The fundamental principles of optics and electronics that are used in manufacturing spectrophotometers are common to all regions of the spectrum from the vacuum ultraviolet to the far-infrared. However, due to important differences in detail, spectrophotometers are commercially available for use in the visible; in the visible and ultraviolet; in the visible, ultraviolet, and near-infrared; and in the infrared regions of the spectrum. In selecting the type of spectrophotometer to be employed, several factors have to be considered, including the nature of the specimen to be analyzed, the degree of accuracy required, sensitivity, and selectivity. The essential parts of all spectrophotometers include a stable source of radiant energy; a device that permits the selection of a defined wavelength region such as a prism or grating monochromator: a slit for limiting the suitable bandwidth; a transparent container for sample and solvent; a radiation detector; and an indicator that may be a meter, a recorder, a digital counter, a printer, or a computer. Radiation sources commonly employed are hydrogen or deuterium lamps for the ultraviolet region, tungsten lamps for the visible, and a Nernst glower, a globar, or an incandescent wire for the infrared. Quartz or fused-silica cells or cuvettes can be used in the ultraviolet, visible, or near-infrared regions. For infrared spectrophotometry, cells or plates made of sodium chloride are usually used. The radiation detector of ultraviolet and visible radiation is usually a photomultiplier tube with associated amplifiers. Two types of spectrophotometers are available: a single-beam spectrophotometer, which adapts well to quantitative analysis that involves single-wavelength measurements, and a double-beam spectrophotometer, which is particularly useful for qualitative analysis and where continuous monitoring of absorbance is required. Some spectrophotometers are manually operated, while others are equipped for automatic and continuous recordings. Spectrophotometers employing the latest technology can be interfaced to a digital computer through an analog-digital converter for the direct determination of difference spectra of analytes as well as for the storage of reference spectra. Fourier transformed infrared spectrophotometry is different from the regular dispersion type in that it employs an interferometric technique, whereby polychromatic radiations pass through the specimen to a detector on an intensity and frequency
basis. In order to process such complicated spectral data, interfacing with a digital computer is a requirement. Instruments for atomic absorption measurements have the same basic components as other spectrophotometers except for the radiation source and the sample container. The most common radiation source is the hollow-cathode lamp, the cathode of which is usually made of the element to be analyzed. The sample is aspirated as a fine mist into a flame that is produced by an optimized mixture of air and acetylene or other suitable gases. The flame thus serves a function similar to that of the sample cell in ordinary absorption spectrophotometry. Photomultiplier tubes are used as detectors, with the electronics designed to accept the modulated radiation source output, thereby negating the continuous signal from the flame. Therefore only changes in the signal from the hollow-cathode lamp are monitored by the detector. These changes are proportional to the number of atoms in the analyte. Both single-and double-beam atomic absorption spectrophotometers are available. The apparatus for fluorescence intensity measurement is either a fluorometer, which employs filters to restrict the bandwidth of both the excitation and emission beams, or a spectrofluorometer, where prism or grating monochromators are used to limit either the excitation beam, the emission beam, or both. Since the spectrofluorometer requires a more intense radiation source than the spectrophotometers, either a mercury lamp with its strong discrete lines or a xenon lamp with its energy continuum from the ultraviolet to the infrared is used. Cells for fluorometric measurement are constructed of glass of silica, and the cell compartment is designed to allow a minimum of scattered light to reach the photomultiplier. To minimize scattering interferences, the detector is placed at right angles to the incident excitation beam. For turbidimetric measurements, a conventional photometer with a tungsten source is usually employed. However, it is preferable to make the measurements in the blue region of a mercury arc. For nephelometric measurements, standard fluorometers are commonly used.
Procedures
Instruction manuals supplied by manufacturers should always be consulted for such matters as care, calibration, handling techniques, and operating procedures. Calibration of both the wavelength and the photometric scales should be conducted at fixed intervals. For wavelength calibration in the ultraviolet and visible regions, a quartz-mercury arc and a holmium oxide glass filter are the most common standards employed. For the near-infrared and infrared regions, a polystyrene film may be used. The photometric scale can be checked by a number of standard inorganic glass filters or by standard solutions of known transmittance. In absorption spectrophotometry, comparisons of the sample and reference standard are best made at or within 1 nm of the wavelength at which maximum absorbance occurs. If matched cells are unavailable, both cells are filled with the selected solvent and any difference in absorbance should be corrected instrumentally or mathematically. The solvent should be transparent in the spectral range of interest. Water, lower alcohols, chloroform, aliphatic hydrocarbons, and many other organic solvents can be used as solvents for ultraviolet and visible measurements. For best results, the concentration of the sample solution should produce an absorbance in the range of about 0.2 to 0.7. For the infrared region, however, few solvents are suitable for sample preparation.
The solvent used in infrared spectrophotometry must not affect the material, usually sodium chloride, of which the cell is made. No solvent in appreciable thickness is completely transparent throughout the infrared spectrum. Carbon tetrachloride R is practically transparent (up to 1 mn in thickness) from 4,000 to 1,700 cm-1 (2.5 to 6 m). Chloroform R, dichloromethane R, and dibromomethane R are other useful solvents. Carbon disulfide IR (up to 1 mm in thickness) is suitable as a solvent to 250 cm-1 (40 m), except in the 2,400-2,000 cm-1 (4.2-5.0 m) and the 1,800-1,300 cm-1 (5.5-7.5 m) regions, where it has strong absorption. Its weak absorption in the 875-845 cm-1 (11,411,8 m) region should also be noted. Other solvents have relatively narrow regions of transparency (carbon disulfide, chloroform, and carbon tetrachloride are the most frequently used). In some cases, the sample can be dispersed in mineral oil to form a mull, which is transferred to the salt plates. In most cases, however, the sample is dispersed in dried potassium bromide and the mixture is compressed into a tablet or pellet. The proportion of substance to the halide should be about 1 to 200. The amount taken should be such that the weight of substance per area of the disc is about 5-15 g per mm2, varying with the molecular weight and to some degree with the type of apparatus used. However, the concentration of the substance should be such that the strongest peak attributable to the substance reaches to between 5% and 25% transmittance. Although the infrared region extends from 2 to 40 m, for purposes of ascertaining compliance with a reference spectrum, the range from 2.5 to 15 m (3,800 to 650 cm-1) is usually satisfactory. For atomic absorption measurements, the solvent should not seriously interfere with the absorption or emission processes or with the production of neutral atoms. Also, both the analyte solution and the standard solution should be as much alike as possible, especially with respect to concentration, viscosity, and surface tension. In fluorescence spectrophotometry, test solutions are usually very dilute (10-3 to 10-7M) in order to minimize the "inner filter" effect caused by significant absorption of incident radiation by the sample near the cell surface. Other undesirable effects of highly concentrated solutions in fluorometry are the "self-quenching" and "self-absorption" phenomena that cause significant deviation from linearity. Test solutions used in fluorometry should also be free from any dust and solid particles, as they cause interference in the measurement. In some cases, before any measurement it is advisable to remove dissolved oxygen from the test solutions, due to its quenching effect. Temperature control is usually needed for extremely sensitive determinations, and baseline correction may be critical. In turbidimetric and nephelometric measurements, it is important to minimize the settling of the suspended particles. This is generally achieved through the addition of protective colloids. When visual colour and turbidity comparisons are made, matched colour-comparison tubes that are of the same internal diameter must be used. The solutions to be compared should be at the same temperature (preferably room temperature). For colour comparisons, the tubes are usually held vertically and illuminated from below. Viewing is done from above along the axis of the tube, against a white background. If the colours to be compared are too dark to be viewed downward through the depth of the solutions, they may be viewed horizontally across the diameter of the tubes, with the aid of a light source directed from the back of the tubes. If two layers are present, the designated layer must be viewed horizontally across the diameter of the tube.
For visual turbidity comparisons, the tubes should be viewed horizontally across the diameter of the tubes, with the aid of a light source directed at a right angle against the sides of the tubes. When conducting limit tests involving the comparison of colour or turbidities, suitable detection instruments may be used in place of the unaided eye.
Applications
Ultraviolet and visible spectra provide only limited information about the chemical structure of a substance. However, because of the sensitivity of these techniques and the high degree of precision and accuracy in their measurements, they are employed extensively in assays and other quantitative determinations. Near-infrared and infrared spectra, on the other hand, are unique for a given chemical compound, except for optical isomers, which have identical spectra in solution. Polymorphism and other factors, such as variations in crystal size and orientation, the grinding procedure, and the possible formation of hydrates may, however, be responsible for a difference in the infrared spectrum of a given compound in the solid state. The infrared spectrum is usually not greatly affected by the presence of small quantities of impurities (up to several percent) in the tested substance. For identification purposes the spectrum may be compared with that of a reference substance, concomitantly prepared or with a standard reference spectrum. Specificity makes the infrared spectrum one of the most valuable tools for structure elucidation and positive identification of complex organic molecules. Correlation charts and reference spectra of thousands of chemicals are readily available. The sensitivity of infrared analysis, however, is poor (about 1/100 to 1/1,000 of ultraviolet), and therefore it has only a very limited application in quantitative analysis. Atomic absorption is the technique of choice for the quantitative determination of most of the common elements, even those in complex matrices. Although interferences may occur in the determination of some elements due to chemical interaction between different atoms in the flame (e.g., cation-anion interference), they can usually be circumvented by preliminary treatment (e.g., addition of a complexing agent) or by the optimization of the instrumentation parameters (e.g., increasing the temperature of the flame to decrease anion-cation attraction). Fluorescence spectrophotometry has the most inherent sensitivity of all the absorption and light-scattering techniques. Concentrations as low as 10-7M can be quantitatively determined with high precision and accuracy. Fluorescence, however, is not as widespread as the other techniques because of the limited number of organic compounds in which fluorescence can be induced. Light-scattering techniques, including turbidimetry and nephelometry, are very useful in the determination of weight-average molecular weights in dispersed colloidal systems. Several common ions can be determined using these techniques after their precipitation with suitable reagents. Generally, turbidimetry is adquate for the analysis of heavy suspensions where excessive scattering occurs. Nephelometry, on the other hand, is more suitable for the analysis of cloudy liquids where the attenuation of the radiant power is minimal.
I. METHODS FOR EVALUATING APPEARANCE AND PHYSICAL PROPERTIES o BOILING POINT AND DISTILLATION RANGE o COLOUR (Platinum-Cobalt Hazen Scale)
o o o o o o
MELTING RANGE pH DETERMINATION REFRACTIVE INDEX SOLIDIFICATON POINT SPECIFIC GRAVITY SPECIFIC ROTATION
Definitions
Distillation range
The difference between the temperature observed at the start of a distillation and that observed at which a specified volume has distilled, or at which the dry point is reached.
Dry point
The temperature indicated at the instant the last drop of liquid evaporates from the lowest point in the distillation flask, disregarding any liquid on the side of the flask.
Apparatus
Distillation flask
A 200-ml round-bottomed distillation flask of heat-resistant glass is preferred when sufficient sample (in excess of 100 ml) is available for the test. If a sample of less than 100 ml must be used, a smaller flask having the capacity of at least double the volume of the liquid taken may be employed. The 200-ml flask has a total length of 17.9 cm, and the inside diameter of the neck is 2.1 cm. Attached about midway in the neck, approximately 12 cm from the bottom of the flask, is a side arm 12.7 cm long and 5 mm in internal diameter, which is inclined downward at an angle of 75 from the vertical.
Condenser
Use a straight glass condenser of heat-resistant tubing, 56 to 60 cm long and equipped with a water jacket so that about 40 cm of the tubing is in contact with the cooling
medium. The lower end of the condenser may be bent to provide a delivery tube or it may be connected to a bent adapter which serves as the delivery tube. Note: All-glass apparatus with standard-taper ground joints may be used alternatively if the assembly employed provides results equal to those obtained with the flask and condenser described above.
Receiver
The receiver is a 100-ml cylinder which is graduated in 1-ml sub-divisions and calibrated "to contain". It is used for measuring the sample as well as for receiving the distillate.
Thermometer
An accurately standardized partial-immersion thermomether having the smallest practical sub-divisions (not greater than 0.2) is recommended in order to avoid the necessity for an emergent-stem correction. Suitable thermometers are available such as the ASTM Series 37C through 41C, and 102C through 107C, or as the MCA types R-1 through R-4, or equivalent.
Source of heat
A Bunsen burner is the preferred source of heat. An electric heater may be used, however, if it is shown to give results comparable to those obtained with the gas burner.
Shield
The entire burner and flask assembly should be protected from external air currents. Any efficient shield may be employed for this purpose.
Flask support
An asbestos board, 6.5 mm in thickness and having a 10 cm circular hole, is placed on a suitable ring or platform support and fitted loosely inside the shield to ensure that hot gases from the source of heat do not come in contact with the sides of neck of the flask. A second 6.5 mm asbestos board, at least 225 square cm and provided with a 30 mm circular hole, is placed on top of the first board. This board is used to hold the 200 ml distillation flask which should be fitted firmly on the board so that direct heat is applied to the flask only through the opening in the board.
Procedure
Note: This procedure is to be used for liquids which distil above 50 in which case the sample can be measured and received, and the condenser water used, at room temperature (20-30). For materials boiling below 50, cool the liquid to below 10 before sampling, receive the distillate in a water bath cooled to below 10 and use water cooled to below 10 in the condenser. Measure 100 0.5 ml of the liquid in the 100-ml graduated cylinder and transfer the sample together with an efficient antibumping device to the distilling flask. Do not use a
funnel in the transfer, or allow any of the sample to enter the side arm of the flask. Place the flask on the asbestos boards which are supported on a ring or platform, and place in position the shield for the flask and burner. Connect the flask and condenser, place the graduated cylinder under the outlet of the condenser tube and insert the thermometer. The thermometer should be located in the centre of the neck end so that the top of the bulb (when present, auxiliary bulb) is just below the bottom of the outlet to the side arm. Regulate the heating so that the first drop of liquid is collected within 5 to 10 min. Read the thermometer at the instant the first drop of distillate falls from the end of the condenser tube and record as the initial boiling point. Continue the distillation at the rate of 4 or 5 ml of distillate per min, noting the temperature as soon as the last drop of liquid evaporates from the bottom of the flask (dry point) or when the specified percentage has distilled over. Correct the observed temperature readings for any variation in the barometric pressure from the normal (760 mm) by allowing 0.1 for each 2.7 mm of variation, adding the correction if the pressure is lower, or substracting if higher than 760 mm. When a total immersion thermometer is used correct for the temperature of the emergent-stem by the formula 0.00015 x N(T - t), in which N represents the number of degrees of emergent-stem from the bottom of the stopper, T the observed temperature of distillation, and t the temperature registered by an auxiliary thermometer the bulb of which is placed midway of the emergent-stem, adding the correction to the observed readings of the main thermometer. Alternatively, the following simplified correction formula may be applied: t = to - k (760 - b) in which to = boiling point at 760 mm; b = observed pressure in mm of mercury; and k = correction factor for each 1-mm difference with normal pressure. The factor k depends on the substance under study; it is given in handbooks and varies between 0.033 and 0.057.
Colour comparator
A comparator constructed to permit visual comparison of light transmitted through tallform Nessler tubes in the direction of their longitudinal axes. The comparator should be constructed so that white light is passed through or reflected off a white glass plate and directed with equal intensity through the tubes from the side.
Reference Standards
Use Platinum-cobalt TSC to prepare colour standards in accordance with the table below, by diluting the required volumes to 100 ml with water in the Nessler tubes. Cap the tubes and seal the caps with a water proofing agent such as shellac or a waterproof cement.
Procedure
Introduce 100 ml of sample into a Nessler tube, passing the sample through a filter if it has any visible turbidity. Cap the tube, place in the comparator, and compare with standards.
Report
Report as the colour the No. of the standard that most nearly matches the sample. In the event that the colour lies midway between two standards, report the darker of the two. If, owing to differences in hue between the sample and the standards, a definite match cannot be obtained, report the range over which an apparent match is obtained and report the sample as "off-hue".
MELTING RANGE
Before determining the melting range of a substance, the sample should be dried under the conditions specified for Loss on Drying in the individual monograph. If a temperature is not specified in the monograph, the sample should be dried for 24 h in a desiccator. Transfer a quantity of the dried powder to a dry capillary-tube about 10 cm long and sealed at one end (thickness of the wall, 0.10-0.15 mm; internal diameter 0.9-1.1 mm) and pack the powder by tapping the tube on a hard surface so as to form a tightlypacked column 2-4 mm in height. Attach the capillary-tube and its contents to a standard thermometer so that the closed end is at the level of the middle of the bulb, and heat in a suitable apparatus containing an appropriate liquid (liquid paraffin or silicone oil) and fitted with a stirring device and an auxiliary thermometer. Regulate the rise in temperature during the first period to 3 per min. When the temperature has risen to 5 below the lowest figure of the range for the substance being tested, heat more slowly: if no other directions are given, the rate of rise in temperature should be 1-2 per min. Unless otherwise directed, read the temperature at which the substance is observed to form droplets against the side of the tube and the temperature at which it is completely melted, as indicated by the formation of a definitive meniscus. To the temperature readings, apply the emergent-stem correction determined as follows: Before starting the determination of the melting range, adjust the auxiliary thermometer so that the bulb touches the standard thermometer at a point midway between the graduation for the expected melting range and the surface of the heating material. When the substance has melted, read the temperature on the auxiliary thermometer. Calculate the correction to be added to the temperature reading of the standard thermometer from the following formula: 0.00015 N(T - t) where T is the temperature reading of the standard thermometer; t is the temperature reading of the auxiliary thermometer; N is the number of degrees of the scale of the standard thermometer between the surface of the heating material and the level of the mercury. The statement "melting range, ao-bo" means that the corrected temperature at which the material is observed to form droplets must be at least ao, and that the material must be completely melted at the corrected temperature bo.
Procedure
Use a suitable pH meter and follow the manufacturer's instructions. Each time the electrodes are used, rinse them with distilled or deionized water and carefully blot them dry with clean absorbent tissue. Form a fresh reference electrode liquid junction. Rinse the sample vessel three times with each new solution to be introduced.
Choose two standard buffers (For description of standard buffers, see the Merck Index, 11th ed. page MISC-113, 1989.) to bracket, if possible, the anticipated pH of the unknown. Warm or cool these standards as necessary to match within 2 the temperature of the unknown, and initially set the temperature compensator to that temperature. Immerse the electrodes in a portion of the first standard buffer, and following the manufacturer's instructions adjust the appropriate standardization control (knob, switch, or button) until the pH reading is that of the buffer. Repeat this procedure with fresh portions of the first standard buffer until two successive readings are within 0.02 pH unit without an adjustment of the standardization control. Rinse the electrodes, blot dry, and immerse them in a portion of the second standard buffer of lower pH. Do not change the setting of the standardization control. Following the manufacturer's instructions, adjust the slope control (thumbwheel switch, knob, or temperature compensator) until the exact buffer pH is displayed. Repeat the sequence of standardization with both buffers until the pH readings are within 0.02 pH unit for both buffers without any adjustment of either control (The amount of sample to be used in sample preparation is given where applicable in the individual specification.). The pH of the unknown solution may then be measured (The difference between the results of two pH determinations when carried out simultaneously on in rapid succession by the same analyst, under the same conditions, should not exceed 0.05 pH unit.). Always restandardize the instrument after even a short period during which the amplifier is turned off.
References
Food Chemicals Codex, Third Edition (1981), National Academy Press, 531-2. EC Directive 81/712/EEEC, July 1981.
REFRACTIVE INDEX
The refractive index of a transparent substance is the ratio of the velocity of light in air to its velocity in that material under like conditions. It is equal to the ratio of the sine of the angle of incidence made by a ray in air to the sine of the angle of refraction made by the ray in the material being tested. The refractive index values specified are for the D line of sodium (589 nm) unless otherwise specified. The determination should be made at the temperature specified in the individual monograph, or at 25 if no temperature is specified. This physical constant is used as a means for identification of, and detection of impurities in, volatile oils and other liquid substances. The Abb refractometer, or other refractometers of equal or greater accuracy, may be employed at the discretion of the operator.
Solidification point is an empirical constant defined as the temperature at which the liquid phase of a substance is in approximate equilibrium with a relatively small portion of the solid phase. It is measured by noting the maximum temperature reached during a controlled cooling cycle after the appearance of a solid phase. Solidification point is distinguished from freezing point in that the latter term applies to the temperature of equilibrium between the solid and liquid state of pure compounds. Some chemical compounds have two temperatures at which there may be a temperature equilibrium between solid and liquid state depending upon the crystal form of the solid that is present.
Apparatus
The apparatus is illustrated on the following page and consists of the components described in the following paragraphs.
Sample container
Use a standard glass 25 x 150 mm test-tube with lip, fitted with a cork stopper bored to hold the thermometer in place and to allow stirring with stirrer.
Thermometer
A thermomether having a range not exceeding 30 graduated in 0.1 divisions, and calibrated for 76 mm immersion, should be employed. A satisfactory series of thermometers, covering a range from -20 to +150 is available as ASTM-EI 89C through 96C. A thermometer should be so chosen that the solidification point is not obscured by the cork stopper of the sample container.
Stirrer
The stirrer consists of a 1 mm diameter (B & S gauge 18) corrosion-resistant wire bent in a series of 3 loops about 25 mm apart. It should be made so that it will move freely in the space between the thermometer and the inner wall of the sample container. The shaft of the stirrer should be of a convenient length designed to pass loosely through a hole in the cork holding the thermometer. Stirring may be hand-operated or mechanically activated at 20 to 30 strokes per min.
Air jacket
Use a standard glass 38 x 200 mm test-tube with lip, fitted with a cork stopper bored with a hole into which the sample container can easily be inserted up to the lip.
Cooling bath
Use a 2-L beaker or similar suitable container as a cooling bath. Fill it with an appropriate cooling medium such as glycerine, mineral oil, water, water and ice or alcohol-dry ice.
Assembly
Assemble the apparatus in such a way that the cooling bath can be heated or cooled to control the desired temperature ranges. Clamp the air jacket so that it is held rigidly just below the lip and immerse it in the cooling bath to a depth of 160 mm.
Preparation of Sample
The solidification point is usually determined on chemicals as they are received. Some may be hygroscopic, however, and require special drying. Where this is necessary it will be noted in the monograph. Products which are normally solid at room temperature must be carefuly melted at a temperature about 10 above the expected solidification point. Care should be observed to avoid heating in such a way as to decompose or distil any portion of the sample.
Procedure
Adjust the temperature of the cooling bath to about 5 below the expected solidification point. Fit the thermometer and stirrer with a cork stopper so that the thermometer is centred and the bulb is about 20 mm from the bottom of the sample container. Transfer a sufficient amount of the sample, previously melted if necessary, into the sample container to fill it to a depth of about 90 mm when in molten state. Place the thermometer and stirrer in the sample container and adjust the thermometer so that the immersion line will be at the surface of the liquid and the end of the bulb 20 4 mm from the bottom of the sample container. When the temperature of the sample is about 5 above the expected solidification point, place the assembled sample tube in the air jacket. Allow the sample to cool while stirring at the rate of 20 to 30 strokes per min, in such a manner that the stirrer does not touch the thermometer. Stir the sample continuously during the remainder of the test. The temperature at first will gradually fall, then become constant as crystallization starts and continues under equilibrium conditions, and finally will start to drop again. Some chemicals may supercool slightly below (0.5) the solidification point; as crystallization begins the temperature will rise and remain constant as equilibrium conditions are established. Other products may cool more than 0.5 and cause deviation from the normal pattern of temperature changes. If the temperature rise exceeds 0.5 after the initial crystallization begins, repeat the test and seed the melted compound with small crystals of the sample at 0.5 intervals as the temperature approaches the expected solidification point. Crystals for seeding may be obtained by freezing a small sample in a test-tube directly in the cooling bath. It is preferable that seeds of the stable phase be used from a previous determination. Observe and record the temperature readings at regular intervals until the temperature rises from a minimum, due to supercooling, to a maximum and then finally drops. The maximum temperature reading is the solidification point. Readings 10 sec apart should be taken in order to establish that the temperature is at the maximum level and continues until the drop in temperature is established.
SPECIFIC GRAVITY
Specific gravity is defined as the ratio of the mass of the sample to the mass of an equal volume of the standard material. The specific gravity (dtt) means the ratio of the weight of the sample at t' to that of an equal volume of water at t. Unless otherwise specified, specific gravity means D2020. Specific gravity is determined by one of the following methods, unless otherwise specified.
Measurement by Pycnometer
A pycnometer is a vessel made of glass with a capacity of usually 10 to 100 ml. It has a ground, glass stopper fitted with a thermometer, and has a side tube with a mark and a ground glass cap. Weigh a pycnometer previously cleaned and dried, and note the weight W. Remove the stopper and the cap, fill the pycnometer with a sample, keep at the temperature of about 1 to 3 lower than that specified, and stopper, taking care not to leave bubbles. Raise the temperature gradually until the thermometer shows the specified temperature. Remove the sample above the mark from the side tube, replace the cap, and wipe the outside thoroughly. Weigh, and note the weight W1. Using the
same pycnometer, perform the similar determination with water. Weight the pycnometer containing water at the specified temperature, and note the weight W2. Calculate the specific gravity of the sample by the following formula. d = (W1 - W) / (W2 - W)
Measurement by Hydrometer
Use a hydrometer with a necessary precision intended for use at the specified temperature. Clean the hydrometer with alcohol. Shake the sample well, and place in the hydrometer after bubbles have disappeared. At the specified temperature, when the hydrometer has settled, read the specific gravity at the upper brim of the meniscus. In case of any hydrometer, however, for which special directions are given, follow the directions.
Sprengel-Ostwald Pycnometer Weigh the pycnometer, previously cleaned and dried (W). Immerse the curved tube in the sample kept at a temperature 3 to 5 lower than the specified temperature, attach a rubber tube at the end of the straight tube, and suck the sample gently until it comes up above the mark, taking care to prevent formation of bubbles. Immerse the pycnometer in a water bath kept at the specified temperature for about 15 min, and by attaching a piece of filter paper at the end of the curved tube, adjust the end of the sample to the mark. Remove the pycnometer from the water bath, and wipe the outside well. Weigh and note the weight W1. By using the same pycnometer, perform the same determination with water. Weigh the pycnometer containing water at the specified temperature, and note the weight W. Calculate the specific gravity by the following formula: d = (W1 - W) / (W2 - W)
SPECIFIC ROTATION
Optical rotation of chemicals is generally expressed in degrees, as either "angular rotation" (observed) or "specific rotation" (calculated with reference to the specific concentration of 1 g of solute in 1 ml of solution, measured under stated conditions). Specific rotation usually is expressed by the term [alpha]tx, in which t represents, in degrees centigrade, the temperature at which the rotation is determined, and x represents the characteristic spectral line or wavelength of the light used. Spectral lines most frequently employed are the D line of sodium (doublet at 589.0 and 589.6 nm and the yellow-green line of mercury at 546.1 nm). The specific gravity and the rotatory power vary appreciably with the temperature. The accuracy and precision of optical rotatory measurements will be increased if they are carried out with due regard for the following general considerations.
The source of illumination should be supplemented by a filtering system capable of transmitting light of a sufficiently monochromatic nature. Precision polarimeters generally are designed to accomodate interchangeable disks to isolate the D line from sodium light or the 546.1 nm line from the mercury spectrum. With polarimeters not thus designed, cells containing suitably coloured liquids may be employed as filters [see "Technique of Organic Chemistry", A. Weissberger. Vol. I, Part II, 3rd ed. (1960), Interscience Publishers, Inc., New York, N.Y.]. Special attention should be paid to temperature control of the solution and of the polarimeter. Observations should be accurate and reproducible to the extent that differences between replicates, or between observed and true values of rotation (the latter value having been established by calibration of the polarimeter scale with suitable standards), calculated in terms of either specific rotation or angular rotation, whichever is appropriate, shall not exceed one-fourth of the range given in the individual monograph for the rotation of the article being tested. Generally, a polarimeter accurate to 0.05 of angular rotation, and capable of being read with the same precision, suffices. In some cases, a polarimeter accurate to 0.01 or less, of angular rotation, and read with comparable precision, may be required. Polarimeter tubes should be filled in such a way as to avoid creating or leaving air bubbles which interfere with the passage of the beam of light. Interference from bubbles is minimized with tubes in which the bore is expanded at one end. However, with tubes of uniform bore, such as semimicro-or micro-tubes, care is required for proper filling. At the time of filling, the tubes and the liquid or solution should be at a temperature not higher than that specified for the determination, to guard against the formation of a bubble upon cooling and contraction of the contents. In closing tubes having removable end-plates fitted with gaskets and caps, the latter should be tightened only enough to ensure a leak-proof seal between the end-plate and the body of the tube. Excessive pressure on the end-plate may set up strains that result in interference with the measurements. In determining the specific rotation of a substance of low rotatory power, it is desirable to loosen the caps and tighten them again between successive readings in the measurement of both the rotation and the zero-point. Differences arising from end-plate strain thus generally will be revealed and appropriate adjustments to eliminate the cause may be made.
Procedure
In the case of a solid, dissolve the substance in a suitable solvent, reserving a separate portion of the latter for a blank determination. Make at least five readings of the rotation of the solution, or of the substance itself if liquid, at 25 or the temperature specified in the individual monograph. Replace the solution with the reserved portion of the solvent (or, in the case of a liquid, use the empty tube), make the same number of readings, and use the average as the blank value. Subtract the blank value from the average observed rotation if the two figures are of the same sign, or add if opposite in sign, to obtain the corrected angular rotation.
Calculation
Calculate the specific rotation of a liquid substance, or of a solid in solution, by application of one of the following formulas: (I) For liquid substances, [alpha]tx = (a/ld);
(II) For solutions of solids, [alpha]tx = (100a/lpd) = (100a/lc); in which a = the corrected angular rotation, in degrees, at temperature t; l = the length of the polarimeter tube in decimeters; d = the specific gravity of the liquid or solution at the temperature of observation; p = the concentration of the solution expressed as the number of g of substance in 100 g of solution; and c = the concentration of the solution expressed as the number of g of substance in 100 ml of solution. The concentrations p and c should be calculated on the dried or anhydrous basis, unless otherwise specified.
II. METHODS FOR DETERMINING INORGANIC COMPONENTS o ACID-INSOLUBLE MATTER o ASH o CHLORIDES LIMIT TEST o FLUORIDE LIMIT TEST(Food Chemicals Codex, 3rd Edition, National Academy Press (1981).) o LOSS ON DRYING o LOSS ON IGNITION o METALLIC IMPURITIES o INSTRUMENTAL METHODS (TENTATIVE) Measurement of antimony, barium, cadmium, chromium, copper, lead and zinc by atomic absorption Measurement of arsenic and antimony by atomic absorption hydride technique Determination of mercury by atomic absorption cold vapour technique o ARSENIC LIMIT TEST METHOD I (Gutzeit Procedure) METHOD II (Colorimetric Procedure) o CHROMIUM LIMIT TEST o HEAVY METALS LIMIT TEST o IRON LIMIT TEST o LEAD LIMIT TEST o MERCURY LIMIT TEST o NICKEL LIMIT TEST o SELENIUM LIMIT TEST o NITROGEN DETERMINATION (Kjeldahl Method)( ISO R-937-1969 may be used as an alternate method.) o NON-VOLATILE RESIDUE o SULFATES LIMIT TEST o WATER DETERMINATION (Karl Fischer Titrimetric Method)
ASH (Acid-insoluble)
Boil the ash obtained as directed under Ash (Total) above, with 25 ml of dilute hydrochloric acid TS for 5 min, collect the insoluble matter on a suitable ashless filter, wash with hot water, ignite at 800 25, cool, and weigh. Calculate the percentage of acid-insoluble ash from the weight of the sample taken.
heat in the same manner until the remainder of the sample and any excess sulfuric acid have been volatilized. Finally ignite in a muffle furnace at 800 25 for 15 min or longer, if necessary, to complete ignition, cool in a desiccator, and weigh. (Note: In order to promote volatilization of sulfuric acid, it is advisable to add a few pieces of ammonium carbonate just before completing ignition.)
FLUORIDE LIMIT TEST(Food Chemicals Codex, 3rd Edition, National Academy Press (1981).) METHOD I
Thorium Nitrate Colorimetric Method
This method should be used unless otherwise directed in the individual monograph. Caution: When applying this test to organic compounds, the temperature at which the distillation is conducted must be rigidly controlled at all times to the recommended range of 135 to 140 to avoid the possibility of explosion. Note: To minimize the distillation blank resulting from fluoride leached from the glassware, the distillation apparatus should be treated as follows: Treat the glassware with hot 10% sodium hydroxide solution, followed by flushing with tap water and rinsing with distilled water. At least once daily, treat in addition by boiling down 15 to 20 ml of dilute sulfuric acid (1 in 2) until the still is filled with fumes; cool, pour off the acid, treat again with 10% sodium hydroxide solution, and rinse thoroughly. For further details, see sections 25.050 and 25.054 in Official Methods of Analysis of the AOAC, Thirteenth Edition, 1980.
Unless otherwise directed, place a 5.0 g sample and 30 ml of water in a 125 ml distillation flask having a side arm and trap. The flask is connected with a condenser and carries a thermometer and a capillary tube, both of which must extend into the liquid. Slowly add, with continuous stirring, 10 ml of perchloric acid, and then add 2 or 3 drops of silver nitrate solution (1 in 2) and a few glass beads. Connect a small dropping funnel or a steam generator to the capillary tube. Support the flask on an asbestos mat with a hole that exposes about one third of the flask to the flame. Distil until the temperature reaches 135. Add water from the funnel or introduce steam through the capillary, maintaining the temperature between 135 and 140 at all times. Continue the distillation until 100 ml of distillate has been collected. After the 100 ml portion (Distillate A) is collected, collect an additional 50 ml portion of distillate (Distillate B) to ensure that all of the fluorine has been volatilized. Place 50 ml of Distillate A in a 50 ml Nessler tube. In another similar Nessler tube place 50 ml of water distilled through the apparatus as a control. Add to each tube 0.1 ml of a filtered solution of sodium alizarinsulfonate (1 in 1,000) and 1 ml of freshly prepared hydroxylamine hydrochloride solution (1 in 4,000), and mix well. Add, dropwise and with stirring, either 1 N or 0.05 N sodium hydroxide, depending upon the expected volume of volatile and distilling over, to the tube containing the distillate until its colour just matches that of the control, which is faintly pink. Then add to each tube 1.0 ml of 0.1 N hydrochloric acid, and mix well. From a buret, graduated in 0.05 ml, add slowly to the tube containing the distillate enough thorium nitrate solution (1 in 4,000) so that, after mixing, the colour of the liquid just changes to a faint pink. Note the volume of the solution added, then add exactly the same volume to the control, and mix. Now add to the control solution sodium fluoride TS (10 g F per ml) from a buret to make the colours of the two tubes match after dilution to the same volume. Mix well, and allow all air bubbles to escape before making the final colour comparison. Check the endpoint by adding 1 or 2 drops of sodium fluoride TS to the control. A distinct change in colour should take place. Note the volume of sodium fluoride TS added. Dilute Distillate B to 100 ml, and mix well. Place 50 ml of this solution in a 50 ml Nessler tube, and follow the procedure used for Distillate A. The total volume of sodium fluoride TS required for the solutions from both Distillate A and Distillate B should not exceed 2.5 ml.
METHOD II
Ion-Selective Electrode Method A
Buffer Solution: Dissolve 36 g of cyclohexylenedinitrilo-tetra-acetic acid (CDTA) in sufficient 1 M sodium hydroxide to make 200 ml. Transfer 20 ml of this solution (equivalent to 4 g of disodium CDTA) into a 1,000 ml beaker containing 500 ml of water, 57 ml of glacial acetic acid, and 58 g of sodium chloride, and stir to dissolve. Adjust the pH of the solution to between 5.0 and 5.5 by the addition of 5 M sodium hydroxide, then cool to room temperature, dilute to 1,000 ml with water, and mix. Procedure: Unless otherwise directed in the individual monograph, place an 8.0 g sample and 20 ml of water in a 250 ml distilling flask, cautiously add 20 ml of perchloric acid, and then add 2 or 3 drops of silver nitrate solution (1 in 2) and a few glass beads. Following the directions, and observing the Caution and Note, as given under Method I, distil the solution until 200 ml of distillate has been collected. Transfer a 25.0-ml aliquot of the distillate into a 250-ml plastic beaker, and dilute to 100 ml with the Buffer Solution. Place the fluoride ion and reference electrodes (or a
combination fluoride electrode) of a suitable ion-selective electrode apparatus (such as the Orion Model 407) in the solution, and adjust the calibration control until the indicator needle points to the centre of the logarithmic concentration scale, allowing sufficient time for equilibration (about 20 min) and stirring constantly during the equilibration period and throughout the remainder of the procedure. Pipet 1.0 ml of a solution containing 100 g of fluoride ion (F) per ml (prepared by dissolving 22.2 mg of sodium fluoride, previously dried at 200 for 4 h, in sufficient water to make 100.0 ml) into the beaker, allow the electrode to come to equilibrium, and record the final reading on the logarithmic concentration scale. (Note: Follow the instrument manufacturer's instructions regarding precautions and interferences, electrode filling and check, temperature compensation, and calibration.) Calculation: Calculate the fluoride content, in mg/kg of the sample taken by the formula [IA/(R - I)] x 100 x [200/25W] in which I is the initial scale reading before the addition of the sodium fluoride solution; A is the concentration, in g per ml, of fluoride in the sodium fluoride solution added to the sample solution; R is the final scale reading, after addition of the sodium fluoride solution; and W is the original weight of the sample in g.
METHOD III
Ion-Selective Electrode Method B
Sodium Fluoride Solution (5 g F per ml): Transfer 2.210 g of sodium fluoride, previously dried at 110 for 2 h and accurately weighed, into a 400 ml plastic beaker, add 200 ml of water, and stir until dissolved. Quantitatively transfer this solution into a 1,000 ml volumetric flask with the aid of water, dilute to volume with water, and mix. Store this stock solution in a plastic bottle. On the day of use, transfer 5,0 ml of the stock solution into a 1,000 ml volumetric flask, dilute to volume with water, and mix. Calibration Curve: Transfer into separate 250 ml plastic beakers 1.0, 2.0, 3.0, 5.0, 10.0, and 15.0 ml of the Sodium Fluoride Solution, add 50 ml of water, 5 ml of 1 N hydrochloric acid, 10 ml of 1 M sodium citrate, and 10 ml of 0.2 M disodium EDTA to each beaker, and mix. Transfer each solution into a 100 ml volumetric flask, dilute to volume with water, and mix. Transfer a 50 ml portion of each solution into a 125-ml plastic beaker, and measure the potential of each solution with a suitable ion-selective electrode apparatus (such as the Orion Model No. 94-09, with solid-state membrane), using a suitable reference electrode (such as Orion Model No. 90-0l, with single junction). Plot the calibration curve on two-cycle semilogarithmic paper (such as K & E No. 465130), with g F per 100 ml solution on the logarithmic scale. Procedure: Transfer 1.00 g of the sample into a 150-ml glass beaker, add 10 ml of water, and while stirring continuously, add 20 ml of 1 N hydrochloric acid slowly to dissolve the sample. Boil rapidly for 1 min, then transfer into a 250-ml plastic beaker, and cool rapidly in ice water. Add 15 ml of 1 M sodium citrate and 10 ml of 0.2 M disodium EDTA, and mix. Adjust the pH to 5.5 0.1 with 1 N hydrochloric acid or 1 M sodium hydroxide, if necessary, then transfer into a 100-ml volumetric flask, dilute to volume with water, and mix. Transfer a 50-ml portion of this solution into a 125-ml plastic beaker and measure the potential of the solution with the apparatus described under Calibration Curve. Determine the fluoride content, in g, of the sample from the Calibration Curve.
METHOD IV
Ion-Selective Electrode Method C
Buffer Solution A: Add 2 volumes of 6 N acetic acid to 1 volume of water, and adjust the pH to 5.0 with 50% potassium hydroxide solution. Buffer Solution B: Dissolve 150 g of sodium citrate dihydrate and 10.3 g of disodium EDTA dihydrate in 800 ml of water, adjust the pH to 8.0 with 50% sodium hydroxide solution, and dilute to 1,000 ml with water. Buffer Solution C: Dissolve 36 g of cyclohexylenedinitrilo-tetra-acetic acid (CDTA) in sufficient 1 N sodium hydroxide to make 200 ml by boiling, then cool, and filter through glass-fiber filter paper. Pipet 30 ml of this solution into a mixture consisting of 750 ml of water, 87 g of sodium chloride, and 85.5 ml of glacial acetic acid. Adjust the pH to between 5.0 and 5.5 by the addition of 50% sodium hydroxide solution, then cool, and dilute to 3,000 ml with water. Fluoride Standard Solution: Use a solution containing 100 g of fluoride ion (F) per ml (100 mg/kg), obtained commercially or prepared by dissolved 22.2 mg of sodium fluoride, previously dried at 200 for 4 h in sufficient water to make 100.0 ml. Sample Preparation: Weigh accurately the amount of sample specified in the monograph, transfer it into a 100-ml volumetric flask, and dissolve it in a minimum amount of water or in the volume of hydrochloric acid solution specified in the monograph. Add 50.0 ml of the appropriate buffer solution, A, B, or C, as specified in the monograph, dilute to volume with water and mix. Procedure: Pipet a 50-ml aliquot of the Sample Preparation into a plastic beaker, and place in the solution the fluoride ion and reference electrodes (or a combination fluoride electrode) of a suitable ion-selective electrode apparatus with magnetic stirrer (Orion Model 407 or equivalent). Begin stirring slowly, and set the slope of the meter to 100% and the temperature control to room temperature, which should be the temperature of the solution. Adjust the calibration control to read infinity on the increment logarithmic scale, and allow the instrument to equilibrate. Note: The ion-selective electrode responds much more slowly than does a pH electrode, and a stable reading may not be obtained until 2 or 3 min. The reading should not change for 30 to 60 s. Add the volume, accurately measured, of Fluoride Standard Solution specified in the monograph, allow the electrode to equilibrate with continued stirring, and take the final reading on the increment logarithmic scale, recording the value obtained as S. Perform a blank determination using 50 ml of the same buffer solution as used for the sample under analysis, and record the value obtained as B. Calculation: Determine the value of by the formula (V x C)/50, in which V is the volume of Fluoride Standard Solution added, in ml; C is the exact concentration of the Fluoride Standard Solution, in mg/kg; and 50 is the volume in ml of Sample Preparation used. Calculate the concentration, in mg/kg, of fluoride (F) in sample by the formula, [(S x ) - B] x (100/W)
LOSS ON DRYING
(Note. Suitable precautionary steps should be taken when weighing hygroscopic or deliquescent samples to ensure that they do not absorb moisture.) Unless otherwise directed in the individual monograph, conduct the determination on 1 to 2 g of the substance, previously well mixed and accurately weighed. Reduce the sample to a fine powder when it occurs as crystals. Tare a glass-stoppered, shallow weighing bottle that has been dried for 30 min under the same conditions as will be employed in the determination. Transfer the sample into the bottle, replace the cover, and weigh the bottle and the sample. Distribute the sample as evenly as practicable to a depth of about 5 mm, and not over 10 mm in the case of bulky materials. Place the bottle with its contents in the drying chamber, removing the stopper and leaving it also in the chamber, and dry the sample at the temperature and for the time specified in the monograph. Upon opening the chamber, close the bottle promptly and allow it to come to room temperature in a desiccator before weighing. If the substance melts at a lower temperature than that specified for the determination of Loss on Drying, prepare the sample as described above, then place it in a vacuum desiccator containing sulfuric acid. Evacuate the desiccator to 130 Pa (1 mm of mercury), maintain this vacuum for 24 h, and then weigh the dried sample.
LOSS ON IGNITION
Proceed as directed for Loss on Drying. However, unless otherwise directed, ignite the sample at the temperature of 450 to 550 and use a platinum, quartz or porcelain dish instead of the weighing bottle.
METALLIC IMPURITIES
All the procedures for trace metals commence with dissolution of the sample and, if applicable, with destruction of organic matter in the sample. The trace metal content may then be determined by instrumental or chemical methods. Atomic spectroscopy combines speed with accuracy and is widely used when large numbers of samples have to be analyzed. Chemical methods depend on the formation of specific coloured compounds by the metal impurities. The colour intensities of sample and standards are then compared visually or by using a spectrophotometer.
substance can also follow that given in the individual monograph for the Heavy Metals Limit Test.
Principle
The samples are dissolved in acid or digested in a mixture of sulfuric, nitric and, in some cases perchloric acids. The barium, cadmium, lead, copper, chromium, and zinc in solution are determined by conventional flame atomic absorption spectroscopy. Antimony and arsenic are determined by using a hydride generation technique. Alternatively, antimony may be determined by flame atomic absorption but the hydride generation technique is more sensitive.
General precautions
Because of the minute amounts of metals involved special care must be taken to reduce the reagent blanks to as low a value as possible and to avoid contamination during the test. All apparatus should be thoroughly cleaned with a mixture of hot dilute acids (1 part hydrochloric acid, 1 part concentrated nitric acid, and 3 parts water) followed by thorough washing with water immediately before use.
Apparatus
- Kjeldahl flasks, of silica or borosilicate glass (nominal capacity 100 ml) fitted with an extension to the neck by means of a B24 ground joint, as shown in Figure 1. The extension serves to condense the fumes and carries a tap funnel through which the reagents are introduced.
Figure 1. Modified Kjeldahl Flask (open type) - Atomic absorption spectrophotometer. Any commercial instrument operating in the absorption mode may be used providing it has facilities for the selection of the required oxidant/fuel combination from a choice of air, argon, nitrous oxide, hydrogen and acetylene and has a wavelength range from 180 to 600 nm. A hydride generation vessel accessory is also required and is available from all the major commercial manufacturers of atomic absorption equipment. For operations in emission mode and measurements of absorption involving the generation of a gaseous hydride, a potentiometric recorder is necessary, preferably a multi-range type covering the range 1-20 mV.
Reagents
Reagents shall be of an order of purity higher than accepted analytical reagent grade quality. Metal-free water (see below) shall be used throughout.
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9.
Nitric acid, sp.gr. 1.42 Perchloric acid, 60% (w/w) solution Sulfuric acid, 98% H2SO4 Hydrochloric acid, sp.gr. 1.16 - 1.18 Hydrochloric acid 5 N solution prepared by dilution of reagent (d) with metalfree distilled water Water, metal free. Distilled water may be re-distilled from an all-glass apparatus or may be passed down a column of cation exchange resin, e.g., Amberlite IR 120 (H) Sodium sulfate Sodium borohydride pellets Potassium chloride
Standards
Use commercially available standard solutions or prepare solutions as follows:
Dissolve 1.60 g of lead nitrate, Pb(NO3)2 in nitric acid (10 ml of concentrated nitric acid diluted with 20 ml water, boiled to remove nitrous fumes, and cooled) and dilute to 1,000 ml with water in a one-mark graduated flask. Dilute 10.0 ml of this solution to 500 ml at 20 with water in a one-mark graduated flask as required. 1 ml = 20 g Pb
Method I
Accurately weigh about 2.5 g of the sample and dissolve in a mixture of 4 ml of sulfuric acid and 5 ml of hydrochloric acid. Transfer the solution to a 50 ml one-mark graduated flask. If barium is to be measured from the solution, add 0.0954 g of potassium chloride. Dilute to the mark with water. Call this Solution A.
Method II
Accurately weigh about 2.5 g of the sample into a 100 - 150 ml Kjeldahl flask, and add 5 ml of the dilute nitric acid. As soon as any initial reaction subsides, heat gently until further vigorous reactions cease and then cool. Add gradually 4 ml of concentrated
sulfuric acid at such a rate as not to cause excessive frothing on heating (5-10 min are usually required) and then heat until the liquid darkens appreciably in colour, i.e., begins to char. Add concentrated nitric acid slowly in small portions, heating between additions until darking again takes place. Do not heat so strongly that charring is excessive, or loss of arsenic may occur; small but not excessive amount of free nitric acid should be present throughout. Continue this treatment until the solution is only pale yellow in colour and fails to darken in colour on prolonged heating. If the solution is still coloured run in 0.5 ml of the perchloric acid solution and a little concentrated nitric acid and heat for about 15 minutes, then add a further 0.5 ml of the perchloric acid solution and heat for a few minutes longer. Note the total amount of concentrated nitric acid used. Allow to cool somewhat and dilute with 10 ml of water. The solution should be quite colourless (if much iron is present it may be faintly yellow). Boil down gently, taking care to avoid bumping, until white fumes appear. Allow to cool, add a further 5 ml of water and again boil down gently to fuming. Finally, cool, add 10 ml 5 N hydrochloric acid and boil gently for a few minutes. Cool and transfer the solution to a 50 ml one-mark graduated flask washing out the Kjeldahl flask with small portions of water. Add the washings to the graduated flask and dilute to the mark with water. If barium is to be measured from the solution, add before dilution 0.0954 g of potassium chloride, as an ionizing buffer to prevent ionization of barium. Call this Solution A. Prepare a reagent blank using the same quantities of reagents as used in the sample oxidation.
Measurement of antimony, barium, cadmium, chromium, copper, lead and zinc by atomic absorption
Instrumental conditions
Select the wavelength and gases to be used for the particular element under consideration from the table below.
Element
Antimony 217.6
Barium
553.6
Cadmium 228.8 Chromium 357.9 Copper Lead Zinc 324.8 283.3 213.9
The recommended settings for the various instrumental parameters vary from model to model, and certain parameters require optimization at the time of use to obtain the best results. Instruments should therefore be adjusted as described in the manufacturer's instructions using the type of flame and wavelength settings specified above.
Procedure
Set the atomic absorption spectrophotometer to the appropriate conditions. Aspirate the strongest standard containing the element to be determined and optimize the instrument settings to give full-scale or maximum deflection on the chart recorder. Measure the absorbances of the other standards and plot a graph showing the net absorbance against the concentration of the element in the standard solutions. Aspirate the solution A obtained from dissolution or the wet oxidation of the sample and the corresponding blank solution and determine the net absorbance. Using the graph prepared above, determine the concentration of the element in the sample solution. (Concentration of element (g/ml) x 50) / Weight of sample taken (g) = mg/kg element in the sample
Instrumental conditions
Using the atomic absorption spectrophotometer with the appropriate hollow cathode or electrodeless discharge lamp, select the wavelength for either arsenic (193.7 nm) or antimony (217.6 nm).
Procedure
Measure 5.0 ml of the strongest standard into the generation vessel, add 25 ml water and 2 ml 5 N hydrochloric acid [reagent (e)]. Stopper the vessel and expel any air as described in the maker's instructions, filling the apparatus with Argon. Isolate the vessel from the atomizer using the by-pass valve. Remove the atomizer and then quickly add 1 pellet of sodium borohydride weighing approximately 0.2 g [reagent (h)] and replace the stopper. Ensure that all the joints are secure. When the reaction slows (20 - 30 sec) open the appropriate taps to allow Argon to drive the generated hydride into the flame. When the hydride has all been expelled as shown by the recorder trace, return the taps to their original position and empty the vessel. Optimize the instrument settings to give full scale deflection for the strongest standard. Measure the other standards, the sample and the blank solution using the same procedure. Plot a graph relating peak height on the recorder to concentration of the arsenic or antimony in the standards. Using the net absorbance of the sample, read from the graph the concentration of arsenic or antimony in the solution.
Calculation
(Concentration of arsenic or antimony (g/ml) x 50) / weight of sample taken (g) = mg/kg arsenic or antimony in the sample
Principle
The sample is ashed by heating under reflux with sulfuric and nitric acids. The oxidation is completed by addition of potassium permanganate solution. After successive additions of hydroxylamine hydrochloride solution and stannous chloride solution, the mercury content is measured by cold vapour atomic absorption spectrometry.
Special Reagents
1. Nitric Acid, sp.gr. 1.40; 2. Sulfuric acid, sp.gr. 1.84; 3. Sulfuric acid, approximately 3.5 M. Prepare by diluting 1 volume of concentrated sulfuric acid (b), with 4 volumes of water; 4. Sulfuric acid, approximately 1 M. Prepare by diluting 1 volume of 3.5 M sulfuric acid (c) with 2.5 volumes of water; 5. Hydrochloric acid, sp.gr. 1.18; 6. Potassium permanganate solution, 50.0 g/L;
7. Hydroxylamine hydrochloride solution, 100.0 g/L; 8. Stannous chloride solution. Prepare by dissolving 25.0 g of stannous chloride (SnCl2.2H2O) in 50 ml hydrochloric acid (e). Make up to 250 ml with water and bubble nitrogen through the solution. Store over a few granules of metallic tin; 9. Chromic acid mixture. Dissolve 4.0 g of potassium dichromate in 300 ml of 3.5 M sulfuric acid (c) and make up to 1 litre with water; 10. Magnesium perchlorate, in granular form for gas desiccation; 11. Mercuric chloride
Standards
Use commercialy available standard solutions, or prepare the standards as follows:
Apparatus
All the glassware must be cleaned with hot nitric acid [special reagent (a)] and washed thoroughly with water before use.
Mineralization apparatus fitted with reflux condenser (see figure). Bubblers, with a ground glass stopper fitted with two tubes to permit entrainment of the mercury vapour and with a calibration mark at the required volume for measurement. The capacity of the bubbler and position of the mark depend on the atomic absorption spectrophotometer used. Clean the bubbler successively with chromic acid mixture [special reagent (i)], tap water and double distilled water before use. Water vapour absorption apparatus, containing magnesium perchlorate [special reagent (j)]. Atomic absorption spectrophotometer suitable for the cold vapour determination of mercury in open or closed circuit, with recorder.
Procedure
Ashing
Weigh out, to the nearest 2 mg, approximately 0.5 g sample containing not more than 0.5 g total mercury. Introduce the sample into the receiver flask (M), and add a few glass beads. Connect the receiver flask to the condensate reservoir (D) and close the stopcock (R). Introduce into the reservoir 25 ml of nitric acid [special reagent (a)] followed by 10 ml sulfuric acid [special reagent (b)]. Mount and turn on the condenser (A). Open the stopcock carefully and allow small portions of the mixture of acids to run into the receiver flask. Interrupt the flow of acids if the reaction becomes too vigorous. Empty the reservoir into the receiver flask, mix the contents of the latter well by careful shaking and leave the stopcock open. Heat the receiver flask carefully. As soon as foaming has ceased, close the stopcock (R), continue heating and let the condensate collect in the reservoir. Discontinue heating when the contents of the receiver flask begin to char. Allow a small portion of the condensate to run into the receiver flask, close the stopcock again and resume heating the receiver flask. Repeat this procedure for as long as the contents display charring when heated. When charring has ceased, heat and add condensate as soon as white fumes appear. Continue alternately heating and adding condensate for one hour. Finally, heat the contents of the flask to white fumes.
Stop heating and allow to cool to approximately 40. Open the stopcock and allow all the condensate to run into the receiver flask. Wash the apparatus out from the top of the condenser with 5 - 10 ml of water, collect the washings in the receiver flask and disconnect it from the reservoir.
Calibration Curve
Introduce respectively 2, 5, 10, 15 and 25 ml aliquots of the standard mercury solution [Standard (b)] into bubblers and 25 ml sulfuric acid [special reagent (d)] into a sixth bubbler. Add potassium permanganate solution [special reagent (f)] dropwise, with agitation, to each bubbler until a colouration persists. Measure the mercury content as described above. Plot the calibration curve with the measured absorption values as ordinates and the corresponding mercury contents in micrograms as abscissae. The working standards contain 0, 0.04, 0.10, 0.20, 0.30 and 0.50 g of mercury, respectively.
Method of Addition
The method of addition may be used if an open-circuit system is used. Place one of the working standard solutions (see 4 above) in a bubbler and add an aliquot portion of the sample solution obtained after treatment (see 2 above). The quantity of mercury in the bubbler must lie in the range in which the photometer gives a
linear response. Measure the mercury content as described in 3, above. If necessary, carry out several such determinations, using different working standard solutions.
Blank Determination
Carry out all the operations, from ashing to measurement, except for introduction of the sample. When treating the solution, add a quantity of potassium permanganate solution [special reagent (f)] equal to that used for the experimental sample.
Calculation
Read off from the calibration curve the quantities, in g, of mercury corresponding to the measured absorption values. Subtract the quantity of mercury found in the blank from that found in the sample. net weight of mercury (g) / sample weight (g) = mg/kg Hg in the sample
Procedure
Transfer the solution (D) to a conical flask of 120 ml capacity (see Figure). The flask is fitted with a rubber stopper, through which passes a glass tube, 200 mm long and with an internal diameter of 6.5 mm. The lower end of the glass tube is cut at an angle and a hole not less than 2 mm in diameter is blown in the side of the tube. About 40 mm above the stopper the tube is cut clearly and squarely into two parts: between the two parts of the tube is inserted a small disc of test paper (A), having a diameter equal to the outside diameter of the tube. The two parts of the tube, with the test paper, are tightly joined together with rubber tubing (B). The test paper circle is made from filter paper (Whatman No. 1 or equivalent), soaked in a 5% solution of mercuric chloride in ethanol and dried in a current of air.
A. Mercuric chloride test paper disc B. Rubber connection C. Cotton gauze saturated with lead acetate D. Test solution E. Aluminum squares Figure. Apparatus for Limit Test for Arsenic Loosely plug the lower end of the tube with cotton gauze soaked in a 5% lead acetate solution and dried (C). In the conical flask, add three squares (8 mm x 8 mm x 1 mm) of aluminium sheet (E) and immediately close the flask with the rubber stopper. Allow the flask to stand in a water bath at 25 for 45 min. At the same time, carry out a parallel experiment using the standard solution of arsenic in place of the test sample. Compare the colours of the two mercuric chloride test papers. The intensity of the colour from the test sample should not be greater than that of the standard stain.
Apparatus
The general apparatus is shown in the accompanying diagram. It consists of a 125-ml arsine generator flask (A) with a 24/40 standard-taper joint (B) fitted with a scrubber unit (C) and an absorber tube (E) connected by a capillary of inside diameter 2 mm and outside diameter 8 mm via a ball-and-socket joint (D), secured with a No. 12 clamp, connecting the units. Alternatively, an apparatus embodying the principle of the general assembly described and illustrated may be used.
Reagents
Silver Diethyldithiocarbamate Solution
Dissolve 1 g of recrystallized silver diethyldithiocarbamate, (C2H5)2NCSSAg, in 200 ml of reagent grade pyridine in a fume hood. Store this solution in a light-resistant container and use within 1 month. Silver diethyldithiocarbamate is available commercially or may be prepared as follows. Dissolve 1.7 g of reagent grade silver nitrate in 100 ml of water. In a separate container, dissolve 2.3 g of sodium diethyldithiocarbamate, (C2H5)2NCSSNa3H2O, in 100 ml of water, and filter. Cool both solutions to about 15, mix the two solutions, while stirring, collect the yellow precipitate in a medium-porosity sintered-glass crucible or funnel, and wash with about 200 ml of cold water. Recrystallize the reagent, whether prepared as directed above or obtained commercially, as follows: Dissolve in freshly distilled pyridine, using about 100 ml of
solvent for each g of reagent, and filter. Add an equal volume of cold water to the pyridine solution, while stirring. Filter off the precipitate, using suction, wash with cold water, and dry in vacuum at room temperature for 2 to 3 h. The dry salt is pure yellow in colour and should show no change in character after 1 month when stored in a lightresistant container. Discard any material that changes in colour or develops a strong odour.
reaction, and heating should be discontinued if foaming becomes excessive. Swirl the solution in the flask to prevent unreacted substance from caking on the walls or bottom of the flask during digestion. Maintain oxidizing conditions at all times during the digestion by adding small quantities of the peroxide whenever the mixture turns brown or darkens. Continue the digestion until the organic matter is destroyed, gradually raising the temperature of the hot plate to 250 - 300 until fumes of sulfuric acid are copiously evolved, and the solution becomes colourless, or retains only a slight straw colour. Cool, add cautiously 10 ml of water, again evaporate (fumes of sulfuric acid evolved), and cool. Add cautiously 10 ml of water, mix, wash the sides of the flask with a few ml of water, and dilute to 35 ml.
Procedure
If the sample solution was not prepared in the generator flask, transfer to the flask a volume of the solution, prepared as directed, equivalent to 1.0 g of the substance being tested and add water to make 35 ml. Add 20 ml of dilute sulfuric acid (1 in 5), 2 ml of potassium iodide TS, and 0.5 ml of Stannous Chloride Solution, and mix. Allow the mixture to stand for 30 min at room temperature. Pack the scrubber tube (C) with two plugs of Lead Acetate-Impregnated Cotton, leaving a small air space between the two plugs, lubricate joints (B) and (D) with stopcock grease, if necessary, and connect the scrubber unit with the absorber tube (E). Transfer 3.0 ml of Silver diethyldithiocarbamate solution to the absorber tube, add 3.0 g of granular zinc (20-mesh) to the mixture in the flask, and immediately insert the standard-taper joint in the flask. Allow the evolution of hydrogen and colour development to proceed at room temperature (25 3) for 45 min, swirling the flask gently at 10-min intervals. (The addition of a small amount of isopropanol to the generator flask may improve the uniformity of the rate of gas evolution.) Disconnect the absorber tube from the generator and scrubber units, and transfer the Silver diethyldithiocarbamate solution to a 1-cm absorption cell. Determine the absorbance at the wavelength of maximum absorption between 535 nm and 540 nm with a suitable spectrophotometer or colorimeter, using Silver diethyldithiocarbamate solution as the blank. The absorbance due to any red colour from the solution of the sample does not exceed that produced by 3.0 ml of Standard arsenic solution (3g As) when treated in the same manner and under the same conditions as the sample. The room temperature during the generation of arsine from the standard should be held to within 2 of that observed during the determination of the sample. Note 1. Metals or salts of metals such as chromium, cobalt, copper, mercury, molybdenum, nickel, palladium, and silver are said to interfere with the evolution of arsine. Antimony, which forms stibine, is the only metal likely to produce a positive interference in the colour development with the silver diethyldithiocarbamate. Stibine forms a red colour which has a maximum absorbance at 510 nm, but at 535 - 540 nm the absorbance of the antimony complex is so diminished that the results of the determination would not be altered significantly. Note 2. All reagents used in the limit test for arsenic should be very low in arsenic content.
Procedure
Weigh 1.0 g of the sample into a quartz dish. Char the material, raising the temperature slowly. Allow to cool, add 10 ml of a 25% magnesium nitrate solution; evaporate, heating slowly until no more nitrous vapour evolves. Heat the material in an oven at 600 until all black particles have disappeared (1 h). Dissolve the residue by adding 10 ml of 4 N sulfuric acid and 20 ml of water. Heat on a water bath for about 5 min. Add 0.5 ml of 0.1 N potassium permanganate. Add more permanganate if the solution decolourizes. Cover with a watch glass and heat on a water bath for about 20 min. Add 5% sodium azide solution, one drop every 10 sec, until the excess potassium permanganate has been removed (avoid excess of sodium azide; 2 drops are usually sufficient). Cool the solution in running water, and filter if manganese dioxide is evident. Transfer the solution to a 50-ml volumetric flask. Add 2.5 ml of 5 M sodium dihydrogenphosphate, add 2 ml of diphenyl carbazide TS and fill to the mark with water. Measure the absorbance at 540 nm 30 min after adding the diphenyl carbazide TS. A blank with the latter two reagents should show no colour or only a slight purple colour. At the same time run a parallel test with 1.00 ml of standard chromate TS (1 ml = 20 g Cr) and a few ml of saccharose placed into a second quartz dish. Treat the mixture exactly as the sample and measure the extinction at the same wavelength. Calculate the chromium content of the sample from the two extinction values observed.
by virtue of their complex nature, interfere with the precipitation of heavy metals by sulfide.
Reagents
Ammonia TS
Dilute 400 ml of reagent grade ammonium hydroxide to 1,000 ml with water.
Hydrochloric acid
Use reagent grade hydrochloric acid in preparing all solutions of hydrochloric acid employed in this test.
Procedure
Note. In the following procedures for Methods I and II, failure to adjust accurately the pH of the solutions within the specified limits may result in a significant loss of test sensitivity.
METHOD I
Solution A
Pipet into a 50-ml Nessler tube 2 ml of Standard lead solution [20 g of lead ion (Pb)] unless otherwise stated in the individual monograph. Adjust the pH to between 3.0 and 4.0 (short-range pH indicator paper) by the addition of dilute acetic acid TS or ammonia TS, dilute with water to 40 ml and mix.
Solution B
Place in a 50-ml Nessler tube that matches the one used for Solution A, 25 ml of the sample solution prepared as directed in the individual monograph, adjust the pH to between 3.0 and 4.0 (short-range pH indicator paper) by the addition of dilute acetic acid TS or ammonia TS, dilute to 40 ml with water, and mix.
Solution C
Place into a third 50-ml Nessler tube that matches the ones used for Solution A and B, 25 ml of the sample solution prepared as directed in the individual monograph and add the same volume of Standard lead solution as was added to Solution A. Adjust the pH to between 3.0 and 4.0 (short-range indicator paper) by the addition of dilute acetic acid TS or ammonia TS, dilute with water to 40 ml and mix. Working in a fume hood, add to each tube 10 ml of freshly prepared hydrogen sulfide TS, mix, allow to stand for 5 min, and view downward over a white surface. The colour of Solution B is no darker than that of Solution A and the colour of Solution C is equal to or greater than that of Solution A. If the colour of Solution C is lighter than that of Solution A, the test substance is providing an interference and Method II must be used.
Method II
Proceed as directed under Method I preparing Solution B as follows: Working in a fume hood, place the specified quantity of the sample, accurately weighed, in a suitable crucible, add sufficient sulfuric acid to wet the sample, and carefully ignite at a low temperature until thoroughly charred, covering the crucible loosely with a suitable lid during the ignition. After the substance is thoroughly carbonized, add 2 ml of nitric acid and 5 drops of sulfuric acid, and cautiously heat until white fumes are evolved, then ignite, preferably in a muffle furnace, at 500 to 600 until all the carbon is burned off. Cool, add 4 ml of dilute hydrochloric acid (1 in 2), cover, and digest on a steam bath for 10 to 15 min. Uncover, and slowly evaporate on a steam bath to dryness. Moisten the residue with 1 drop of hydrochloric acid, add 10 ml of hot water, and digest for 2 min. Add dropwise ammonia TS until the solution is just alkaline to litmus paper, dilute with water to 25 ml, and adjust the pH to between 3.0 and 4.0 (short-range pH indicator paper) by the addition of dilute acetic acid TS. Filter if necessary, wash the crucible and the filter with 10 ml of water, transfer the solution and rinsings to a 50-ml Nessler tube, dilute with water to 40 ml, and mix. Prepare Solution C in the same manner as Solution B, adding to the sample in the crucible the same volume of Lead Standard Solution as was added to Solution A. Proceed as in Method I from "Working in a fume hood, add... ".
Ammonia-Cyanide Solution
Dissolve 2 g of potassium cyanide in 15 ml of strong ammonia TS, and dilute with water to 100 ml.
Sample Solution
The solution obtained by treating the sample as directed in an individual monograph is used directly as the Sample Solution in the Procedure. Sample solutions of organic compounds are prepared, unless otherwise directed, according to the following general method: Caution. Some substances may react unexpectedly with explosive violence when digested with hydrogen peroxide. Appropriate safety precautions must be employed at all times. Transfer 1.0 g of the sample into a suitable flask, add 5 ml of sulfuric acid and a few glass beads, and digest at a temperature not exceeding 120 until charring begins, using preferably a hot plate in a fume hood. (Additional sulfuric acid may be necessary to completely wet some samples, but the total volume added should not exceed about 10 ml.) After the sample has been initially decomposed by the acid, add with caution, dropwise, 30% hydrogen peroxide, allowing the reaction to subside and reheating between drops. The first few drops must be added very slowly with sufficient mixing to prevent a rapid reaction, and heating should be discontinued if foaming becomes excessive. Swirl the solution in the flask to prevent unreacted substance from caking on the walls or bottom of the flask during the digestion. Add small quantities of the peroxide when the solution begins to darken, and continue the digestion until the organic matter is destroyed, gradually raising the temperature of the hot plate to 250 300 until fumes of sulfur trioxide are copiously evolved and the solution becomes colourless or retains only a light straw colour. Cool, add cautiously 10 ml of water, again evaporate to strong fuming, and cool. Quantitatively transfer the solution into a separator with the aid of small quantities of water.
Procedure
Transfer the Sample Solution, prepared as directed in the individual monograph, into a separator, and, unless otherwise directed, add 6 ml of Ammonium Citrate TS (PbT), and 2 ml of Hydroxylamine Hydrochloride TS. (Use 10 ml of the citrate solution when
determining lead in iron salts.) To the separator add 2 drops of phenol red TS, and make the solution just alkaline (red in colour) by the addition of strong ammonia TS. Cool the solution, if necessary, under a stream of tap water, then add 2 ml of Potassium Cyanide TS. Immediately extract the solution with 5-ml portions of Dithizone Extraction TS, draining each extract into another separator, until the dithizone solution retains its green colour. Shake the combined dithizone solutions for 30 sec with 20 ml of dilute nitric acid (1 in 100), discard the chloroform layer, add to the acid solution 5.0 ml of Standard Dithizone TS and 4 ml of Ammonia-Cyanide Solution, and shake for 30 sec. The purplish hue in the chloroform solution of the sample due to any lead dithizonate present does not exceed that in a control, containing the volume of Diluted Standard Lead Solution equivalent to the amount of lead specified in the monograph, when treated in the same manner as the sample.
Aeration Apparatus
The apparatus, shown in Fig. 1, consists of a flowmeter (a), capable of measuring at a flow rate of 2.7 L per h, connected via a three-way stopcock (b), with Teflon plug, to 125-ml gas washing bottles (c and d), followed by a drying tube packed with glass wool (e), and finally a suitable quartz liquid absorption cell (f), terminating with a vent (g). Note: The absorption cell will vary in optical pathlength depending upon the type of mercury detection instrument used. Bottle c is fitted with an extra-coarse fritted bubbler (Corning 31770 125 EC or equivalent), and the bottle is marked with a 60-ml calibration line. The drying tube e is lightly packed with glass wool or magnesium perchlorate. Bottle c is used for the test solution, and bottle d, which remains empty throughout the procedure, is used to collect water droplets. Alternatively, an apparatus embodying the principle of the assembly described and illustrated may be used. The aerating medium may be either compressed air or compressed nitrogen.
Standard Preparation
Transfer 1.71 g of mercuric nitrate, Hg(NO3)2H2O, to a 1,000-ml volumetric flask, dissolve in a mixture of 100 ml of water and 2 ml of nitric acid, dilute to volume with water, and mix. Discard after 1 month. Transfer 10.0 ml of this solution to a second 1,000-ml volumetric flask, acidify with 5 ml of dilute sulfuric acid solution (1 in 5), dilute to volume with water, and mix. Discard after 1 week. On the day of use, transfer 10.0 ml of the second solution to a 100-ml volumetric flask, acidify with 5 ml of dilute sulfuric acid (1 in 5), dilute to volume with water, and mix. Each ml of this solution contains 1 g of Hg. Transfer 2.0 ml of this solution (2 g of Hg) to a 50-ml beaker, and add 20 ml of water, 1 ml of dilute sulfuric acid solution (1 in 5), and 1 ml of potassium permanganate solution (1 in 25). Cover the beaker with a watch glass, boil for a few sec, and cool.
Sample Preparation
Prepare as directed in the individual monograph.
Procedure
Assemble the aerating apparatus as shown in Figure 1, with bottles c and d empty and stopcock b in the bypass position. Connect the apparatus to the absorption cell (f) in the instrument, and adjust the air or nitrogen flow rate so that, in the following procedure, maximum absorption and reproductibility are obained without excessive foaming in the test solution. Obtain a baseline reading at 253.6 nm, following the manufacturer's instructions for operating the instrument. Treat the Standard Preparation as follows: Destroy the excess permanganate by adding a 1-in-10 solution of hydroxylamine hydrochloride, dropwise, until the solution is colourless. Immediately wash the solution into bottle c with water, and dilute to the 60-ml mark with water. Add 2 ml of 10% stannous chloride solution (prepared fresh each week by dissolving 20 g of SnCl22H2O in 40 ml of warm hydrochloric acid and diluting with 160 ml of water), and immediately reconnect bottle c to the aerating apparatus. Turn stopcock b from the bypass to the aerating position, and obtain the reading on the recorder. Disconnect bottle c from the aerating apparatus, discard the Standard Preparation mixture, wash bottle c with water,
and repeat the foregoing procedure using the Sample Preparation; any absorbance produced by the Sample Preparation does not exceed that produced by the Standard Preparation.
METHOD I
Preparation of Standard
Transfer 2.0 ml of the Selenium standard solution into a 150-ml beaker, add 50 ml of 0.25 N nitric acid, and mix.
Sample Preparation
Transfer into a 1,000-ml combustion flask the amount of sample specified in the individual monograph (and the magnesium oxide, where required), and proceed as directed under Oxygen Flask Combustion, using 0.5 N nitric acid as the absorbing liquid. (Note. If the sample contains water of hydration or more than 1% of moisture, dry it at 140 for 2 h before combustion.) Upon completion of combustion, place a few ml of water in the cup or lip of the combustion flask, loosen the stopper of the flask, and rinse the stopper, sample holder, and sides of the flask with about 25 ml of water. Transfer the solution into a 150-ml beaker, heat gently to boiling, boil for 10 min and cool.
Procedure
Using dilute ammonium hydroxide (1 in 2), adjust the pH of the Standard solution, of the Sample preparation, and of 50 ml of 0.25 N nitric acid, to serve as the blank, to 2.0 0.2. Add 200 mg of hydroxylamine hydrochloride to each beaker, swirl gently to dissolve, then without delay add 5 ml of 2.3-Diaminonaphthalene solution to each solution, and mix. Cover each beaker with a watch glass, and allow to stand at room temperature for 100 min. Transfer the solutions into separate separators with the aid of about 10 ml of water, extract each solution with 5.0 ml of cyclohexane, shaking each separator vigorously for 2 min, and allow the layers to separate. Discard the aqueous phases, and centrifuge the cyclohexane extracts to remove any traces of water. Determine the absorbance of each extract in a 1-cm cell at the maximum at about 380 nm, with a suitable spectrophotometer, using the blank to set the instrument. The absorbance of the extract from the Sample preparation is not greater than that from the Standard Solution when a 200-mg sample is tested, or not greater than one-half the absorbance of the extract from the Standard solution when a 100-mg sample is tested.
METHOD II
Standard Preparation
Transfer 2.0 ml of the Selenium standard solution into a 150-ml beaker, add 50 ml of 2 N hydrochloric acid, and mix.
Sample Preparation
Transfer into a 150-ml beaker the amount of sample specified in the individual monograph, dissolve in 25 ml of 4 N hydrochloric acid, swirling if necessary to effect solution, heat gently to boiling, and digest on a steam bath for 15 min. Remove from heat, add 25 ml of water, and allow to cool to room temperature.
Procedure
Place the beakers containing the Standard preparation and the Sample preparation in a fume hood. Cautiously add 5 ml of ammonium hydroxide to each beaker and to a third beaker containing 50 ml of 2 N hydrochloric acid to serve as the blank. Allow the solutions to cool, and then adjust the pH of each solution to 2.0 0.2 with dilute ammonium hydroxide (1 in 2). Continue as directed under Procedure in Method I, beginning with "Add 200 mg of hydroxylamine hydrochloride...".
Procedure
Caution. The analyst should wear safety glasses and should use a suitable safety shield between himself and the apparatus. Further safety measures should be observed as necessary to ensure maximum protection of the analyst. Furthermore, the flask must be scrupulously clean and free from even traces of organic solvents. Samples containing water of hydration or more than 1% of moisture should be dried at 140 for 2 h before combustion. Accurately weigh the amount of sample specified in the monograph. Solids should be weighed on a 4-cm square piece of halide-free filter paper, which should be folded around the sample. Liquid samples not exceeding 0.2 ml in volume should be weighed in tared cellulose acetate capsules [available as Catalog Nos. 6513-C80 (100 capsules) and 6513-C82 (1,000 capsules) from the Arthur H. Thomas Co.]; gelatin capsules are satisfactory for liquid sample exceeding 0.2 ml in volume. Note. Gelatin capsules may contain significant amounts of combined halide or sulfur, in which case a blank determination should be made as necessary. Place the sample, together with a filter paper fuse-strip, in the platinum gauze sample holder. Place the absorbing liquid, as specified in the individual monograph or general test, in the flask, moisten the joint of the stopper with water, and flush the air from the flask with a stream of rapidly flowing oxygen, swirling the liquid to facilitate its taking up oxygen. Note. Saturation of the liquid with oxygen is essential for successful performance of this procedure. Ignite the fuse-strip by suitable means. If the strip is ignited outside the flask, immediately plunge the sample holder into the flask, invert the flask so that the absorption solution makes a seal around the stopper, and hold the stopper firmly in place. If the ignition is carried out in a closed system, the inversion of the flask may be omitted. After combustion is complete, shake the flask vigorously, and allow to stand for not less than 10 min with intermittent shaking. Then continue as directed in the individual monograph.
NITROGEN DETERMINATION (Kjeldahl Method)( ISO R-9371969 may be used as an alternate method.)
CAUTION: Provide adequate ventilation in the laboratory and do not permit accumulation of exposed mercury. Note. All reagents should be nitrogen-free, where available, or otherwise very low in nitrogen content.
METHOD I
This method should be used unless otherwise directed in the individual monograph. It is not applicable for certain nitrogen-containing compounds that do not yield their entire nitrogen content upon digestion with sulfuric acid.
nitrogen-free filter paper to facilitate the transfer if desired. To the flask add 10 g of powdered potassium sulfate or anhydrous sodium sulfate, 500 mg of powdered cupric sulfate, and 20 ml of sulfuric acid. Gently heat the mixture, keeping the flask inclined at about a 45 angle, and after frothing has ceased, boil briskly until the solution has remained clear green in colour or almost colourless for 30 min. Cool, add 150 ml of water, mix, and cool again. Cautiously pour 100 ml of sodium hydroxide solution (2 in 5) down the inside of the flask so that it forms a layer under the acid solution, then add a few pieces of granulated zinc. Connect the flask to a distillation apparatus consisting of a Kjeldahl connecting bulb and a condenser, the delivery tube from which extends well beneath the surface of 50 ml of boric acid solution (1 in 25) contained in a 500-ml flask or bottle. Gently rotate the contents of the Kjeldahl flask to mix, and distil until about two-thirds of the solution has been collected in the receiving flask. To the receiving flask add methyl red/methylene blue TS, and titrate with 0.5 N sulfuric acid. Perform a blank determination substituting 2 g of sucrose for the sample and make the necessary corrections. Each ml of 0.5 N acid is equivalent to 7.003 mg of nitrogen. Note. If it is known that the substance to be determined has a low nitrogen content, 0.1 N acid may be used in place of the 0.5 N solution, in which case each ml of 0.1 N acid is equivalent to 1.401 mg of nitrogen.
METHOD II (Semimicro)
Transfer an accurately weighed or measured quantity of the sample equivalent to about 2 or 3 mg of nitrogen, to the digestion flask of a semimicro Kjeldahl apparatus. Add 1 g of a powdered mixture of potassium sulfate and cupric sulfate (10 to 1), using a fine jet of water to wash down any material adhering to the neck of the flask, then pour 7 ml of sulfuric acid down the inside wall of the flask to rinse it. Add cautiously, down the inside of the flask, 1 ml of 30% hydrogen peroxide, swirling the flask during the addition (CAUTION. Do not add any peroxide during the digestion.) Heat over a free flame or an electric heater until the solution has attained a clear blue colour and the walls of the flask are free from carbonized material. Cautiously add 20 ml of water, cool, then add through a funnel 30 ml of sodium hydroxide solution (2 in 5), and rinse the funnel with 10 ml of water. Connect the flask to a steam distillation apparatus and immediately begin the distillation with steam. Collect the distillate in 15 ml of boric acid solution (1 in 25) to which has been added 3 drops of methyl red/methylene blue TS and enough water to cover the end of the condensing tube. Continue passing the steam until 80 to 100 ml of distillate has been collected, then remove the absorption flask, rinse the end of the condenser tube with a small quantity of water, and titrate with 0.01 N sulfuric acid. Each ml of 0.01 N acid is equivalent to 0.140 mg (140 g) of nitrogen. When more than 2 to 3 mg of nitrogen is present in the measured quantity of the substance to be determined, 0.02 or 0.1 N sulfuric acid may be used in the titration if at least 15 ml of titrant is required. If the total dry weight of the material taken is greater
than 100 mg, increase proportionately the quantities of sulfuric acid and sodium hydroxide added before distillation.
NON-VOLATILE RESIDUE
Unless otherwise indicated, transfer 100 ml of the sample into a tared 125-ml platinum evaporating dish, previously heated at 105 to constant weight, and evaporate the sample to dryness on a steam bath. Heat the dish at 105 for 30 min or to constant weight, cool in a desiccator, and weigh.
2 x (18.02/230.08) x (W/V), in which W = the weight, in mg, of sodium tartrate dihydrate, V = the volume, in ml, of the Reagent consumed in the second titration, and 18.02 and 230.08 are, respectively, the molecular weights of water and sodium tartrate dihydrate. (b) For the precise determination of more than trace amounts of water (i.e., more than about 1%), distilled water is used as the reference substance. If this method is used, quickly add 25 to 250 mg of distilled water, accurately weighed, to the methanol, and again titrate to the endpoint with the Reagent. Calculate the water equivalence factor, F, in mg of water per ml of Reagent, by the formula W/V, in which W is the weight, in mg, of distilled water, and V is the volume, in ml, of the Reagent consumed in the second titration.
Secondary standardization
Prepare a Water-Methanol Solution by diluting 2 ml of water to 1,000 ml with methanol. Standardize this solution by titrating 25.0 ml with the Reagent, previously standardized as directed under Primary standardization above. Calculate the water content, in mg per ml, of the Water-Methanol Solution by the formula V'F/25, in which V' is the volume, in ml, of the Reagent consumed, and F is the water equivalence factor of the Reagent, determined as directed under Primary standardization. The water content of the WaterMethanol Solution should be determined weekly and the Reagent standardized against it periodically as needed.
Procedure
Note. Determine the water content by the Direct Titration Procedure, unless otherwise directed.
Direct titration
Unless otherwise directed, place about 35 to 40 ml of methanol in the titration vessel, and titrate with the Reagent to the endpoint, disregarding the volume consumed. Quickly transfer to the titration vessel an accurately weighed or measured quantity of the sample, preferably containing 10 to 50 mg of water, stir vigorously, and again titrate to the endpoint. The water content of the sample, in mg, is obtained by multiplying the volume of Reagent used in titrating the sample by the equivalence factor, F, of the Reagent.
Residual titration
Unless otherwise directed, place about 35 to 40 ml of methanol in the titration vessel, and titrate with the Reagent to the endpoint, disregarding the volume consumed. Quickly transfer to the titration vessel an accurately weighed or measured quantity of the sample, preferably containing 10 to 50 mg of water, stir vigorously, and add an accurately measured excess of the Reagent. Allow sufficient time for the reaction to
reach completion, and titrate the unconsumed Reagent with standardized WaterMethanol Solution to the endpoint. The water content in the sample, in mg, is obtained by multiplying the net volume of the Reagent used in titrating the sample by the equivalence factor, F, of the Reagent.
III. METHODS FOR DETERMINING ORGANIC COMPONENTS o AROMATIC HYDROCARBONS DETERMINATION (Based on ASTM D 2267-67.) o CARBON DIOXIDE DETERMINATION BY DECARBOXYLATION o CHLORINATED ORGANIC COMPOUNDS LIMIT TEST o 1,4-DIOXANE LIMIT TEST o ETHOXYL AND METHOXYL GROUP DETERMINATION o GUM CONSTITUENTS IDENTIFICATION o MALEIC ACID LIMIT TEST o OXALATE LIMIT TEST o READILY CARBONIZABLE SUBSTANCES o REDUCING SUBSTANCES (AS GLUCOSE) o RESIDUAL SOLVENT o RESIDUAL SOLVENT LIMIT TEST
Apparatus
Chromatograph
Any chromatograph, commercially available or custom designed, which can be operated at 100 and is equipped with a conventional dual-pass thermal conductivity detector, may be used.
Strip-Chart Recorder
A recording potentiometer with a full-scale deflection of 10 mV or less should be used. The full-scale response time of the recorder should not exceed 2 sec. If a manual method of integration (such as triangulation method, paper cutout method, or planimeter) is employed, the chart speed should be at least 150 cm per h in order to minimize errors in peak area measurement. This requirement is, of course, waived if a ball-and-disc or an electronic integrator is employed.
Microsyringe
A microsyringe 10-l capacity, is needed for sample introduction.
Volumetric Flask
100-ml capacity.
Volumetric Pipets
1, 2, 5, 10, 15, 20, and 25-ml capacity.
Column diameter, mm, ID 3 Column length, m Column temperature Carrier gas Flow rate, ml per min Sample size, l 2 100 0.5 Helium 100 0.5 4
Procedure
The quantitative injection approach to quantitative analysis is employed in this method. This approach depends upon a repeatable quantitative injection of a small quantity (4 l) of sample. It is necessary to develop calibration factors or curves for each aromatic hydrocarbon to be determined. Ethylbenzene, para and metaxylene are not individually resolved. One of the three isomers or a representative mixture of the three should be used to establish the calibration factor of this group of components. Either of the following procedures may be utilized for calibration of the gas chromatograph and quantitative determination of the concentration of the various aromatic hydrocarbons:
Procedure A
Preparation of the Sample
Prepare a standard sample containing each of the aromatics of interest in approximately the concentration to be encountered in the sample to be analyzed. In order to minimize measurement errors, the standard sample should be prepared by using volumetric pipets to add the desired quantity of each aromatic to a 100-ml volumetric flask and then diluting to the mark with n-heptane. The temperature of the various hydrocarbons should, of course, be at or near the temperature at which the pipets and flask were calibrated (normally 20). Table II. Retention Time Data
Compounds n-Hexane n-Heptane n-Octane n-Nonane n-Decane n-Undecane Hexene-1 Heptene-1 Octene-1 Nonene-1 Undecene-1 Methylcyclopentane Cyclohexane Methylcyclohexane Ethylcyclohexane
Boiling Point C Final Retention Time, min 68.74 98.43 125.66 150.80 174.12 195.89 63.49 93.64 121.28 146.87 192.67 71.81 80.74 100.93 131.78 0.61 0.67 0.91 1.24 1.85 2.81 0.65 0.81 1.05 1.53 3.69 0.73 0.84 0.97 1.45
2.07 2.04 3.20 4.77 4.89 6.41 6.01 7.19 8.43 10.36
Chromatograph the standard sample several times taking care to inject exactly 4 l each time. Retention time data obtained from the calibration chromatograms may be used to identify the various aromatics in the samples to be analyzed. Measure the peak area of each aromatic peak by any of the following means; triangulation, planimeter, paper cutout, ball-and-disc indicator, or electronic integrator.
Calculation
Calculate a calibration factor for each aromatic, from the average peak area obtained from the several calibration chromatograms, as follows: K = v / PA Where K = calibration factor, v = volume percentage of the particular aromatic hydrocarbon in the standard sample, and PA = peak area of the aromatic peak in arbitrary units (square centimeters, square inches, counts, etc.) After determining a calibration factor for each aromatic, carefully inject exactly 4 l of the sample to be analyzed. The time required for the analysis will vary from 2 to 10 min depending upon the molecular weight range of the sample. Measure the peak areas of the aromatics as before and finally calculate the concentration of each aromatic as follows:
v = PA x K where v = volume percentage of the aromatic, PA = peak area of the aromatic peak in arbitrary units, and K = calibration factor for the aromatic.
Report
Report the volume percentage of each aromatic hydrocarbon to the nearest 0.1% by volume.
Procedure B
Preparation of the Sample
Prepare several standard samples containing increasingly higher concentrations of each aromatic hydrocarbon to be determined, again using volumetric pipets and flask and n-heptane as the diluent. (For example, if one wished to calibrate the instrument over the 0 to 25% by volume range, standard samples containing 2, 5, 10, 15, 20 and 25% by volume of each component might be prepared.) Inject 4 l of each standard sample and measure the areas of the aromatic peaks thus produced. Make a plot of volume percentage versus peak area for each aromatic.
Calculation
After obtaining calibration curves for each aromatic inject exactly 4 l of the sample to be analyzed and measure the areas of the aromatic peaks. Calculate the concentration of each aromatic directly from the calibration curve.
Report
Report the volume percentage of each aromatic hydrocarbon to the nearest 0.1% by volume. Note 1: The calibration described in Procedure A is somewhat less laborious than that of Procedure B; however, the response of the thermal conductivity detector and the recorder is assumed to be linear in Procedure A. Although linear response will be obtained over the concentration range of interest with most gas chromatographic systems of this nature, no assumptions in this regard are made in Procedure B. A slight nonlinearity in either the detector or the recorder will be evident from the calibration curves. Note 2: It cannot be overemphasized that the accuracy of the quantitative injection approach depends upon the ability of the analyst to inject repeatedly a small quantity of sample. The accuracy of this approach is adversely affected by relatively small changes in column temperature, carrier gas flow rate, and detector cell current. These variables must, therefore, be closely controlled. In addition, check the instrument calibration a minimum of once each day. This can be done very easily and quickly by
analyzing a reference sample (such as a retained quantity of light naphtha, reformate, or gasoline) which was initially analyzed immediately after the calibration factors or curves described in Procedure A and B were obtained. If the reference sample analysis is not that which was initially obtained within the limits of repeatability, the instrument should be recalibrated. Note 3: The following criteria should be used for judging the acceptability of results (95% confidence).
Repeatability
Duplicate results by the same operator should be considered suspect if they differ by more than the following amounts:
Total aromatics 1 to 50
Reproducibility
The results submitted by each of two laboratories should be considered suspect if the two results differ by more than the following amounts:
1 to 10 1 to 10 1 to 3 1 to 10
8 8 28 14 8
Total aromatics 1 to 50
Procedure
Weigh to the nearest 0.1 mg, 250 mg of the sample, previously dried in vacuum for 4 h at 60. Transfer into the reaction flask, D, add 25 ml of 0.1 N hydrochloric acid, insert several boiling chips, and connect the flask to the reflux condenser, F, using syrupy phosphoric acid as a lubricant. Note. Stopcock grease may be used for the other connections. Check the system for air leaks by forcing mercury up into the inner tube of the mercury valve, B, to a height of about 5 cm. Turn off the pressure using the stopcock, M. If the mercury level does not fall appreciably after 1 to 2 min, the apparatus may be considered to be free from leaks. Draw carbon dioxide-free air through the apparatus at a rate of 3,000 to 6,000 ml per h. Raise the heating mantle, E, to the flask, heat the sample to boiling, and boil gently for 2 min. Turn off and lower the mantle, and allow the sample to cool for 15 min. Charge the delivery tube, G, with 23 ml of concentrated hydrochloric acid. Disconnect the absorption tower, L, rapidly transfer 25.0 ml of 0.25 N sodium hydroxide into the tower, add 5 drops of n-butanol, and again connect the
absorption tower. Draw carbon dioxide-free air through the apparatus at the rate of about 2,000 ml per h, add the hydrochloric acid to the reaction flask through the delivery tube, raise the heating mantle, and heat the reaction mixture to boiling. After 2 h, discontinue the current of air and heating. Force the sodium hydroxide solution down into the flask, K, using gentle air pressure, and then rinse down the absorption tower with three 15-ml portions of water, forcing each washing into the flask with air pressure. Remove the flask, and add to it 10 ml of a 10% solution of barium chloride (BaCl22H2O). Stopper the flask, shake gently for about 2 min, add phenolphthalein TS, and titrate with 0.1 N hydrochloric acid. Perform a blank determination. Each ml of 0.25 N sodium hydroxide consumed is equivalent to 5.5 mg of carbon dioxide (CO2).
Figure.
Standard Preparation
Prepare a solution of 1,4-dioxane in water (100 g/ml). Keep the solution refrigerated and prepare fresh weekly.
Sample Preparation
Transfer 20 g of the sample, accurately weighed, into a 50-ml round-bottom flask containing a 24/40 ground-glass neck. Semisolid or waxy samples should be liquefied by heating on a steam bath before making the transfer. Add 2.0 ml of water to the flask for crystalline samples, and 1.0 ml for liquid, semisolid, or waxy samples. Place a small Teflon covered stirring bar in the flask, stopper, and stir to mix. Immerse the flask in an ice bath, and chill for about 1 min.
Distillation
Wrap heating tape around the tube connecting the Chromaflex tube (D) and the roundbottom flask (E), and apply about 10 V to the tape. Apply a light coating of high-vacuum silicone grease to the ground-glass joints, and connect the Chromaflex tube to the 10/30 joint and the round-bottom flask to the 24/40 joint. Immerse the vacuum trap in a Dewar flask filled with liquid nitrogen, close stopcocks A and B, open stopcock C, and begin evacuating the system with a vacuum pump. Prepare a slush bath from powdered dry ice and methanol, and raise the bath to the neck of the round-bottom flask. After freezing the contents of the flask for about 10 min, and when the vacuum system is operating at 0.05 mm pressure or lower, open stopcock A for 20 sec, and then close it. Remove the slush bath, and allow the flask to warm in air for about 1 min. Immerse the flask in a water bath at 20 to 25, and after about 5 min warm the water in the bath to 35 to 40 (sufficient to liquefy most samples) while stirring slowly but constantly with the magnetic bar. Cool the water in the bath by adding ice, and chill for about 2 min. Replace the water bath with the slush bath, freeze the contents of the flask for about 10 min, then open stopcock A for 20 sec, and close it. Remove the slush bath, and repeat the heating steps as before, this time reaching a final temperature of 45 to 50 or a temperature necessary to melt the sample completely. If there is any condensation in the tube connecting the round-bottom flask to the Chromaflex tube, slowly increase the voltage to the heating tape and heat until condensation disappears. Stir with the magnetic stirrer throughout the following steps: Very slowly immerse the Chromaflex tube in the Dewar flask containing liquid nitrogen. Caution. When there is liquid distillate in the Chromaflex tube, the tube must be immersed in the nitrogen very slowly or the tube will break. Water will begin to distil into the tube. As ice forms in the tube, raise the Dewar flask to keep the liquid nitrogen level only slightly below the level of ice in the tube. When water begins to freeze in the neck of the 10/30 joint, or when liquid nitrogen reaches the 2.0ml graduation mark on the Chromaflex tube, remove the Dewar flask and let the ice melt without heating. After the ice has melted, check the volume of water that has distilled, and repeat the sequence of chilling and thawing until at least 0.9 ml of water has been collected. Freeze the tube once again for 2 min, and release the vacuum first by opening stopcock B, followed by stopcock A. Remove the Chromaflex tube from the apparatus, close it with a greased stopper, and let the ice melt without heating. Mix the
contents of the tube by swirling, note the volume of distillate, and dilute to 2.0 ml with water, if necessary.
Chromatography
Use a gas chromatograph equipped with a flame-ionization detector. Under typical conditions, the instrument contains a 4-mm (id) x 1.83 m glass column packed with 80/100- or 100/120-mesh Chromosorb 104 or equivalent. The column is maintained isothermally at about 140, the injection port at 200, and the detector at 250. Nitrogen is the carrier gas, flowing at a rate of about 35 ml per min. Install an oxygen scrubber between the carrier gas line and the column. The column should be conditioned for about 72 h at 250 with 30 to 40 ml per min carrier flow. Note. Chromosorb 104 is oxygen-sensitive. Both new and used columns should be flushed with carrier gas for 30 to 60 min before heating each time they are installed in the gas chromatograph. Inject a volume of the Standard Preparation, accurately measured, to give about 20% of maximum recorder response. Where possible, keep the injection volume in the range of 2 to 4 l, and use the solvent-flush technique to minimize errors associated with injection volumes. In the same manner, inject an identical volume of the Sample Preparation. The height of the peak produced by the Sample Preparation does not exceed that produced by the Standard Preparation.
Procedure
Prepare the apparatus by placing in trap D, through the funnel K or tube F and the connecting side-arm, a volume sufficient to make trap D half-full of a suspension of about 60 mg of red phosphorus in 100 ml of water. Rinse the tube F and the side-arm with water into trap D. Dry carefully the absorption tube F and pour down the funnel K 7 ml of bromine acetic acid TS. Weigh 0.05 g of the sample, to the nearest 0.1 mg, in a tared gelatin capsule, and place it in the boiling flask along with a few glass beads or pieces of porous plate. Add 6 ml of hydriodic acid TS and attach the flask to the condenser, using a few drops of the acid to seal the junction. Bubble carbon dioxide through the apparatus at the rate of about 2 bubbles per sec. Place the boiling flask in an oil bath heated to 150, and continue the reaction for 40 min. Drain the contents of the absorption tube F into a 500 ml conical flask containing 10 ml of a 1 in 4 solution of sodium acetate. Rinse tube F with water, adding the rinsings to the flask, and finally dilute with water to about 125 ml. Add formic acid, dropwise, with swirling, until the
reddish-brown colour of the bromine is discharged, then add 3 additional drops. A total of 12 to 15 drops are usually required. Let stand for 3 min, and add 15 ml of dilute sulfuric acid TS and 3 g of potassium iodide, and titrate immediately with 0.1 N sodium thiosulfate, using starch TS as indicator near the endpoint. Perform a blank determination, including also a gelatin capsule and make any necessary correction. Each ml of 0.1 N sodium thiosulfate is equivalent to 0.517 mg of (-OCH3) or 0.751 mg of (-OC2H5).
DIAGRAM FOR THE DETERMINATION OF ETHOXYL AND METHOXYL GROUPS (Dimensions in mm)
A. Boiling flask B. Side-arm capillary, 1-mm internal diameter C. Condenser D. Trap E. 4 slots, each 1 x 3 mm F. Absorption tube G. 2-mm stopcock H. Hooks and tension springs each side I. 14/20 T joint K. Funnel
Standard solution
Transfer to a 100-ml volumetric flask about 100 mg, accurately weighed, of maleic acid of the highest purity available, dissolve in about 10 ml of water, then dilute to volume with water, and mix.
Sample solution
Transfer about 50 g of the sample, accurately weighed, into a 250-ml beaker, add 80 ml of water, and stir for 10 min with a mechanical stirrer. Filter, using suction, and wash with about 40 ml of water. Transfer the combined filtrate and washings to a 250-ml beaker, add an additional 50-g sample, accurately weighed, to the beaker, and repeat the stirring, filtration, and washing procedure. Transfer the combined filtrate and washings to a 250-ml volumetric flask, add 2 drops of phenolphthalein TS, then add sodium hydroxide TS, with stirring, until a light pink colour persists for at least 30 sec and dilute to volume with water.
Procedure
Transfer 10.0 ml of the Sample Solution into a 100-ml volumetric flask, add 20 ml of Buffer Solution, dilute to volume with water, and mix (Solution A). Rinse a polarographic cell with a portion of the solution, then add a suitable volume of the solution to the cell, immerse it in a water bath regulated at 24.5 to 25.5, and deaerate by bubbling purified nitrogen through the solution for at least 6 min. Insert the dropping mercury electrode of a suitable polarograph, and record the polarogram from -1 to -2 V, using a saturated calomel electrode as the reference electrode. Determine the height of the wave occurring at the half-wave potential near -1.36 V. In the same manner polarograph a solution prepared by adding 10.0 ml of the Sample Solution, 20 ml of the Buffer Solution, and 2.0 ml of the Standard Solution to a 100-ml volumetric flask and diluting to volume with water (Solution B). Calculate the weight, in mg, of maleic acid in the total weight of sample taken by the formula: 2500C x A/(B-A) in which A is the wave height of Solution A, B is the wave height of Solution B, and C is the concentration, in mg per ml of added maleic acid in Solution B.
Matching Fluids
For purposes of comparison, a series of twenty matching fluids, each designated by a letter of the alphabet, is provided, the composition of each being as indicated in the following table. To prepare the matching fluid specified, pipet the prescribed volumes of the colorimetric test solutions (TSC) and water into one of the matching containers, and mix the solutions in the container. Matching Fluids
Matching Fluid A B C D E F G H
Parts of Cobaltous Chloride TSC 0.1 0.3 0.1 0.3 0.4 0.3 0.5 0.2
Parts of Ferric Chloride TSC 0.4 0.9 0.6 0.6 1.2 1.2 1.2 1.5
Parts of Cupric Sulfate TSC 0.1 0.3 0.1 0.4 0.3 0.0 0.2 0.0
Parts of Water 4.4 8.5 4.2 3.7 3.1 3.5 3.1 3.3
I J K L M N O P Q R S T
0.4 0.4 0.5 0.8 0.1 0.0 0.1 0.2 0.2 0.3 0.2 0.5
2.2 3.5 4.5 3.8 2.0 4.9 4.8 0.4 0.3 0.4 0.1 0.5
0.1 0.1 0.0 0.1 0.1 0.1 0.1 0.1 0.1 0.2 0.0 0.4
2.3 1.0 0.0 0.3 2.8 0.0 0.0 4.3 4.4 4.1 4.7 3.6
Note: Solution A-D, very light brownish yellow.; solutions E-L, yellow through reddish yellow; solutions M-O, greenish yellow; solutions P-T, light pink.
METHOD II
Dissolve 7 g of the sample in 35 ml of water in a 400-ml beaker and mix. Add 25 ml of cupric sulfate TS and 25 ml of alkaline tartrate TS. Cover the beaker with glass, heat the mixture at such a rate that it comes to a boil in approximately 4 min and boils for exactly 2 min. Filter the precipitated cuprous oxide through a tared Gooch crucible previously washed with hot water, ethanol, and ether, and dried at 100 for 30 min. Thoroughly wash the collected cuprous oxide on the filter with hot water, then with 10 ml of ethanol and finally with 10 ml of ether, and dry at 100 for 30 min. The weight of the cuprous oxide does not exceed that prescribed in the individual monograph.
RESIDUAL SOLVENT
This procedure is for the determination of acetone, ethylene dichloride, hexane, isopropanol, methanol, dichloromethane, and trichloroethylene residues.
Apparatus
- Distilling Head. Use a Clevenger trap designed for use with oils heavier than water. A suitable design is shown in the Figure.
Clavenger Trap (Dimensions in mm) (a) 17% by weight of Ucon 75-H-90,000 on 35/80-mesh Chromosorb W; (b) 20% Ucon LB-135 on 35/80-mesh Chromosorb W; (c) 15% Ucon LB-1715 on 60/80-mesh Chromosorb W; or (d) Porapak Q 50/60-mesh. Follow the conditions described under Procedure, and inject the same amount of Toluene as will be injected in the analysis of the solvents. If impurities interfering with the test are present, they will appear as peaks occurring before the Toluene peak and should be removed by fractional distillation. Benzene. The benzene used for this analysis should be free from interfering impurities. The purity may be determined as described under Toluene.
Detergent and Antifoam. Any such products that are free from volatile compounds may be used. If volatile compounds are present, they may be removed by prolonged boiling of the aqueous solutions of the products. Reference Solution A. Prepare a solution in Toluene containing 2.500 g/kg of benzene. If the Toluene available contains benzene as the only impurity, the benzene level can be determined by gas chromatography and sufficient benzene added to bring the level to 2.500 g/kg. Reference Solution B. Prepare a solution containing 0.63% v/w of acetone in water. Sample Preparation A (all solvents except methanol). Place 50.0 g of the sample, 1.0 ml of Reference Solution A, 10 g of anhydrous sodium sulfate, 50 ml of water, and a small amount each of Detergent and Antifoam in a 250-ml round-bottom flask with a 24/40 ground glass neck. Attach the Distilling Head, a 400-mm water-cooled condenser, and a receiver, and collect approximately 15 ml of distillate. Add 15 g of anhydrous potassium carbonate to the distillate, cool while shaking, and allow the phases to separate. All the solvents except methanol will be present in the toluene layer, which is used in the Procedure. Draw off the aqueous layer for use in Sample Preparation B. Sample Preparation B (methanol only). Place the aqueous layer obtained from Sample Preparation A in a 50-ml round-bottom distilling flask with a 24/40 ground-glass neck, add a few boiling chips and 1.0 ml of Reference Solution B, and collect approximately 1 ml of distillate, which will contain any methanol from the sample, together with acetone as the internal standard. The distillate is used in the Procedure.
Procedure
Use a gas chromatograph equipped with a hot-wire detector and a suitable sampleinjection system or on-column injection. Under typical conditions, the instrument contains a 63 mm (od) x 183 to 244 cm column maintained isothermally at 70 to 80. The flow rate of dry carrier gas is 50 to 80 ml per min and the sample size is 15 to 20 l (for the hot-wire detector). The column selected for use in the chromatograph depends on the components to be analyzed and, to a certain extent, on the preference of the analyst. The columns 1, 2, 3 and 4, as described under Toluene, may be used as follows: 1. This column separates acetone and methanol from their aqueous solution. It may be used for the separation and analysis of hexane, acetone, and trichloroethylene in the toluene layer from Sample Preparation A. The elution order is acetone, methanol, and water, or hexane, acetone, isopropanol plus dichloromethane, benzene and trichloroethylene plus toluene. 2. This column separates dichloromethane and isopropanol. The elution order is hexane plus acetone, dichloromethane, isopropanol, benzene, trichloroethylene, and toluene. 3. This is the best general purpose column, except for the determination of methanol. The elution order is hexane, acetone, benzene, and toluene. 4. This column is used for the determination of methanol, which elutes just after the large water peak.
Calibration
Determine the response of the detector for known ratios of solvents by injecting known mixtures of solvents and benzene in toluene. The levels of the solvents and benzene in toluene should be of the same magnitude as they will be present in the sample under analysis.
Calculation
Calculate the areas of the solvents with respect to benzene, and then calculate the calibration factor, F, as follows: F (solvent) = (weight solvent / weight benzene) x (area of benzene / area of solvent) The recovery of the various solvents from the sample, with respect to the recovery of benzene, is as follows: hexane - 52% acetone - 85% isopropanol - 100% dichloromethane - 87.5% trichloroethylene - 113% methanol - 87% Calculate the mg/kg of residual solvent (except methanol) by the formula: Residual solvent = [43.4 x F(solvent) x 100] / % recovery of solvent x (area of solvent / area of benzene) in which 43.4 is the mg/kg of benzene internal standard, related to the 50 g sample taken for analysis. Calculate the mg/kg of residual methanol by the formula: Residual methanol (100 F / 0.87) x (area of methanol / area of acetone) in which 100 is the concentration in mg/kg of acetone internal standard, related to the 50 g sample taken for analysis, and F is the calibration factor for methanol determined by using known mixture of methanol and acetone.
Apparatus
The method given relates to the ordinary equipement used for GLC (See General Methods*) employing a packed column and a flame-ionization detector. Any apparatus giving efficiency and resolution for the specific solvents is suitable. An appropriate head space (See Headspace Gas Chromatography under Chromatography in General Analytical Techniques in this volume) analyzer may be used. Head space chromatography provides a rapid and an accurate test to evaluate solvent residues. Quantitative determinations are carried out by calibration with an internal standard method or by the method of known addition of the solvent to be detected. It is also sometimes possible to carry out the determination by calibration with an external standard method, and for routine analysis to carry out a limit test.
Reagents
Carrier gas: Inert gas (nitrogen, helium, argon, etc.) thoroughly dried and containing less than 10 mg/kg of oxygen. Auxiliary gases: 1) Hydrogen (99.9% min) free from organic impurities, and 2) air or oxygen, free from organic impurities. Reference standards: Solvent or a mixture of solvents of known composition, similar to the matter to be analyzed.
Sample preparation
Liquid samples are directly analyzed and solid samples can be dissolved in an appropriate solvent or pulverized and suspended in a head space vial; solid samples can be also diluted in dispersing agents.
Internal standard
Prepare a solution containing 20 to 100 g/ml of the standard in an appropriate solvent. Traces of organic solvents are commonly determined by GLC. A generally applicable procedure is applied with the following experimental conditions. Stationary phase: 67% P.E.G. and 33% bis (2-ethylhexyl-sebacate) applied at 15% on silanized silicagel, a working temperature of 60 and a flame ionisation detector. The following table gives for information some experimental conditions which can be adopted in each particular case.
Solvents
Detector Temp. C
140
140
150
Carbowax 1540 on chromosorb W, 80/100 mesh 150 oven 80 15% carbowax on chromosorb W, 80/100 mesh 150150 Porapak Q 120 15% carbowax 1500 on celite 150 60/80 oven 60 4% OV 101 on chromosorb G FID 200 or AW-DMCS 80/100 mesh (63Ni-ECD) oven 60
N2 30 ml/min
150150
150
N220 ml/min
150
IV. METHODS FOR FOOD COLOURS o CHLORIDE AS SODIUM CHLORIDE DETERMINATION o CHLOROFORM INSOLUBLE MATTER o COLOURING MATTERS Total Content by Spectrophotometry Total Content by Titration with Titanous Chloride Method of Assay of Certain Food Colours (Tentative Comments are invited on the use of this method as an alternative) Subsidiary Colouring Matter Content Determination by Paper Chromatography Identification and Rapid Limit Test by Thin-Layer Chromatography (Tentative*) o ETHER EXTRACTABLE MATTER METHOD I METHOD II o HYDROCHLORIC ACID INSOLUBLE MATTERS IN LAKES o LEUCO BASE IN SULPHONATED TRIARYLMETHANE COLOURS o ORGANIC COMPOUNDS OTHER THAN COLOURING MATTERS Determination by Liquid Chromatography Determination by Column Chromatography o SULFATE AS SODIUM SULFATE o UNSULPHONATED PRIMARY AROMATIC AMINES o WATER CONTENT (LOSS ON DRYING) o WATER INSOLUBLE MATTER
Procedure
Weigh 0.5 - 1.0 g of the dye sample, dissolve in 100 ml of water, and acidify with 5 ml of 1.5 N nitric acid solution. Place the silver electrode in the colour solution and connect the calomel electrode to the solution by means of the saturated potassium sulfate bridge. The saturated potassium sulfate bridge may be eliminated by using a glass electrode as the reference electrode; this simplifies the apparatus considerably, and the glass electrode is sufficiently constant to be used as a reference for this type of titration. Determine the chloride content of the solution by titration against the 0.1 N silver nitrate solution, and calculate the result as sodium chloride. 1 ml of 0.1 N silver nitrate solution = 0.00585 g of sodium chloride. Express the result as a percentage of the weight of sample taken.
Oven, 0 - 200 range Hot plate, capable of boiling carbon tetrachloride (CCl4) (b.p. 76.8) Crucible, fitted with glass fiber disk Vacuum flask Source of vacuum Desiccator
Reagents
Procedure
The test shall be carried out in accordance with the following instructions:
Mix the prescribed weight of the sample (W1) with 100 ml of solvent in a 250-ml beaker, stir and heat to boiling on the hot plate in a fume hood. Filter the hot solution through a weighed crucible (W2). Transfer residue in the beaker to the crucible with solvent. Wash the residue in the crucible with 10-ml portions of solvent until washings are colourless. Place the crucible in oven at 100 - 150 for 3 h; cool crucible in desiccator. Weigh cooled crucible (W3).
Calculation
Calculate the percent carbon tetrachloride or chloroform insoluble matter (PIM) in the sample using the following equation: PIM (%) = (W3 - W2) / W1 x 100 Report as percent carbon tetrachloride or chloroform insoluble matter in the original sample.
Coincidence of migration distances with a single solvent system should be looked upon only as one criterion of identity and further tests should be made for securing the finding. The following table contains examples of the Rf-values that may be expected when 1% aqueous solutions of various colouring matters are subjected to thin layer chromatography on Silica Gel G in ten different solvent systems. The compositions of the solvent systems, all of which must be freshly prepared, are:
Solvent No.
1 iso-Propanol:ammonia (sp.gr. 0.880):water (7:2:1) 2 iso-Butanol:ethanol:water:ammonia (sp.gr. 0.880) (10:20:10:1) 3 Saturated aqueous potassium nitrate solution 4 Phenol:water (4:1, w/v) 5 Hydrochloric acid (sp.gr. 1.18):water (23:77) 6 Trisodium citrate:ammonia (sp.gr. 0.880):water (2g:15ml:85ml) 7 Acetone:ethylmethylketone:ammonia (sp.gr. 0.880):water (60:140:1:60) 8 n-Butanol:ethanol:pyridine:water (2:1:1:2) 9 iso-Propanol:ammonia (sp.gr. 0.880) (4:1) 10 n-Butanol:acetic acid (glacial):water (10:5:6) Assessment of the colour shade should be made while the chromatograms are still moist with solvent and then again after drying. The shade should be assessed in incident and transmitted daylight as well as in UV light. In ultraviolet light many colouring matters show characteristic colour changes. Furthermore, it is thus often possible to trace colourless fluorescent impurities. If possible, two UV emitters which yield different wave lengths should be used; one lamp should emit around 250 nm. Tests with acids, alkalis and other suitable reagents, in order further to safeguard the results, should be made. All tests may be carried out with fine capillary pipettes on each colour spot. The following requirements should be met when identifying colouring matters:
equal migration distances in several solvents; equal shade in daylight and ultraviolet light; equal colour changes with reagents.
Spectrophotometric methods of examination are among the most useful means of identification of colouring matters. Ultraviolet, visible, and infrared regions are all employed.
The visible region of the spectrum is ordinarily examined as the first step in attempting to identify an unknown colouring matter. Many colouring matters show characteristic absorption in the visible region while others do not. Spectra in the ultraviolet region may also be of use, and should be obtained if possible.
Infrared absorption spectra often offer the best means of identification of various compounds, but there are some difficulties in the practical use of the methods. In the application of visible and ultraviolet spectrophotometry, spectra should always be obtained in more than one solvent, or if in a single solvent, under various conditions. Spectra of water solutions should be obtained under neutral (buffered with ammonium acetate), acid (0.1 N hydrochloric acid), and alkaline (0.1 N sodium hydroxide) conditions. Absorption spectra are ordinarily plotted as charts, showing the absorbance at all wavelengths. Examination of the resulting curves should include more than location of the wave length of maximum absorption. The entire curve should be carefully inspected to determine the particular shape of the curve since "shoulders" or inflection points may be the most characteristic and useful features of the absorption spectra. These features often make it possible to distinguish between two or more colouring matters that have absorption maxima at the same wavelength. Many colouring matters can be definitely characterized by observing the extent to which the absorption maxima and other features of the absorption curve are changed by variation in pH or by other changes in the solvent. Infrared spectra can be obtained in several ways; the more commonly used are:
spectra of solutions of the material in suitable solvents; spectra of suspensions of the material in a suitable liquid; the potassium bromide pellet tehcnique (a small amount of the colouring matter, usually from 1 to 3 mg, is thoroughly mixed with pure, dry potassium bromide, the mixture is transferred to a suitable die and pressed into solid form by exerting a pressure of 700 to 1,400 kg/square cm).
The spectra obtained are plotted in the usual way. Salient features of the resulting curves are the wavelength at which absorption peaks occur, and the shape of the curves near the peaks. Detailed discussion of the interpretation of infrared spectra is beyond the scope of this brief statement. It must be pointed out, however, that care must be taken to ensure that absorption peaks due to inorganic contaminants are not considered as due to the colouring matter. The crystal structure or other physical state of the sample may affect the spectra obtained from suspensions or potassium bromide pellets. It is necessary to make certain that the unknown material has been treated in exactly the same manner as was the standard or known sample. Water soluble colouring matters can often be handled by dissolving the materials in water, adding a little acetic acid, evaporating to apparent dryness, and then drying at about 100 to remove the residual water. All materials to be tested should be free from water or other solvent before an infrared spectrum is obtained. Water and all organic solvents absorb infrared radiation. As an example of the use of infrared spectra, two of the colouring matters, one of which is listed in this publication, may be mentioned. Sunset Yellow and Orange GGN have absorption spectra in the visible region and in the ultraviolet region so nearly identical that they cannot be distinguished through examination in these regions. Their infrared spectra, however, are quite different in the region of the spectrum in which the sulfonic acid groups absorb strongly.
In some instances, chromatographic procedures, spectrophotometric procedures, and any combination of the two may fail to give positive identification. In such cases, the problem may often be solved by reducing the colouring matter or otherwise degrading the compound and identifying the resulting products. This technique is particularly applicable to azo colouring matters. The amino compounds resulting from the reduction can frequently be readily identified by chromographic and spectrophotometric techniques. Many other techniques have been applied to identification of colouring matters. Their description here will not be undertaken, but one example will be cited. Many pigments have definite crystalline structure and can be identified by X-ray diffraction patterns, or by optical crystallography. Some colouring matters can be converted to crystalline derivatives and similarly identified.
Total Content
Two general methods are used for determination of total colouring matters content: Spectrophotometric comparison and Titanous chloride reduction When using the spectrophotometric method it should be remembered that many makers of spectrophotometers do not guarantee accuracy greater than 1%. All colours present in the sample which have their absorption peak in the region of that of the main colour will contribute to the absorbance figure used to calculate the results. Subsidiary colouring matters of markedly different hue will not be accounted for by this technique. In the ideal situation the spectrophotometer would be used to make side-byside comparison of the sample and a standard of known colouring content. The use of a generally accepted absorptivity figure in place of the standard itself is considered to be somewhat less satisfactory, but in the case of a number of colours it is recognized that there is no practical alternative. In the titanous chloride method the assumption is made that isomers and subsidiaries have the same titanous chloride equivalent as the main colouring matter.
Principle
The absorbance of a solution of the colouring matter is determined at its wavelength of maximum absorption and compared with a standard absorptivity figure.
Apparatus
Spectrophotometer capable of accurate ( 1% or better) measurement of absorbance in the region of 350 - 700 nm with an effective slit width of 10 nm or less. Absorption cells, 1 cm light path.
Reagents
Freshly distilled water or the solvent prescribed in the specification for the colour.
Procedure 1
Accurately weigh 0.25 g ( 0.02 g) of the sample. Transfer to a 1,000-ml volumetric flask. Add freshly distilled water or the prescribed solvent and swirl to dissolve. Make up to volume and mix. Dilute to a solution of suitable strength according to the details given in the colour specification. Determine the absorbance (A) at the wavelength of maximum absorbance in a 1 cm cell.
Calculation
Calculate the total colouring matters content of the sample using the following equation: % total colouring matters = (A / A1%w) x (Vol / w) x 100 where A = absorbance of the sample A1%1cm = specific absorbance of the standard (from the colour specification) Vol = dilution factor (Volume diluted to / Volume measured) w = weight of sample taken
Procedure 2
Accurately weigh about 0.08 g (= w) of sample in a 100-ml volumetric flask (= V1) and dissolve by shaking briefly with 20 ml pure, acid-free chloroform. Make sure that the solution is clear. Make up to volume by the addition of pure Cyclohexane. Pipet 5.0 ml of the solution (= v1) into a 100 ml volumetric flask (= V2) and make up to volume with Cyclohexane. Similarly, dilute 5.0 ml of this solution (= v2) to 100 ml (= V3) and measure the absorbance at the absorbance maximum (= A) against Cyclohexane as a blank, using 1 cm cells. Calculate the total colouring matters content according to the following formula: % total colouring matters = (A V1 V2 V3) / v1 v2 w A1%1cm where A = absorbance of the sample solution at the wavelength of maximum absorption
V1 = volume of first volumetric flask (= 100 ml) V2 = volume of second volumetric flask (= 100 ml) V3 = volume of final volumetric flask (= 100 ml) v1 = volume of first pipet (= 5 ml) v2 = volume of second pipet (= 5 ml) w = weight of sample in g A1%1cm = specific absorbance of the standard Complete the determination promptly, avoiding exposure to air insofar as possible, and undertaking all operations in the absence of daylight.
Apparatus
Carbon dioxide generator, e.g. a Kipp apparatus. Titration apparatus, as shown in the Figure, comprising an aspirator and a burette fitted with a double-oblique tap and side arm. The aspirator is closed at the top by a rubber stopper with two holes, through one of which passes a glass tube connected to the carbon dioxide generator. Through the second hole passes a glass tube connected to the top of the burette. The side arm of the burette is connected to the bottom of the aspirator. 500 ml conical flask with CO2 inlet tube. (When carrying out titrations with titanous chloride, ensure that the tip of the burette is always inside the neck of the flask.)
Procedure
Preparation of 0.1 N titanous chloride solution. Measure into a large round flask a volume of 15% titanous chloride solution containing 15.5 - 16.5 g of titanous chloride for each litre of solution required. Add 100 ml of hydrochloric acid (sp.gr. 1.16 - 1.18) for each litre of solution required. Boil the mixture for 1-2 min and then pour it into cold water. Make up the required volume in the aspirator, mix well, and preserve the solution in an atmosphere of carbon dioxide. Cover the solution with a layer of liquid paraffin (about 0.6 cm deep). Standardization of titanous chloride solution. Weigh 3 g of ammonium ferrous sulfate [(NH4)2SO4FeSO46H2O] into a 500 ml conical flask, and pass a stream of carbon dioxide through the flask continuously until the end of the determination. Add 50 ml of water and 25 ml of 10 N sulfuric acid solution, then 30 ml of 0.1 N potassium dichromate solution, accurately standardized. Titrate with the titanous chloride solution until the calculated end point is nearly reached. Add 5 ml of a 20% ammonium thiocyanate solution and continue the titration until the red colour is discharged and the solution remains green. Carry out a blank determination on 3 g of ammonium ferrous sulfate, using the same quantities of water, acid and ammonium thiocyanate solution and passing a continuous current of carbon dioxide through the flask as before. The factor for 0.1 N titanous chloride solution is: F = 30 / ml (corrected) of titanous chloride solution required Determination of total colouring matter content of sample. Accurately weigh the quantity of the colour sample specified in each monograph into a 500 ml flask and add 10 g of sodium citrate or 15 g of sodium hydrogen tartrate, as specified in each monograph, and 150 ml of water. Pass a stream of carbon dioxide through the flask, heat the solution to boiling, and titrate with standardized titanous chloride solution, maintaining a steady flow of carbon dioxide. Towards the end of the titration, add the
titanous chloride solution dropwise to the end point. The colour will act as its own indicator unless otherwise stated in the appropriate monograph. % total colouring matters = (A x D x 100 x F) / weight of sample where A = ml of 0.1 N titanous chloride solution required (corrected) D = weight of colouring matters equivalent to 1.00 ml of 0.1 N titanous chloride solution (specified in each monograph)
Method of Assay of Certain Food Colours (Tentative Comments are invited on the use of this method as an alternative)
Procedure
Dissolve an amount of the colour equal to the value of (p) in the table below, in ammonium acetate (1.542 g in 1 L H2O); dilute 1 ml of this solution to 100 ml with the same solution of ammonium acetate. Under the same conditions, prepare a test solution with (p') mg of the reference colour. Determine by visible spectrometry at the wavelength of the reference colour 5 nm, the absorbance of the test solution (A1) and the reference solution (A2). Calculate the percentage content of the colour in the examined sample from expression: (A1 x p' x T) / A2 x p Where T = concentration (%) of pure colour in the reference colour.
p, p' Azorubine
nm
C.I.
170 mg 507 nm 16255 75 mg 525 nm 45430 150 mg 612 nm 73015 150 mg 480 nm 15985
Quinoline Yellow 100 mg 416 nm 47005 Brillant black Tartrazine 150 mg 573 nm 28840 150 mg 426 nm 19140
General Note
For many years paper chromatography has been used for determining the subsidiary colouring matter content of water-soluble food colours. In the commonly used version of this well-established technique the assumption is made that the absorptivities of subsidiary colouring matters are similar to that of the main colouring matter. Accordingly, standards of individual subsidiary colour matters are not required. HPLC has been used successfully to separate and determine the subsidiary colouring matter contents of a number of food colours, including some of the water soluble ones. Standards of individual subsidiary colouring matters are needed for this method. However, it should be remembered that specification limit figures are, unless otherwise stated, linked to the paper chromatographic method and the conditions referred to under "Tests".
Definition
Subsidiary colouring matters are defined as those colouring matters that are produced during the manufacturing process in addition to the principal named colouring matter(s). Any colouring matters other than the principal and subsidiary colouring matters are considered to be adulterants and their presence is usually detected on the chromatograms used to determine subsidiary colouring matters. Interpretation of the chromatograms for adulterant colours usually requires some experience.
Principle
The subsidiary colouring matters are separated from the main colouring matter by ascending paper chromatography and are extracted separately from the paper. The absorbance of each extract is measured at its wavelength of maximum absorbance in the visible spectrum.
Because it is impractical to identify each subsidiary colouring matter in each food colour, an approximate method of expressing them as a percentage of the sample has been adopted. The assumption is made that the absorptivity of each subsidiary colouring matter is the same as that of the total colouring matters. The absorbances of the extracts are added together and used in conjunction with the absorbance of the sample and its total colouring matters content to calculate the subsidiary colouring matters content. This is considered to be a sufficiently close approximation for the determination of a minor component.
Apparatus
a glass tank (A) and cover (B); a supporting frame (C) for the chromatography paper sheets; a tray (D) for chromatography solvent; a secondary frame (E) supporting "drapes" of the filter paper; sheets of chromatography grade paper not less than 20 cm x 20 cm
Procedure
Not less than 2 hours before carrying out the determination, arrange the filter-paper drapes in the glass tank and pour over the drapes and into the bottom of the tank sufficient of the chromatography solvent to cover the bottom of the tank to a depth of approximately 1 cm. Place the solvent tray (D) in position and fit the cover to the tank. Mark out a sheet of chromatography paper as shown in Fig. 3. Apply 0.10 ml of a 1.0% aqueous solution of the sample as uniformly as possible within the confines of the 18 cm x 7 mm rectangle, holding the nozzle of the microsyringe steadily in contact with the paper. Allow the paper to dry at room temperature for 1 - 2 hours or at 50 for 5 min, followed by 15 min at room temperature. Mount the sheet, together with a plain sheet to act as a blank, in frame (C). Pour sufficient of the chromatography solvent into the tray (D) to bring the surface of the solvent about 1 cm below the base line of the chromatogram sheet. The volume necessary will depend on the dimensions of the apparatus and should be predetermined. Put frame (C) into position and replace the cover. Allow the solvent front to ascend the specified distance above the base line, then remove frame (C) and transfer it to a drying cabinet at 50 - 60 for 10 - 15 min. Remove the sheets from frame (C). (If required, several chromatograms may be developed simultaneously.) Cut each subsidiary band from the sheet as a strip, and cut an equivalent strip from the corresponding position of the plain sheet. Place each strip, subdivided into a suitable number of approximately equal portions, in a separate test tube. Add 5.0 ml of water:acetone (1:1 by vol) to each test tube, swirl for 2 - 3 min, add 15.0 ml of 0.05 N
sodium hydrogen carbonate solution and shake the tube to ensure mixing. Filter the coloured extracts and
blanks through 9 cm filter papers of open texture and determine the absorbances of the coloured extracts at their wavelengths of maximum absorbance, using 40 mm closed cells, against a filtered mixture of 5.0 ml of water:acetone (1:1 by vol) and 15.0 ml of the 0.05 N sodium hydrogen carbonate solution. Measure the absorbances of the extracts of the blank strips at the wavelengths at which those of the corresponding coloured extracts were measured and correct the absorbances of the coloured extracts with the blank values. To prepare the "standard", proceed as follows: From the 1.0% solution of the sample prepare a solution corresponding to L/100% where L = the Subsidiary Colouring matters limit. Apply 0.10 ml of this solution to a sheet of chromatography paper by the technique outlined above, run a chromatogram, and then dry it at 50-60 for 10-15 min. Cut the band from the sheet as a strip and cut an equivalent strip from a plain but marked sheet. Proceed as detailed previously and determine the net absorbance (As) of the standard. Calculate the percentage of Subsidiary Colouring matters from: % Subsidiary Colouring matters = (Aa + Ab + Ac ...An) / As x L x (D / 100) where Aa + Ab + Ac ...An = the sum of the absorbances of the Subsidiary Colouring matters corrected for the blank values; D = the total colouring matters content of the sample.
Chromatography solvents
1. Water:ammonia (sp.gr. O.880):trisodium citrate (95 ml:5 ml:2 g) 2. n-Butanol:water:ethanol:ammonia (sp.gr. O.880) (600:264:135:6) 3. Butan-2-one:acetone:water (7:3:3) 4. Butan-2-one:acetone:water:ammonia (sp.gr. O.880) (700:300:300:2) 5. Butan-2-one:acetone:water:ammonia (sp.gr. O.880) (700:160:300:2)
6. n-Butanol:glacial acetic acid:water (4:1:5) Shake for 2 min, allow layers to separate. Use the upper layer as the chromatography solvent.
Principle
The coloured impurities are determined by Thin-Layer Chromatography (T.L.C.) on a silica gel plate.
Preparation of solutions
Solution 1: Dissolve 40 mg of the food colour under test in a mixture of methanol/water (50/50) and dilute to 10 ml with the same solvent. Solution 2: Dilute 0.1 to 0.5 ml (Corresponding to the limit of coloured impurities or subsidiary colours tolerated in the food colour examined (1 to 5%)) of solution 1 to 10 ml with the mixture of methanol/water (50/50). Solution 3 (standard solution): Dissolve 40 mg of the corresponding standard food dye in a mixture of methanol/water (50/50) and dilute to 10 ml with the same solvent.
Procedure
Spot 5 l each of the solution 1, solution 2 and the standard solution. Place the plate in a developing chamber containing n-butanol/ethanol/water /Ammonia TS (50/25/25/10) and allow the solvent to ascend to a point 15 cm above the sample spots. The major spots appearing on chromatograms 1 and 3 migrate approximatively to the same Rf. Any other spots appearing on chromatogram 1 are not more than the major spot appearing on chromatogram 2.
Remarks
Sometimes it is possible to eluate the spots on chromatogram 1 and to carry out an approximate assay. In this case, the procedure described in Food and Nutrition paper 31/1 (1984) page A.10 can be modified as following: "Scratch each subsidiary spot from the plate and scratch equivalent spot from the corresponding position of the plain plate. Place each ..."
Apparatus
Upward displacement type liquid/liquid extractor with sintered glass distributor, working capacity 200 ml. A piece of bright copper wire is suspended through the condenser and a small coil of copper wire (0.5 g) is placed in the distillation flask.
Ether
Diethylether or diisopropylether. Immediately before use the freshly distilled ether should be passed through a 30 cm column of chromatography grade aluminum oxide in order to remove peroxides and inhibitors. Test to ensure the absence of peroxides, as follows: Prepare a colourless solution of ferrous thiocyanate by mixing equal volumes of 0.1 N solutions of ferrous sulfate and ammonium thiocyanate and carefully discharging any red colouration, due to ferric ions, with titanous chloride. To 50 ml of this solution add 10 ml of ether and shake the mixture vigorously for 2-3 min. No red colour should develop.
Procedure
(i) Alkaline ether extract. Weigh accurately about 5.0 g (Some colours have solubilities of less than 5 g/150 ml and the use of a lower weight is prescribed in the Colour Specification under TESTS.) of the colour sample, dissolve in 150 ml of water, add 2.5 ml of 2 N sodium hydroxide solution and transfer the solution to the extractor, diluting to approximately 200 ml with water in the process. Add 200 ml of ether to the distillation flask and extract for 2 h with a reflux rate of about 15 ml/min. Reserve the colour solution. Transfer the ether extract to a separatory funnel and wash the ether extract with two 25-ml portions of 0.1 N sodium hydroxide and then with water. Distil the ether in portions from a tared 150-ml flask containing a clean copper coil, reducing the volume to about 5 ml. (ii) Acid ether extract. To the colour solution reserved from (i), add 5 ml of 3 N hydrochloric acid, mix and extract with a further quantity of the ether as in (i). Wash the ether extract with two 25-ml portions of 0.1 N hydrochloric acid and then with water. Transfer in portions to the flask containing the evaporated alkaline extract and carefully evaporate all the ether. Complete the drying in an oven at 85 for 20 min, then allow the flask to cool in a desiccator for 30 min and weigh. Repeat the drying and cooling until constant weight is obtained. The increase in weight of the tared flask, expressed as a percentage of the weight of sample taken, is the "ether extractable matter".
METHOD II
Apparatus
Soxhlet extractor. A piece of bright copper wire is suspended through the condenser and a small coil of copper wire (0.5 g) is placed in the distillation flask.
Ether
Diethylether or diisopropylether. Purify the ether as directed in METHOD I.
Procedure
Weigh accurately about 2 g of the colour sample. Transfer to the Soxhlet thimble and extract with 150 ml ether for 5 h. Concentrate the ether extract on a steam bath to about 5 ml. Dry the residue in a tared evaporating dish on a water bath and then dry at 105 until a constant weight is obtained. The increase in weight of the evaporating dish, expressed as a percentage of the weight of sample taken, is the "ether extractable matter".
Procedure
Accurately weigh approximately 5 g of the lake into a 500 ml beaker. Add 250 ml water and 60 ml concentrated hydrochloric acid. Boil until all the colour and alumina has dissolved. Filter through a tared No. 4 sintered glass crucible. Wash the crucible with hot 0.5% hydrochloric acid until the washings are colourless. Dry the crucible to constant weight at 135. Express the weight of residue as a percentage of the weight taken.
Reagents
Dimethylformamide (DMF) Solution A: Weigh 10.0 g of CuCl22H2O and dissolve in 200 ml of DMF. Transfer to a 1-L volumetric flask and make up to the mark with DMF.
Solution B: Accurately weigh the specified quantity of sample. Dissolve in approximately 100 ml water, transfer quantitatively to a 1-L volumetric flask and make up to the mark with water.
Procedure
Prepare the following solutions: Solution a: Pipet 50 ml DMF into a 250-ml volumetric flask. Cover with parafilm and place in the dark. Solution b: Accurately pipet 10 ml of Solution B into a 250-ml volumetric flask. Add 50 ml DMF. Cover with parafilm and place in the dark. Solution c: Pipet 50 ml of Solution A into a 250-ml volumetric flask. Bubble air through this solution for 30 min in the following manner: Insert a 5 ml pipette into a box attached to a bench air flow source. Turn on the air, slowly. Stick the pipette down into the solution in the flask and adjust the air flow to a rapid but controlled rate. After 30 min pull the pipette up out of the solution and rinse the sides of the pipette into the flask with water from a wash bottle. Then turn off the air flow. Solutions d1 and d2 : Accurately pipet 10 ml Solution B into 2 separate 250-ml volumetric flasks in the same manner as used for Solution b. Add 50 ml Solution A to each flask. Bubble air through the solutions for 30 min, using the above method. After 30 min of rapid bubbling of air through the solutions, dilute all 5 flasks nearly to volume with water. Heat is evolved when DMF and water are mixed, so place the flasks in a water bath of tap water until they have cooled to room temperature. Do not leave them for longer than necessary; 5 - 10 min are normally enough. Bring accurately to volume with water. Run the solutions on the spectrophotometer immediately. The entire procedure should be completed as quickly as possible.
Spectrophotometric Determination
Draw the following curves from 700 - 500 nm using an absorbance range of 0.1 and 1 cm cells. Run all curves on the same spectrogram, and (for maximum accuracy) take readings off the numerical display at the maximum between 620 and 635 nm by cranking back after the curve is drawn.
Reference Sample
Curve Cell Cell Comments 1 a a Set zero at 700 nm, run curve; record absorbance at Abs std for colouring matter Run curve without readjusting zero setting; record absorbance at maximum
3 4a
c c
c d1
Set zero at 700 nm; record absorbance at Abs std for colouring matter Run curve without readjusting zero setting; record absorbance at maximum Run curve without readjusting zero setting; record absorbance at maximum
4b
d2
(d1 and d2 are duplicate determinations) Note: Cells must be thoroughly rinsed before each run. For the flow-through cell, use 3 separate rinses of at least 40 ml of the sample solution to be run.
Calculations
[(4 - 3) - (2 - 1)] x 25 x 100% / (a x 1 cm x mg sample x ratio) = % leuco base where a = absorptivity of 100% colouring matters mg sample = amount sample weighed in mg ratio = MW of colouring matter / MW of leuco base (given in the individual monographs) 1, 2, 3 and 4 = maximum absorbance of curves 1, 2, 3 and 4, respectively.
Apparatus
Chromatographic tube (see Figure). Suitable spectro photometer for use in the ultraviolet range.
Column Preparation
Prepare a slurry of Whatman powdered cellulose in a 25% ammonium sulfate (very low in iron) solution. If other cellulose is used, the iron content must be very low. Test: Prepare column as directed and pass 200 ml of 25% ammonium sulfate solution through it. The ultraviolet absorption of the solution must be sufficiently low to avoid interference with the intended analysis. Use about 75 g of cellulose to 500 ml of liquid. Place a small disk of stainless steel gauze in the constriction above the tip of the tube. Pour sufficient volume of the flurry into the tube to give a column to a height of about 5 cm in the mouth of the tube. Tap the tube occasionally to ensure a well-packed column. Wash the column with 200 ml of the eluant.
Procedure
Place 0.200 g of the colour sample in a suitable beaker and dissolve in 20 ml of water. Add approximately 5 g of powdered cellulose. Add 50 g of ammonium sulfate to salt out the colour. Transfer the mixture to the chromatograph tube, rinse the beaker with the 25% ammonium sulfate solution and add the washings to the tube. Allow the column to drain until flow ceases, or nearly so. Add the ammonium sulfate solution to the column at a rate equivalent to the rate of the flow through the column. Collect the effluent in 100 ml fractions. Continue until twelve fractions have been collected. Reserve the column and contents until the last fraction has been examined. Mix each fraction well, and obtain the ultraviolet absorption spectrum of each solution from 220 to 400 nm. If the spectrum of the twelfth fraction shows the presence of any compound, continue collecting fractions until the compounds present are eluted. Usually only one compound is encountered. Identification and quantitative determination is accomplished by comparison of the absorption spectra of the eluted material with the spectra of solutions of the pure compounds in the same solvent.
When more than one compound is present in significant quantities in any fractions, the spectrophotometric data will so indicate. In such case, the amounts of the various compounds must be determined by the procedure customarily used in spectrophotometric analysis of mixtures of absorbing materials. Some samples contain small amounts of various materials, particularly inorganic salts, that contribute "background absorption". Correction for this is made as follows: Determine the amount of such absorption of the fraction collected from the column immediately before and of the fraction immediately following those fractions in which the compounds are encountered. Subtract one-half of the sum of these two determinations from the observed absorbance of the fractions containing the compounds. The remainder is taken as the absorbance due to the compound present.
Apparatus
Visible range Spectrophotometer
Reagents
The reagents shall be of a recognized analytical reagent quality. Distilled water or water of at least equal purity shall be used. 1. Toluene 2. Hydrochloric acid, approx. N solution 3. Hydrochloric acid, approx. 3N solution 4. Potassium bromide, approx. 50% solution 5. Sodium carbonate, approx. 2N solution 6. Sodium hydroxide, approx. N solution 7. Sodium hydroxide, approx. 0.1 N solution 8. R salt (2-naphthol-3,6-disulfonic acid, disodium salt), approx. 0.05 N solution 9. Sodium nitrite, approx. 0.5 N solution 10. Standard aniline solution: Into a small weighing beaker weigh 0.100 g of redistilled aniline, then wash it into a 100-ml one-mark volumetric flask, rinsing the beaker several times with water. Add 30 ml of approx. 3 N hydrochloric acid solution and dilute to the mark with water at room temperature. Call this Solution A. Dilute 10.0 ml of Solution A with water to 100 ml in a one-mark volumetric flask and mix well. Call this Solution B; 1 ml of this solution will be equivalent to 0.0001 g of aniline. (Prepare Solution B freshly when required.)
Procedure
Preparation of Calibration Graph. Measure the following volumes of standard aniline Solution B into a series of 100 ml one-mark volumetric flasks: 5 ml, 10 ml, 15 ml, 20 ml, 25 ml. Dilute to 100 ml with approx. N hydrochloric acid solution and mix well. Pipet 10 ml of each mixture into clean, dry test tubes and cool for 10 min by immersion in a beaker of ice/water mixture. To each tube add 1 ml of the potassium bromide solution and 0.05 ml of the sodium nitrite solution. Mix and allow to stand for 10 min in the ice/water bath. Into each of five 25 ml volumetric flasks, measure 1 ml of the R salt solution, and 10 ml of the sodium carbonate solution. Pour each diazotised aniline solution into a separate flask containing R salt solution and sodium carbonate solution, rinsing the test tubes with a few drops of water. Dilute to the mark with water, stopper the flasks, mix the contents well and allow to stand for 15 min in the dark. Measure the absorbance of each coupled solution at 510 nm in 40 mm cells, using as a reference a mixture of 10.0 ml of N hydrochloric acid solution, 10.0 ml of the sodium
carbonate solution, and 2.0 ml of the R salt solution, diluted to 25.0 ml with water. Plot a graph relating absorbance to weight of aniline in each 100 ml of aniline solution. Preparation and Examination of Test Solution. Weigh, to the nearest 0.01 g, about 2.0 g of the colour sample into a separating funnel containing 100 ml of water, swill down the sides of the funnel with a further 50 ml of water, swirl to dissolve the sample, and add 5 ml of N sodium hydroxide solution. Extract with two 50-ml portions of toluene and wash the combined toluene extracts with 10-ml portions of 0.1 N sodium hydroxide solution to remove traces of colour. Extract the washed toluene with three 10-ml portions of 3 N hydrochloric acid solution and dilute the combined extract to 100 ml with water. Mix well. Call this Solution T. Pipet 10.0 ml of Solution T into a clean, dry test tube, cool for 10 min by immersion in a beaker of ice/water mixture, add 1 ml of the potassium bromide solution and proceed as described above for the preparation of the calibration graph, starting with the addition of 0.05 ml of the sodium nitrite solution. Use as the reference solution in the measurement of absorbance a solution prepared from 10.0 ml of the T solution, 10 ml of the sodium carbonate solution and 2.0 ml of the R solution, diluted to 25.0 ml with water. Read from the calibration graph the weight of aniline corresponding to the observed absorbance of the test solution.
Calculation
Percentage of unsulfonated primary aromatic amine (as aniline) in sample = (weight of aniline x 100) / weight of sample taken
Procedure
Weigh 2.0 - 3.0 g of the sample in a tared weighing bottle fitted with a ground lid. A weighing bottle of squat form about 50 mm in diameter and 30 mm high is suitable. Heat at the prescribed temperature 5 until a constant weight is obtained. Express the loss in weight as a percentage of the weight of sample taken.
laboratory use) and wash with cold water until the washings are colourless. Dry the filter and residue at 135 until a constant weight is obtained. Express the weight of the residue as a percentage of the weight of sample taken.
V. METHODS FOR ENZYME PREPARATIONS o GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS AND CONSIDERATIONS FOR ENZYME PREPARATIONS USED IN FOOD PROCESSING o ALPHA-AMYLASE ACTIVITY, BACTERIAL Bacterial Alpha-Amylase Enzymes used in Desizing (ATCC Test Method 103-19701, ATCC Tech. Manual, 264 (1970)) o ALPHA-AMYLASE ACTIVITY, FUNGAL o ALPHA-AMYLASE ACTIVITY, MALT (Amer. Soc. Brewing Chemistry, 6th ed., 169 (1958)) o ANTIBACTERIAL ACTIVITY o CATALASE ACTIVITY o CELLULASE ACTIVITY o ETHYLENIMINE LIMIT TEST o GLUCOAMYLASE ACTIVITY (AMYLOGLUCOSIDASE ACTIVITY) o Beta-GLUCANASE ACTIVITY o GLUCOSE ISOMERASE ACTIVITY1 o GLUCOSE OXIDASE ACTIVITY o GLUTARALDEHYDE LIMIT TEST o GLUTARALDEHYDE DETERMINATION IN HIGH FRUCTOSE CORN SYRUP o HEMICELLULASE ACTIVITY o MILK CLOTTING ACTIVITY o PROTEASE ACTIVITY, VISCOMETER o PROTEOLYTIC ACTIVITY, BACTERIAL (PC) o PROTEOLYTIC ACTIVITY, FUNGAL (HUT) o PROTEOLYTIC ACTIVITY, FUNGAL (SAP) o PROTEOLYTIC ACTIVITY, PLANT o PULLULANASE ACTIVITY
GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS AND CONSIDERATIONS FOR ENZYME PREPARATIONS USED IN FOOD PROCESSING
Specifications prepared at the 57th JECFA (2001) and published in FNP 52 (Addendum 9), superseding specifications prepared at the 35th JECFA (1989) and published in FNP 49 (1990) and in FNP 52 (1992); the general specifications prepared at the 25th JECFA (1981) and published in FNP 19 (1981) and FNP 31/2 (1984); amendments at the 51st JECFA published in FNP 52 Add 6 (1998); amendments at the 53rd JECFA (1999) and partially published in FNP 52 Add 7 (1999).
Enzyme Nomenclature
Recommendations (1992) of the Nomenclature Committee of the International Union of Biochemistry, Academic Press (1992) with later supplements. Enzyme preparations used in food processing are usually named according to the substrate to which the enzyme is applied, such as protease or amylase. Some traditional names are also in use, such as malt, pepsin and rennet.
Definition
Enzyme preparations consist of biologically active proteins, at times combined with metals, carbohydrates and/or lipids. They are obtained from animal, plant or microbial sources and may consist of whole cells, parts of cells, or cell free extracts of the source used. They may contain one or more active components as well as carriers, solvents, preservatives, antioxidants and other substances consistent with good manufacturing practice. They may be liquid, semi liquid, dry or in an immobilized form (immobilized enzyme preparations are preparations which have been made insoluble in their intended food matrix by physical and/or chemical means). Their colour may vary from virtually colourless to dark brown.
Active components
The principal activities are characterized by their systematic names and Enzyme Commission Numbers. The activities of enzyme preparations are measured according to the reaction catalyzed by individual enzymes and are usually expressed in activity units per weight of preparation.
Source materials
Animal tissues used for the preparation of enzymes must comply with meat inspection requirements and be handled in accordance with good hygienic practice. Plant material used in the production of enzyme preparations must consist of components that leave no residues harmful to health in the processed finished food under normal conditions of use. Microbial sources used in the production of enzyme preparations may be native strains or variants of microorganisms, or be derived from native strains or variants by the processes of selective serial culture or genetic modification. Production strains for food enzyme preparations must be nonpathogenic and nontoxigenic. The evaluation of
enzyme preparations from fungal sources for toxigenicity shall include a determination that they do not contain toxicologically significant amounts of mycotoxins that are known to be synthesised by strains of the production organism's species or of species related to the production microorganism. Source microorganisms must be discrete and stable strains or variants that have been taxonomically characterised to enable them to be assigned unique identities as the sources of the enzyme preparations that are the subject of individual specifications. The reference or production strain number may be included in individual specifications. The production strains must be maintained under conditions that ensure the absence of strain drift and, when used in the production of enzyme preparations, must be subjected to methods and culture conditions that are applied consistently and reproducibly from batch to batch. Such conditions must ensure the absence of toxin production by the source organism and prevent the introduction of microorganisms that could be the source of toxic materials and other undesirable substances. Culture media used for the growth of microbial sources must consist of components that leave no residues harmful to health in the processed finished food under normal conditions of use. Enzyme preparations are produced in accordance with good food manufacturing practice. They cause no increase in the total microbial count in the treated food, over the level considered to be acceptable for the respective food.
OTHER CONSIDERATIONS
An overall safety assessment of each enzyme preparation intended for use in food or food processing must be performed. This assessment should include an evaluation of the safety of the production organism, the enzyme component, side activities, the manufacturing process, and the consideration of dietary exposure. Guidelines for safety assessments of food enzyme preparations derived from microbial strains have been developed (Pariza and Foster, 1983; Pariza and Johnson, 2001; IFBC, 1990; Scientific Committee for Foods, 27th series). Further, several internationally recognized scientists and expert groups have prepared guidelines for the safety assessment of food and food ingredients developed through biotechnology (OECD, 1993: Health Canada, 1994; FAO/WHO, 1996; and Jonas et al., 1996) which are applicable to enzyme preparations derived from recombinant sources. The following points need emphasis when considering the production of enzyme preparations from genetically modified microorganisms: 1. The genetic material introduced into and remaining in the production microorganism should be characterized and evaluated for function and safety. It should be demonstrated that no unexpected genetic material was introduced into the host microorganism, e.g., by providing the sequences of the final introduced genetic material and/or molecular analysis of the introduced sequences in the final production strain. This would include demonstration that the genetic material does not contain genes coding for virulence factors, protein toxins, or enzymes that may be involved in the synthesis of mycotoxins or any other toxic or undesirable substances. 2. If the production microorganism is capable of producing proteins that inactivate clinically useful antibiotics, documentation should be provided that the finished enzyme preparation contains neither antibiotic inactivating proteins at concentrations that would interfere with antibiotic treatment nor DNA that is capable of transforming microorganisms, which potentially could lead to the spread of antibiotic resistance. 3. The need to evaluate the allergenic potential of the potential gene products encoded by the DNA inserted in the production microorganism should be considered (see FAO/WHO, 2000 and 2001).
References
FAO/WHO. Biotechnology and Food Safety, Report of a Joint FAO/WHO Consultation. FAO Food and Nutrition Paper 61. Rome, Italy, 1996. FAO/WHO. Safety aspects of genetically modified foods of plant origin, Report of a Joint FAO/WHO Expert Consultation on Foods Derived from Biotechnology. Geneva, Switzerland, 2000 (also available at www.who.int/fsf).
FAO/WHO. Evaluation of Allergenicity of Genetically Modified Foods, Report of a Joint FAO/WHO Expert Consultation on Allergenicity of Foods Derived from Biotechnology. Rome, Italy, 2001 (also available at www.fao.org). Health Canada, Guidelines for the Safety Assessment of Novel Foods, Food Directorate Publication, Health Protection Branch, Health Canada, Ottawa, 1994. IFBC (International Food Biotechnology Council). Chapter 4: Safety Evaluation of Foods and Food Ingredients Derived from Microorganisms. In Biotechnologies and Food: Assuring the Safety of Foods Produced by Genetic Modification. Regulatory Toxicology and Pharmacology 12:S1 S196, 1990. Jonas, D.A., Antignac, E., Antoine, J.M., Classen, H.G., Huggett, A., Knudsen, I., Mahler, J., Ockhuizen, T., Smith, M., Teuber, M., Walker, R., and de Vogel, P. The Safety Assessment of Novel Foods, Guidelines prepared by ILSI Europe Novel Food Task Force. Food Chemical Toxicology 34:931-940, 1996. Organisation for Economic Cooperation and Development, Safety Evaluation of Foods Derived by Modern Biotechnology, Paris, 1993. Pariza, M.W. and Foster, E.M. Determining the Safety of Enzymes Used in Food Processing. Journal of Food Protection, 46:5:453-468, 1983. Pariza, M. W. and Johnson, E. A., Evaluating the Safety of Microbial Enzyme Preparations Used in Food Processing: Update for a New Century, Regulatory Toxicology and Pharmacology, 33:173-186, 2001. Scientific Committee for Food, Report (27th series), Ref. No EUR14181 EN- Guidelines for the presentation of data on food enzymes. P13-22, 1992.
Limitation
The calibration of the method as presented here further restricts its use to amylases of bacterial origin. Some surface active agents interfere with the colour development which is an essential part of this method. The method is therefore not suitable for assessing the effect of surfactants on enzymes.
Principle
Dextrogenic amylase activity is measured in terms of the digestion time required to produce a colour change denoting a definite stage of dextrinization of the starch
substrates. The amylase content of the sample, expressed in Bacterial Amylase Units (BAU), is readily calculated from the dextrinizing time.
Definition
Bacterial Amylase Unit is defined as that quantity of the enzyme that will dextrinize one mg of starch per minute under the specified experimental conditions.
Apparatus
Comparator: One source of such equipment is Hellige, Inc., 877 Stewart Avenue, Garden City, New York. Order Hellige Alpha-Amylase Testing Outfit 605-S5, include No. 605 Pocket Comparator with two No. 600-T13 Square Precision Tubes, No. 620S5 Colour Disc and direction, or equivalent comparator. The light source should be either daylight or daylight fluorescent lamps. Incandescent lamps should not be used since they give slightly lower results. Water bath: Constant temperature 30 0.20. Electric timer: Calibrated in minutes and hundredths is convenient (such as Time-it, manufactured by Precision Scientific Co., Chicago, Illinois). Glassware: Assorted standard glassware as required. Pyrex 13 x 100 mm test tubes: At least 6 dozen should be on hand. Standard volumetric pipettes to deliver 2 ml, 10 ml, 20 ml, fast 1 ml blow-out pipette for sampling hydrolyzing mixture, plus assorted standard pipettes to accomplish necessary sample preparation dilutions.
Reagents
Stock iodine solution. Weigh in glass, 5.5 g reagent grade crystalline iodine; to dissolve add 11 g reagent grade potassium iodide dissolved in minimum (10-12 ml) water. When iodine has completely dissolved dilute to 250 ml. Preserve this solution in an amber glass-stoppered bottle and store under refrigeration. Solution may be used for three months. Dilute iodine solution. Dissolve 2.0 ml of stock iodine solution and 20 g reagent grade potassium iodide in water and dilute to 500 ml. This should be refrigerated and can be used for one week. At the time of making colour comparison, in Procedure below, this solution, should be at the reaction temperature (30). Buffer solution. Solution A: Dissolve 9.078 g of KH2PO4 in water and dilute to one liter. Solution B: Dissolve 9.472 g of Na2HPO4 in water and dilute to one liter. Mix 600 ml of A and 400 ml of B to obtain pH 6.6 buffer. Buffered starch substrate. Determine the dry weight of Merck's Lintner Starch (Special for Diastatic Power Determinations) by drying 20.000 g of starch at 103-104 for 3 h. Weigh after cooling in desiccator and continue drying until weight is constant. Discard after dry weight has been determined.
Calculate the amount of starch equivalent to 10.0 g dry basis for 500 ml starch substrate. Starch should be retained in tightly closed jar and not exposed to environment where the moisture content would be subject to change. Quantitatively transfer a slurry of 10.00 g (dry weight basis) of Merck's Lintner Starch into about 300 ml of vigorously stirred boiling water contained in one liter Pyrex beaker. Leave the stirring rod in the solution after boiling resumes and boil for exactly 3 min. Cool to room temperature in a cold water bath with continuous stirring to avoid skin formation (surface dehydration). Quantitatively transfer the starch into a 500 ml volumetric flask using a small quantity of water to complete the transfer. Add 10 ml of pH 6.6 buffer and dilute to the mark. Check the pH of the starch substrate with a wellstandardized pH meter. Starch substrate should be free of lumps or flakes and prepared fresh daily. Obviously contamination of the starch substrate with even minute traces of enzyme will render the substrate unsuitable for use.
Procedure
Dispense 5.0 ml dilute iodine solution in each of a series of test tubes and allow to attemperate in the 30 bath. Transfer 20.0 ml of buffered starch substrate into a 50 ml Erlenmeyer (or equivalent) (lead rings are convenient to weigh the flask), stopper, place in 30 bath allowing about 15 min to attain uniform temperature within the flask. Likewise attemperate an appropriate amount of freshly prepared sample solution. Rapidly add 10.0 ml of the sample solution, using a blow-out type pipette, and start the timer. After pipette has drained, replace rubber stopper and swirl flask vigorously to insure proper mixing. Table 1. Guide to Selection of Sample Weight
Sample alpha-amylase content (BAU Sample weight to be used mg sample per 10 ml per g) final dilution 70-250 125-500 200 100
50 25 10 5 2.5 1
At appropriate time intervals, add 1 ml (blow-out pipette with cotton plug) of the hydrolyzing mixture to 5 ml of dilute iodine solution at 30, shake to mix thoroughly, pour into the 13 mm precision square tube, and compare with standard alpha-amylase colour disc in the Hellige comparator. After completing the comparison, empty the square tube, giving it a quick shake so that very little liquid remains. The tube may now be used for another test. During the initial stages of reaction, it is not necessary that the one ml sample be measured precisely before adding to the dilute iodine solution. As the endpoint is approached, the addition must be made accurately. The contents of the pipette are blown into the iodine solution in order that the time may be more accurately measured. Around the time of the endpoint, samples should be taken every 0.5 min. In case two samples 0.5 min apart show that one is darker than the standard colour and the other one is lighter, record the endpoint time as the quarter minute between these two times. Care must be exercised to avoid contact of the 1 ml hydrolyzing pipette with the dilute iodine solution. A carry-back of iodine to the hydrolizing mixture will interfere with enzyme action.
Calculation
Calculate the alpha-amylase content of the sample by using the following formula: BAU per g = 40 F/T Where: BAU = Bacterial Amylase Units F = Dilution Factor = Total dilution volume/Sample weight in g T = Dextrinizing Time in min The preceding formula follows from:
The definition of the BAU as the quantity of enzyme that dextrinizes one mg of starch per min, and the assay practice of dextrinizing 400 mg of starch (20 ml of 2% solution) with a 10 ml aliquot of enzyme solution. Thus: BAU per g : 400/T x F/10 = 40 F/T
Report
Report the amylase content of the sample as Bacterial Amylase Units (BAU) per g.
Precision
The mean of duplicate tests should check within 6.5% of the true mean at the 95% confidence level.
Notes
1. If approximate or anticipated BAU of material to be tested is known, determine dilution factor (F) by multiplying desired test time (T) by anticipated BAU and dividing by 40, thus T x BAU/40 = F 2. Example of Calculation. If we assume that for a particular sample being tested the anticipated BAU/g is 800, reference to Table 1 indicates that 25 mg of sample per 10 ml of final dilution should be employed. Therefore, 2.5 g of the sample would be weighed out, and diluted to 1,000 ml. It now becomes possible to calculate the Dilution Factor F: F = Total Dilution Volume/Sample weight in g = 1,000/2.5 = 400 If the dextrinizing time is 20 minutes, the BAU/g can be calculated: BAU/g = 40 F/T = 40 x 400/20 = 16,000/20 = 800 If BAU does not fall within expected limits, a retest should include the practice of making up an entirely new sample preparation. This constitutes a check on the preparation of the test solution where errors may have occurred resulting in erroneous BAU.
Principle
The assay is based on the time required to obtain a standard degree of hydrolysis of a starch solution at 30 0.1. The degree of hydrolysis is determined by comparing the iodine colour of the hydrolysate with that of a standard.
Apparatus
Reference colour standard
Use a special alpha-amylase colour disk available as Catalog No. 620-S5(Available from Hellige, Inc., 3718 Northern Blvd., Long Island City, New York, USA.) or equivalent. Alternatively, a colour standard may be prepared by dissolving 25.0 g of cobaltous chloride (CoCl26H2O) and 3.84 g of potassium dichromate in 100 ml of 0.01 N hydrochloric acid. This standard is stable indefinitely when stored in a stoppered bottle or comparator tube.
Comparator
Use either the standard Hellige comparator (Catalog No. 607) or the pocket comparator (Catalog No. 605) with prism attachment (Catalog No. 605A)1 or equivalent. The comparator should be illuminated with a 100-watt frosted lamp placed 15 cm from the rear opal glass of the comparator and mounted so that direct rays from the lamp do not shine into the operator's eyes.
Comparator tubes
Use the precision-bored square tubes with a 13-mm viewing depth that are supplied with the Hellige comparator. Suitable tubes are also available from other apparatus suppliers. Note. Alternatively the colour comparison can be carried out by using a spectrophotometer at 620 nm and 1-cm cells.
-Amylase solution
Dissolve 250 mg of -amylase, standardized to 2,000 diastatic power and which is free from alpha-amylase (Available from Sturge Enzymes, 1 Wheeley's Road, Birmingham B15 2LE, UK.) in 5 ml of water. Note. The enzyme should be stored in a refrigerator, and it should be allowed to warm to room temperature before opening, in order to prevent condensation of moisture.
Special starch
Use starch designated as "Starch (Lintner) Soluble" Catalog No. 4010 (Available from J.T. Baker Chemicals, Box 218, Steubenville, OH 43952, USA.), or equivalent. Before using new batches, test them in parallel with previous lots known to be satisfactory. Variations of more than 3 diastatic power in the averages of a series of parallel tests indicate an unsuitable batch.
Sample Preparation
Prepare a solution of the sample so that 5 ml of the final dilution will give an endpoint between 10 and 30 min under the conditions of assay.
Procedure
Pipet 5.0 ml of Dilute Iodine Solution into a series of 13 x 100-mm test tubes, and place them in a water bath maintained at 30 0.1, allowing 20 tubes for each assay. Pipet 20.0 ml of the Buffered Substrate Solution, previously heated in the water bath for 20 min, into a 50-ml Erlenmeyer flask, and add 5.0 ml of 0.5% sodium chloride solution, also previously heated in the water bath for 20 min. Place the flask in the water bath. At zero time, rapidly pipet 5.0 ml of the Sample Preparation into the equilibrated substrate, mix immediately by swirling, and then stopper the flask, which should be placed back in the water bath. After 10 min, transfer 1.0 ml of the reaction mixture from the 50-ml flask into one of the test tubes containing the Dilute Iodine Solution, shake the tube, then pour its contents into a Comparator Tube, and immediately compare with the Reference Colour Standard in the Comparator, using a tube of water behind the colour disk.
Note. Be certain that the pipet tip does not touch the iodine solution; carry-back of iodine to the hydrolyzing mixture will interfere with enzyme action and will affect the results of the determination. In the same manner, repeat the transfer and comparison procedure at accurately timed intervals until the alpha-amylase colour is reached, at which time the elapsed time should be recorded. In cases where two comparisons 30 sec apart show that one is darker and the other lighter than the Reference Colour Standard, the endpoint is recorded to the nearest quarter-minute. The 13-mm Comparator Tube should be shaken out between successive readings. Slight differences in colour discrimination between operators may be minimized by the use of a prism attachment and by maintaining a 15 to 25 cm distance between the Comparator and the operator's eye.
Calculation
One alpha-amylase dextrinizing unit (DU) is defined as the quantity of alpha-amylase that will dextrinize soluble starch in the presence of an excess of -amylase at the rate of 1 g per h at 30. Calculate the alpha-amylase dextrinizing units in the sample as follows: DU (solution) = 24 / (W x T), and DU (dry basis) = [DU (solution) x 100] / (100 - M) in which W = the weight, in g, of the enzyme sample added to the incubation mixture in the 5-ml aliquot of the Sample Preparation used, T = the elapsed dextrinizing time in min, 24 = the product of the weight of the starch substrate (0.4 g) and 60 min, and M = the % moisture in the sample, determined by suitable means.
ALPHA-AMYLASE ACTIVITY, MALT (Amer. Soc. Brewing Chemistry, 6th ed., 169 (1958)) Reagents
-amylase
The special -amylase powder free from a-amylase made by Wallerstein Laboratories, 180 Madison Ave., New York 16, N.Y., should be used. This enzyme preparation has been standardized at Diastatic Power-2,000 and conforms to the following specifications: (1) At the addition level used, the variation in the dextrinization of one and three-dayold substrates obtained with a standard malt infusion is not more than 5%. (2) The dextrinization by a standard malt infusion of a substrate prepared by adding 500 mg of -amylase (instead of the standard 250 mg) does not vary more than 5%
from that obtained with the standard substrate, when both substrates are destrinized 24 h after their preparation. The -amylase powder should be stored in the refrigerator in a tightly closed bottle. To avoid condensation of moisture on the cold enzyme preparation in humid atmospheres, the bottle should be allowed to warm up to room temperature before opening.
Special starch
Starch manufactured specifically for diastatic power determinations is available from e.g. Merck & Co., Rahway, New Jersey. It is designated, "Soluble Starch Merck, according to Lintner, Special for diastatic power determination". When purchasing new batches of starch, test them in parallel with the lot in use. Variations of more than 3 Diastatic Power in the averages of a series of parallel tests indicate an unsuitable batch of starch.
Buffer solution
Dissolve 164 g of anhydrous sodium acetate in water. Add 120 ml of glacial acetic acid and dilute the solution to one liter.
Apparatus
Constant temperature bath
20 ( 0.05).
Comparator
Either the standard Hellige comparator (Catalog No. 607) or the pocket comparator (Catalog No. 605) with prism attachment (Catalog No. 605A) (Amer. Soc. Brewing Chemistry, 6th ed., 169 (1958).). In use illuminate the comparator with a 100-watt frosted lamp placed 15 cm from the rear opal glass of the comparator. Direct rays, from the lamp must not shine into the operator's eyes.
Comparator tubes
Precision square tubes, with a 13 mm liquid thickness at the viewing point. The alphaamylase colour disc gives correct values only when used with a 13 mm viewing thickness. Precision square cuvettes avoid the necessity of calibrating individual test tubes and insure the use of a standard viewing thickness. The 13 mm precision square tubes are supplied as standard equipment with the Hellige comparator, and are also used with the Coleman Universal Spectrophotometer. They may be obtained from Hellige Inc., distributors of the Coleman Instruments, or from Fisher and Porter Co., Hatboro, Pensylvania.
Glassware
Infusion flasks: One litre Erlenmeyer flask or glass stoppered bottle is suitable. Pipettes: 2.00 ml, precision; 20 ml; 5 ml; one ml bacteriological. Test tubes, 12 x 100 mm. Erlenmeyer flasks 50 ml. Funnels, 20 cm. An all-glass automatic pipette, such as the Machlett type, is recommended for rapid dispensing of the dilute iodine solution. A fast flowing pipette such as a one ml bacteriological pipette (blow-out type) is recommended for withdrawing the one ml aliquote near the end of the determination.
Filter paper
See Malt-4, Extract, Apparatus (d) (See Amer. Soc. Brewing Chemistry, 6th ed., Method MALT 4, p. 162, 1958. )
Stopwatch
Or clock that indicates sec.
Method
Preparation of the malt infusion
Extract 25 g 0.05 g of finely ground malt according to the method of Malt-6, Diastatic Power, Preparation of Malt Infusion (FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series No. 50B, p. 83, WHO/Food Add./2, 1972.), using 500 ml of 0.5% sodium chloride solution. Dilute 20 ml of the filtered infusion of malt to 100 ml with 0.5% sodium chloride solution.
Add 5.0 ml of Dilute Iodine Solution to each of a series of 13 x 100 mm test tubes and attemperate them to 20 in the water bath. The buffered limit-dextrin substrate and the diluted malt infusion should also be attempered and adjusted to final volume at 20 before starting the dextrinization. Transfer with a pipette, 20.0 ml of substrate solution at 20 to a 50 ml Erlenmeyer flask, add 5 ml of 0.5% sodium chloride solution and again adjust the temperature to 20. Add 5 ml of diluted malt infusion at 20, blowing it in and counting the time from the instant the first of the dilute malt infusion reaches the substrate in the flask. Mix and leave the reaction mixture in the bath at 20 0.05. After 10 min transfer one ml of the hydrolyzing mixture to one of the tubes containing 5 ml of dilute iodine solution at 20. Shake, pour the iodine solution into a 13 mm square comparator tube, and immediately compare with the alpha-amylase colour disc in the comparator with a tube of distilled water behind the colour disc. Repeat the comparison at intervals with a fresh one ml portion of hydrolyzing mixture until the alpha-amylase colour is reached. Slight differences in colour discrimination between different operators may be minimized by the use of the prism attachment, and maintenance of a six- to ten-inch reading distance between the eye and the comparator. For the first few comparisons it is not necessary for the one ml sample of hydrolyzing mixture to be measured with precision before adding it to the dilute iodine solution. As the endpoint is approached the addition must be made accurately with a one ml pipette. The contents of the pipette should be blown into the iodine solution. Near the endpoint comparisons should be made every thirty sec. In case two comparisons 30 sec apart show that one is darker and the other lighter than the alpha-amylase colour disc, the endpoint is recorded to the nearest quarter min. The 13 mm square tube used for colour comparisons is shaken out between successive readings. For accuracy and convenience, dextrinization times should fall between 10 and 30 min. With malts of low alpha-amylase activity it may be necessary to use 10 ml of the diluted malt infusion. In this case do not add the five ml of 0.5% sodium chloride solution. The final volume of the hydrolyzing mixture should always be 30 ml.
Calculation
An alpha-amylase unit is defined as the quantity of alpha-amylase which will dextrinize soluble starch in the presence of an excess of -amylase at the rate of one g per h at 20. Calculate the alpha-amylase units in the malt by use of the formula: 20 D.U. (as is) = 24 / WT 20 D.U. (dry basis) = (D.U. (as is) 100) / (100 - M) in which D.U. = Dextrinizing Units, W = Malt weight equivalent of the aliquot of dilute malt infusion used, T = Dextrinizing time in min, M = % moisture in the malt.
In the formula, 24 is the product of the weight of starch in the hydrolyzing mixture (0.4 g) and 60 min. Report Dextrinizing Units to the nearest half unit. Example M = 4.1% moisture in the malt, W = 0.05 g of malt in the aliquot of infusion, T = 20 min to obtain dextrinization. 20 D.U. (as is) = 24 / (0.05 x 20) = 24 20 D.U. (dry basis) = (24 x 100) / (100 x 4.1) = 25
Principle
The assay is based on the measurement of inhibition of bacterial growth under specific circumstances.
Culture Plates
Six organisms are tested: Staphylococcus aureus ATCC 6538; Escherichia coli ATCC 11229; Bacillus cereus ATCC 2; Bacillus circulans ATCC 4516; Streptococcus pyrogenes ATCC 12344: and Serratia marcescens ATCC 14041. Make a test plate of each organism by preparing a 1:10 dilution of a 24 h Trypticase Soya Broth culture in Trypticase Agar (TSA) (for Streptococcus pyrogenes ATCC 12344 a 1:20 dilution). Pour 15 ml of plain TSA into a Petri dish and allow the medium to harden. Overlay with 10 ml of seeded TSA and allow to solidify. Place a paper disk prepared according to Disk Preparation of the tested enzyme on each of the 6 inoculated plates.
Disk Preparation
Make a 10% solution of the enzyme by adding 1 g of enzyme to 9 ml of sterile, distilled water. Mix thoroughly with a Vortex mixer to obtain a homogeneous suspension. Autoclave suitable paper disks (for instance, S & S Analytical Filter Papers No. 740-E, 12.7 mm in diameter), then saturate them with the enzyme by application of 0.1 ml (about 3 drops) of a 10% solution of the enzyme to the disk surface. Prepare 6 disks (1 for each of the 6 organisms) for each enzyme: place one disk on the surface of the 6 inoculated agar plates.
Incubation
Keep the 6 plates in the refrigerator overnight to obtain proper diffusion. Incubate the plates at 37 for 24 h. Examine the plates for any inhibition zones that may have been caused by the enzyme preparation.
Interpretation
A visually clear zone around a disk (total diameter: 16 mm) indicates the presence of antibacterial components in the enzyme preparation. If an enzyme preparation shows obvious antibacterial activity against 3 (or more) organisms, it is concluded that antimicrobial agents are present.
Principle
The assay is an exhaustion method based on the breakdown of hydrogen peroxide by catalase, and the simultaneous breakdown of the catalase by the peroxide, under controlled conditions.
Procedure
Pipet an aliquot of not more than 1.0 ml of the sample, previously diluted to contain approximately 3.5 Baker Units of catalase, into a 200-ml beaker. Rapidly add 100 ml of Peroxide Substrate Solution, previously adjusted to 25, and stir immediately for 5 to 10 sec. Cover the beaker, and incubate at 25 1 until the reaction is completed. Stir vigorously for 5 sec and then pipet 4.0 ml from the beaker into a 50-ml Erlenmeyer flask. Add 5 ml of 2 N sulfuric acid to the flask, mix, then add 5.0 ml of 40% potassium iodide, freshly prepared, and 1 drop of 1% ammonium molybdate and mix. While continuing to mix, titrate rapidly to a colourless endpoint with 0.250 N Sodium thiosulfate, recording the volume, in ml, required as S. Perform a blank determination with 4.0 ml of Peroxide Substrate Solution, and record the volume required, in ml, as B. (Note. When preparations derived from beef liver are tested, the reaction is complete within 30 min. Preparations derived from Aspergillus and other sources may require up to 1 h. In assaying an enzyme of unknown origin, a titration should be run after 30 min and then at 10 min intervals thereafter. The reaction is complete when two consecutive titrations are the same.)
Calculation
One Baker Unit is that amount of catalase that will decompose 266 mg of hydrogen peroxide under the conditions of the assay. Calculate the activity of the sample by the formula: Baker Units per g or ml = 0.4 (B - S) x (1/C) in which C is the ml of aliquot of original enzyme preparation added to each 100 ml of Peroxide Substrate Solution, or, when 1 ml of diluted enzyme is used, C is the dilution factor.
Apparatus
Viscometer: Use a Brookfield Model LVF or equivalent-type viscometer, with a No. 1 Spindle, capable of rotating at 12 rpm and of being read in cP. A suitable viscometer is available from Brookfield Engineering Laboratories, Inc., 240, Cushing Street, Stoughton, Mass. 02072. Sample Container: Use a 250-ml beaker, or equivalent container, designed for use with the Brookfield viscometer. Berzelius beakers, available as Corning Catalog No. 1140, are suitable for this purpose.
Beater: Use a wire whip hand beater, such as the Ekco Presto-Whip with a spiral cone (available at hardware stores).
Calculation
One cellulase activity (CA) unit is defined as the quantity of enzyme in g required to reduce the viscosity of 200 g of a 5% solution of the specified sodium carboxymethyl cellulose substrate from 400 to 300 cP at 35 0.1 and pH 5.0, in 1 h. Calculate the activity of the enzyme preparation taken for analysis by the formula CA, units/g = 1,000 x 60 x 60/(W x Tu), in which W is the weight, in mg, of cellulase contained in the 5 ml aliquot of the Sample Preparation used.
Apparatus
High performance liquid chromatograph equipped with an ultraviolet detector (254 nm), injection valve and Lichrosorb DIOL column, 5 nm, 4.6-mm i.d. x 25cm (or equivalent) Glass syringe 10 l Separatory funnel, 100 ml Pipettes of convenient volumes for the preparation of standard solutions.
Hexane, UV grade, distilled in glass 2-propanol, UV grade, distilled in glass Methyl alcohol, UV grade, distilled in glass Acetone, UV grade, distilled in glass 1,2-naphthoquinone-4-sulfonic acid, sodium salt 0.1 N sodium hydroxide (NaOH) 0.1 M Potassium dihydrogen phosphate (KH2PO4)
Buffer Solution: pH 7.7; mix 200 ml of 0.1 M KH2PO4 with 93.4 ml of 0.1 N NaOH. Folin's Reagent: Dissolve 0.40 g of 1,2-naphtoquinone-4-sulfonic acid sodium salt in 100 ml of buffer solution. Dilute to 500 ml with distilled water in a volumetric flask. Wrap
the flask in aluminium foil and store in the refrigerator. Discard the reagent after five days. 4-(1-Aziridinyl)-1,2-naphthoquinone: A standard sample of known purity is required. If a commercial source for this standard is not readily available, the substance may by synthesized by the following procedure: Wrap a separatory funnel with aluminium foil and add 2 g of the sodium salt of 1,2naphthoquinone-4-sulfonic acid dissolved in 250 ml of distilled water. Add 25 ml of 0.5 M trisodium phosphate, shake and check that the pH is between 10.5 and 11.5. Add 0.3 ml ethylenimine (CAUTION: Ethylenimine has been identified as a carcinogen. Appropriate precautions must be taken in handling the compound to avoid personnel exposure and area contamination.) and shake intermittently for 10 min. Extract the 4-(aziridinyl)-1,2-naphthoquinone formed with six 200-ml portions of chloroform. Place the combined extracts in a 2-L beaker wrapped in aluminium foil in which three holes have been made. Evaporate the chloroform with a nitrogen purge. Transfer the dry residue to a 50-ml beaker wrapped in aluminium foil. Add 35 ml of methyl alcohol and 1 ml of chloroform to the residue and stir briefly. Not all of the residue will dissolve. Place the beaker in an ice-water bath for 10 min and then filter the precipitate through Whatman 42 filter paper. Rinse the precipitate in the filter with 4 ml of chilled methyl alcohol and discard the filtrates. Dry the precipitate with a nitrogen purge, transfer it to a brown glass bottle and purge again. Dry the compound overnight in a desiccator containing Drierite. The melting point of the compound is 173-175. The compound is to be used for making standard solutions for calibration purposes. The compound should be stored in a freezer until standard solutions are to be prepared. 0.5 g/L Standard Solution: Accurately weigh about 125 mg of 4-(1-aziridinyl)-1,2naphthoquinone into a 250 ml volumetric flask [low actinic glass] and add chloroform to the mark. 0.1 mg/L Standard Solution: By appropriate dilution(s) of the 0.5 g/L Standard Solution, prepare a standard solution which contains 0.1 mg/L (0.1 ng/l).
Analysis
Accurately weigh a sample of immobilized enzyme preparation containing about 10 g of dry matter into an aluminium foil-covered beaker. Add 50 ml of Folin's Reagent and
agitate the mixture for several minutes. Decant the Folin's Reagent into a separatory funnel and extract with 2 ml of chloroform. Analyze a 20 l portion of the chloroform extract by the following chromatographic conditions: Column: Lichrosorb DIOL 5 nm (or equivalent) Mobile phase: hexane : chloroform (with 1% ethanol) : isopropanol = 59.5 : 40.0 : 0.5 (v/v) Flow rate: 2 ml/min. Inject a 20 l portion of the 0.1 mg/L Standard Solution. The sample response is not greater than that of the 0.1 mg/L Standard Solution. (Another sample containing a standard addition of 4-(1-aziridinyl)-1,2-naphthoquinone to immobilized enzyme preparation should be analyzed to verify that the chromatographic response does not contain interfering substances.)
Acetate buffer
Transfer 60 g of glacial acetic acid into a 1,000-ml volumetric flask, dilute to volume with water, and mix. With the aid of a suitable pH meter, adjust the pH of this solution to 4.2 by the addition of a sodium acetate solution prepared by dissolving 136 g of NaC2H3O23H2O in sufficient water to make 1,000 ml. Note. A pH of 5.0 should be used when testing preparations derived from Aspergillusoryzae or Rhizopusoryzae.
Fehling's solution A
Prepare the Copper Solution (A) as directed under Alkaline Cupric Tartrate TS.
Fehling's solution B
Prepare the Alkaline Tartrate Solution (B) as directed under Alkaline Cupric Tartrate TS.
Sample Preparation
The Procedure below is based on the use of a sample containing 0.1 to 0.2 unit of glucoamylase activity. This sample size will produce 0.2 to 0.4 g of reducing sugars under the conditions specified, and maximum accuracy is obtained in this range. For slightly less accurate results, an enzyme dosage range of 0.05 to 3.0 units may be used if necessary. Liquid samples, solid samples, and liquid concentrates should be prepared as directed in the following tables, and the aliquot size indicated should be used in the Procedure (Production of Reducing Sugars).
5.0 100 1.00 4.0 100 1.00 3.0 100 1.00 2.0 100 1.00
1,000 1,000 1,000 1,000 1,000 1,000 1,000 1,000 2,000 2,000
5.0 5.0 5.0 3.0 2.0 2.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0
Accurately weigh the sample into a volumetric flask, fill the flask two-thirds full of water, and allow the stoppered flask to stand at room temperature for at least 30 min, shaking vigorously at least 5 times during that period. Dilute to volume with water, and mix well. Take the indicated aliquot from a portion of the sample solution that has been filtered through Whatman No. 12 or equivalent filter paper.
Procedure
Production of reducing sugars
Pipet 50.0 ml of the Starch Hydrolyzate Solution and 5.0 ml of Acetate Buffer into a 100-ml volumetric flask. Prepare a second flask in the same manner for use as the control, and carry this flask through the same procedure concurrently, but use water in place of the Sample Preparation. Place the flask in a water bath maintained at 60, and allow to stand for at least 10 min. Note. Use 55 when testing preparation derived from Aspergillusoryzae and Rhizopusoryzae. Pipet an appropriately sized aliquot of the Sample Preparation into the flask, and simultaneously begin timing the reaction.
Note. If a series of samples is being analyzed, pipet aliquots at timed intervals, so spaced as to permit neutralization of each after 120 min of reaction time. Swirl the contents of the flask to mix thoroughly, and allow to stand in the water bath for 120 min. When 115 to 118 min of the reaction period has passed, add 3 drops of phenolphthalein TS, then when exactly 120 min has elapsed, remove the flask from the bath, and immediately neutralize the contents by the addition of 2% sodium hydroxide solution, preferably added with a fast-flowing buret (about 3 to 7 ml is usually required). Cool to room temperature in a running-water bath, dilute to volume with water, and mix thoroughly. Determine the reducing sugars content on a 10.0-ml aliquot of this solution, and on a 10.0-ml aliquot of the control, as directed below.
Calculation
Reducing sugars content
By reference to the accompanying table, entitled Conversion of Titer Difference to Reducing Sugars Content, determine the weight, in mg, of reducing sugars equivalent to the volume Ts, and record the value thus obtained as Ws. In a similar manner, determine the weight of reducing sugars equivalent to the volume Tc, and record this value as Wc. Calculate the total reducing sugars (as dextrose) produced by the aliquot of Sample Preparation taken by the formula
32.3 32.7 33.0 33.3 33.7 34.0 34.3 34.6 35.0 35.3 35.7 36.0 36.3 36.7 37.0 37.3 37.6 38.0 38.3 38.7 39.0 39.3 39.6 40.0 40.3 40.6 41.0 41.3 41.7 42.0 42.4 42.8 43.1 43.4 43.7 44.1 44.4 44.8 45.2 45.5 45.8 46.2 46.5 46.9 47.2 47.6 47.9 48.3 48.6 48.9
49.3 49.6 49.9 50.3 50.7 51.1 51.4 51.7 52.1 52.4 52.8 53.2 53.5 53.9 54.2 54.5 54.9 55.3 55.6 56.0 56.3 56.7 57.0 57.3 57.7 58.1 58.4 58.8 59.1 59.5 59.8 60.1 60.5 60.9 61.2 61.5 61.9 62.3 62.6 63.0 63.3 63.6 64.0 64.3 64.7 65.0 65.4 65.8 66.1 66.5
66.9 67.2 67.6 68.0 68.4 68.8 69.1 69.5 69.9 70.3 70.7 71.1 71.5 71.9 72.2 72.6 73.0 73.4 73.7 74.1 74.5 74.9 75.3 75.7 76.1 76.5 76.9 77.3 77.7 78.1 78.5 78.9 79.3 79.7 80.1 80.5 80.9 81.3 81.7 82.1 82.6 83.0 83.4 83.8 84.2 84.6 85.0 85.4 85.8 86.2
86.6 87.0 87.4 87.8 88.2 88.6 89.0 89.4 89.8 90.2 90.7 91.1 91.5 91.9 92.3 92.7 93.1 93.5 93.9 94.3 94.8
Use of this table presumes the ability of the analyst to duplicate exactly the conditions under which the data were developed. The risk of error can be avoided by careful duplicate standardization with known quantities of pure dextrose (5 samples, ranging from 10 to 70 mg). A plot of Titer Difference vs. mg of dextrose is slightly curvilinear, passing through the origin. If use of a standardization curve is adopted, the thiosulfate solution need not be standardized. Some additional increase in accuracy results from use of a 0.065 N sodium thiosulfate solution, which increases the blank titer to about 44-45 ml. Ds, g = Ws x 100/(1,000 x 10), Calculate the total reducing sugars (as dextrose) produced by the control by the formula Dc, g = Wc x 100/(1,000 x 10)
Buchner funnel, and wash the paper with about 20 ml of water. Add 680 mg of monobasic potassium phosphate to the filtrate, and refilter through a 0.22-m Millipore filter pad, or equivalent. Wash the pad with 10 ml of water, and adjust the pH of the filtrate to 6.5 0.05 with 1 N sodium hydroxide or 1 N hydrochloric acid. Transfer the filtrate into a 100-ml volumetric flask, dilute to volume with water, and mix. Store at 2 to 4 for not more than 3 days. Glucose Standard Solution: Dissolve 36.0 mg of anhydrous dextrose in Phosphate Buffer in a 1,000-ml volumetric flask, dilute to volume with water, and mix. Test Preparation: Prepare a solution from the enzyme preparation sample so that 1 ml of the final dilution will contain between 0.01 and 0.02 -glucanase units. Weigh the sample, transfer it into a volumetric flask of appropriate size, dilute to volume with Phosphate Buffer, and mix. Procedure: Pipet 2 ml of Lichenin Substrate into each of four separate test tubes graduated at 25 ml, and heat the tubes in a water bath at 40 for 10 to 15 min to equilibrate. After equilibration, add 1 ml of Phosphate Buffer to tube 1, 1 ml of Glucose Standard Solution to tube 2 (glucose standard), 4 ml of Neocuproine Solution A and 1 ml of the Test preparation to tube 4 (sample). Prepare a fifth tube for the buffer blank, to which 3 ml of Phosphate Buffer is added. Incubate the five tubes at 40 for exactly 15 min, and then add 4 ml of Neocuproine Solution A to tubes 1, 2, 4, and 5. Add 4 ml of Neocuproine Solution B to all five tubes, and cap them with a suitably sized glass marble. (Caution: Do not use rubber stoppers.) Heat the tubes in a vigorously boiling water bath for exactly 12 min to develop colour, then cool to room temperature in cold water, and adjust the volume of each to 25 ml with water. Cap the tubes with Parafilm, or other suitable closure, and mix by inverting several times. Determine the absorbance of each solution at 450 nm in 1-cm cells, with a suitable spectrophotometer, against the buffer blank in tube 5. Calculation: One -glucanase unit (BGU) is defined as that quantity of enzyme in g that will liberate 1 mol of reducing sugar (as glucose equivalence) per min under the conditions of the assay. Calculate the activity of the enzyme preparation taken for analysis as follows: BGU = [(A4 - A3) x 36 x 106 ] / [(A2 - A1) x 180 x 15 x g Sample)] in which A4 is the absorbance of the sample (tube 4), A3 is the absorbance of the enzyme blank (tube 3), A2 is the absorbance of the glucose standard (tube 2), A1 is the absorbance of the substrate blank (tube 1), 36 is the g of glucose in the Glucose Standard Solution, 106 is the factor converting g to g, 180 is the weight of 1 mol of glucose, and 15 is the reaction time.
Principle
The assay is based on measurement of the rate of conversion of glucose to fructose in a packed bed reactor. The procedure as outlined approximates an initial velocity assay method. Specific conditions are: glucose concentration, 45% w/w; pH (inlet), measured at room temperature in the 7.0 to 8.5 range, as specified; temperature, 60.0; and magnesium concentration, 4 x 10-3M. The optimum conditions for enzymes from different microbial sources and methods of preparation may vary; therefore, if different pH conditions, buffering systems, or methods of sample preparation are recommended by the manufacturer, such variations in the instructions given herein should be used.
Note. Glucose isomerase activity of the commercial enzyme is usually determined on the enzyme that has been immobilized by binding with a polymer matrix or other suitable material. This method is designed for use with such preparations.
Sample Preparation
Transfer to a 500-ml vacuum flask an amount of the sample, accurately weighed in g or measured in ml, as appropriate, sufficient to obtain 2,000 to 8,000 glucose isomerase
units (GIc U). Add 200 ml of Glucose Substrate, stir gently for 15 sec and repeat the stirring every 5 min for 40 min. Deaerate by vacuum for 30 min.
Column Preparation
Quantitatively transfer the Sample Preparation to the column with the aid of Magnesium Sulfate Solution as necessary. Allow the enzyme granules to settle, and then place a porous disk so that it is even with, and in contact with, the top of the enzyme bed. All of the air should be displaced from the disk. Place a cotton plug about 1 or 2 cm above the disk. (This plug acts as a filter. It ensures proper heating of the solution and traps dissolved gases that may be present in the Glucose Substrate.) Connect the tubing from the peristaltic pump with the top of the column, and seal the connection by suitable means in order to protect the column contents from the atmosphere. Place the inlet tube of the peristaltic pump into the Glucose Substrate solution, and begin a downward flow of the Glucose Substrate into the column at a rate of at least 80 ml per h. Maintain the flow rate for 1 h at room temperature.
Procedure
Adjust the flow of the Glucose Substrate to such a rate that a fractional conversion of 0.2 to 0.3 will be produced, based on the estimated activity of the sample. The fractional conversion is calculated from optical rotation values obtained on the starting Glucose Substrate and the sample effluent, as specified under Calculations below. After the correct flow rate has been established, run the column overnight (16 h minimum), then check the pH of the Glucose Substrate, and readjust if necessary to the specified pH. Measure the flow rate, and collect a sample of the column effluent. Cover the effluent sample, allow it to stand for 30 min at room temperature, and then determine the fractional conversion of glucose to fructose (see Calculations below). If the conversion is less than 0.2 or more than 0.3, adjust the flow rate to bring the conversion into this range. If a flow rate adjustment is required, collect an additional effluent sample after allowing the column to re-equilibrate for at least 2 h and then determine the fractional conversion. Measure the flow rate, and collect an effluent sample. Cover the sample, let it stand at room temperature for 30 min, and determine the fractional conversion.
Calculations
Specific rotation
Measure the optical rotation of the effluent sample and of the starting Glucose Substrate at 25.0, and calculate their specific rotations by the formula: [alpha]25D = 100 a/lpd in which a = the corrected observed rotation, in degrees, l = the length of the polarimeter tube, in dm, p = the concentration of the test solution, expressed as g of solute per 100 g of solution, and d = the specific gravity of the solution at 25
Fractional conversion
Calculate the fractional conversion, X, by the formula: X = (alphaE - alphaS) / (alphaF - alphaS) in which alphaE = the specific rotation of the column effluent, alphaS = the specific rotation of the Glucose Substrate, and alphaF = the specific rotation of fructose (which in this case has been calculted to be -94.54).
Activity
The enzyme activity is expressed in glucose isomerase units (CIcU, the subscript c signifying column process). One GIcU is defined as the amount of enzyme that converts glucose to fructose at an initial rate of 1 mol per min, under the conditions specified.
Calculate the glucose isomerase activity by the formula: CIcU per g or ml = (FS/W) [Xe ln Xe / (Xe - X)] in which F = the flow rate, in ml per min, S = the concentration of the Glucose Substrate, in ml per ml, Xe = the fractional conversion at equilibrium, or 0.51, and W = the weight or volume of the sample taken, in g or ml, respectively.
Principle
The assay is based upon oxygen uptake in the presence of excess substrate, excess air, and excess catalase.
Apparatus
Warburg apparatus
Use the apparatus, or equivalent, supplied as Catalog No. 666900(Available from Precision Scientific Co., 3737 W. Cortland St., Chicago, Ill. 60647, USA.).
Manometer
Use the manometer, or equivalent, supplied as Catalog No. 66665 (Available from Precision Scientific Co., 3737 W. Cortland St., Chicago, Ill. 60647, USA.).
Reaction flasks
Use the 15-ml flasks, or equivalent, supplied as Catalog No. 66703 (Available from Precision Scientific Co., 3737 W. Cortland St., Chicago, Ill. 60647, USA.).
Sample Solution
Weigh accurately a suitable amount of the enzyme preparation, and dilute it with water to a known volume to obtain a solution containing between 10 and 20 glucose oxidase units per ml. Note. If the enzyme preparation contains less than one Baker unit of catalase (See Scott, D. and Hommer, F., Enzymologia, 22, p. 194 (1960).), catalase must be added to meet or exceed the minimum ratio. Transfer a 1.0-ml aliquot into a 100-ml volumetric flask, dilute rapidly to volume with the Buffered Dextrose Substrate (previously adjusted to a temperature of 25), and mix. This solution may be unstable and should be used as soon as possible.
Procedure
Pipet 2.0 ml portions of the Sample Solution into four calibrated Reaction Flasks, taking care that none of the solution is pipetted into the wells of the flasks. Using rubber bands or springs, secure each flask to a calibrated Manometer, and place the assembly in the water bath, maintained at 30 0.01 of the Warburg Apparatus. Open the manometer stopcocks leading to the flasks, and allow the manometers to oscillate, using a mechanical shaker, at a rate of 120 times per min, with a stroke of 4 cm for 10 min in order to equilibrate the temperature of the flasks. After temperature equilibration has been reached, adjust the manometers to the initial volume for the respective reaction flasks. Close the stopcocks, and shake again for 30 min. Readjust the manometers to their original volumes, and note the change in pressure (P), in mm, for each flask.
Calculation
One unit of glucose oxidase activity is defined as that quantity of enzyme that will cause the uptake of 10 mm3 of oxygen per min in a Warburg manometer at 30 in the presence of excess air and excess catalase, and with a substrate containing 3.3% glucose monohydrate and 0.1 M phosphate buffer at pH 5.9, with 0.4% sodium dehydroacetate (See Scott, D., J. Agric. Food Chem., 1, p. 727, (1953).). Calculate the activity of the enzyme preparation by the formula: Glucose Oxidase Units, per g or ml = (P x C x D)/(30 min x 10 mm3 x V) in which P = the pressure drop, in mm, observed in the reaction flask, corrected for thermobarometer change (Umbreit, W.W., Burris, R.H. and Stauffer, J.F., Manometric techniques, Third Edition, Burgess Publishing Co., Minneapolis, Minn., (1957), pp. 67.), C = the reaction flask constant (Umbreit, W.W. et al, Ibid., pp. 61-63.), D = the dilution factor of the enzyme solution, and V = the volume, in ml, of Sample Solution used in the Procedure. Average the four values thus calculated to obtain the activity of the enzyme preparation taken for analysis.
Calculation
The relationship between the determination of glutaraldehyde and the determination of activity of the prepared immobilized enzyme can be expressed in the following way: a = (mg GA/kg syrup) / (GIcU/g enzyme) GA = Glutaraldehyde GIcU = activity unit for glucose isomerase in column process
Procedure
Samples of syrup during the assay for "Glucose isomerase activity" are taken at steps as prescribed in the following: Sample 1: 25 ml of syrup is taken out at the step called "Sample preparation" (i.e. syrup decanted off, just after the prescribed 40 min soaking period). Sample 2: 25 ml of syrup is taken out at the step called "Procedure" (i.e. isomerized syrup from the column outlet just after the flow rate has been adjusted to the correct level). Sample 3: 25 ml of syrup is taken out at the point of time when samples are taken for determination of the fractional conversion of the glucose to fructose. As prescribed, this time is at least 16 hours after start-up. In actual practice the time for taking this effluent sample will be in the interval 42-48 hours after start-up. All three samples (Samples 1, 2, and 3) are subjected to determination for glutaraldehyde as described in "Determination of glutaraldehyde in High Fructose Corn Syrup". As indicated in the text of the assay, it has been determined that the lower detection limit for glutaraldehyde in HFCS (High Fructose Corn Syrup) is 5 mg/kg by this assay.
The enzyme passes test if the average "a" from the three samples tested is not greater than 0.025. (For GA concentrations below the detection limit 5 mg/kg, the value 5 mg/kg is taken.)
Examples
(1) a = 0.025 is equal to an average GA concentration of 5 mg/kg from 200 GIcU/g enzyme. (2) a = 0.025 is equal to an average GA concentration of 7.5 mg/kg from 300 GIcU/g enzyme.
Principle
The assay is based on a measurement using thin layer chromatography.
Solvent system
Transfer 5.0 ml absolute ethanol to a 100-ml volumetric flask and fill up to the mark with chloroform. Transfer to a 250-ml flask and shake very thoroughly before pouring the mixture into the developing chamber.
Spray reagents
(Sufficient for one TLC plate) I: 1% MBTH Dissolve 250 mg MBTH (N-methyl-benzothiazolonhydrazon-HCl) in 25 ml water. II: 2% Ferric chloride Dissolve 0.5 g ferric chloride (FeCl36H2O) in 25 ml water.
Standard Solutions
Glutaraldehyde stock solution (1 mg/ml)
Transfer 0.4 ml of 25% glutardialdehyde solution (Merck No. 12179) to a 100-ml volumetric flask. Make up to the mark with water.
Assay Solutions
Transfer to 10-ml volumetric flasks: Assay solution (a): 7.50 g of HFCS sample; Assay solution (b): 7.50 g of HFCS sample and 1.50 ml of glutaraldehyde solution (25 g/ml) corresponding to 37.5 g of glutaraldehyde. Make both solutions up to volume with water.
Procedure
Treat the standard and assay solutions for 30 min in an ultra-sonic bath immediately before use. Spot the TLC plate as follows: Spot 1: 150 l of glutaraldehyde solution (3.75 g/ml) equivalent to 0.5625 g glutaraldehyde. Spot 2: 150 l of assay solution (b) equivalent to 0.5625 g glutaraldehyde plus 0.1125 g HFCS sample. Spot 3: 150 l of assay solution (a) equivalent to 0.1125 g HFCS sample. The spots should be placed at least 3 cm from the edges of the plate and 5 cm apart. Allow the spots to dry at room temperature. Run the chromatogram until the solvent front has migrated 15 cm (30-40 min). Allow the plate to dry for at least 30 min at room temperature. Spray with reagent I using a fine nozzle. Approximately 20 ml are needed. Wait for 10 min and then spray with reagent II until the spots can be seen. Approximately 25 ml are needed.
Estimation
Estimate the glutaraldehyde content of the assay sample (spot 3) by comparison with the standard (spot 1). If the intensity of assay sample spot 3 is less than the intensity of standard spot 1, then the HFCS sample contains < 5 mg/kg of glutaraldehyde. Spot 2 is included as proof that the method can detect 5 mg/kg of glutaraldehyde in HFCS.
Apparatus
Viscometer: Use a size 100 calibrated Cannon-Fenske Type Viscometer, or its equivalent. A suitable viscometer is supplied as Catalog No. 2885-100 by Scientific Products, 1210 Waukegan Road, McGraw Park, Ill. 60085. Glass Water Bath: Use a constant-temperature glass water bath maintained at 40 0.1. A suitable bath is supplied as Catalog No. W3520 10 by Scientific Products.
Sample Preparation: Prepare a solution of the sample in water so that 1 ml of the final dilution will produce a change in relative fluidity between 0.18 and 0.22 in 5 min under the conditions specified in the Procedure. Weigh the enzyme preparation, quantitatively transfer it to a glass mortar, and triturate with water. Quantitatively transfer the mixture to an appropriately sized volumetric flask, dilute to volume with water, and mix. Filter through Whatman No. 1 filter paper, or equivalent, before use. Procedure: Scrupulously clean the Viscometer by drawing a large volume of detergent solution, followed by water, through the instrument, and place the viscometer, previously calibrated, in the Glass Water Bath in an exactly vertical position. Pipet 20.0 ml of Substrate Solution and 4.0 ml of Acetate Buffer into a 50-ml Erlenmeyer flask, allowing at least two flasks for each enzyme sample and one flask for a substrate blank. Stopper the flasks, and equilibrate them in the water bath for 15 min. At zero time, pipet 1.0 ml of the Sample Preparation into the equilibrated substrate, start timing with a stopwatch (No. 1), and mix thoroughly. Immediately pipet 10.0 ml of this mixture into the wide arm of the Viscometer. After about 2 min, draw the reaction mixture above the upper mark into the driving fluid head by applying suction with a rubber tube connected to the narrow arm of the instrument. Measure the efflux time by allowing the reaction mixture to flow freely down past the upper mark. As the meniscus falls past the upper mark, start a second stopwatch (No. 2), and at the same time record the reaction time (TR), in min, from stopwatch No. 1. As the meniscus of the reaction mixture falls past the lower mark, record the time (TT), in sec, from stopwatch No. 2. Immediately redraw the reaction mixture above the upper mark and into the driving fluid head. As the meniscus falls freely past the upper mark, restart stopwatch No. 2, and at the same time record the reaction time (TR), in min, from stopwatch No. 1. As the meniscus falls past the lower mark, record the time (TT), in sec, from stopwatch No. 2. Repeat the latter operation, beginning with "Immediately re-draw the reaction mixture ..." until a total of four determinations are obtained over a reaction time (TR) of not more than 15 min. Prepare a substrate blank by pipetting 1.0 ml of water into a mixture of 20.0 ml of Substrate Solution and 4.0 ml of Acetate Buffer, and then immediately pipet 10.0 ml of this mixture into the wide arm of the Viscometer. Determine the time (TS), in sec, required for the meniscus to fall between the two marks. Use an average of five determinations as TS. Prepare a water blank by pipetting 10.0 ml of water, previously equilibrated to 40 0.1, into the wide arm of the Viscometer. Determine the time (Tw), in sec, required for the meniscus to fall between the two marks. Use an average of five determinations as Tw.
Calculation
One hemicellulase unit (HCU) is that activity that will produce a relative fluidity change of 1 over a period of 5 min in a locust bean gum substrate under the conditions specified. Calculate the relative fluidities (FR) and T values (see definition below) for each of the four efflux times (TT) and reaction times (TR) as follows: FR = (TS - TW)/(TT - Tw), and TN = 1/2(TT/60) + TR = (TT/120) + TR,
in which FR is the relative fluidity for each reaction time; TS is the average efflux time for the substrate blank, in sec; Tw is the average efflux time for the water blank, in sec; TT is the efflux time of the sample reaction mixture, in sec; TR is the elapsed time from zero time, in min, i.e., the time from addition of the enzyme solution to the buffered substrate, until the beginning of the measurement of the efflux time (TT); and TN is the reaction time (TR), in min, plus one half of the efflux time (TT) converted to min. Plot the four relative fluidities (FR) as the ordinate against the four reaction times (TN) as the abscissa. A straight line should be obtained. The slope of the line corresponds to the relative fluidity change per min and is proportional to the enzyme concentration. The slope of the best line through a series of experimental points is a better criterion of enzyme activity than is a single relative fluidity value. From the curve determine the FR values at 10 and 5 min. They should have a difference in fluidity of not more than 0.22 and not less than 0.18. Calculate the activity of the enzyme sample as follows: HCU/g = 1,000(FR10 - FR5)/W, in which FR10 is the relative fluidity at 10 min reaction time; FR5 is the relative fluidity at 5 min reaction time; 1,000 is mg per g; and W is the weight, in mg, of the enzyme sample contained in the 1.0-ml aliquot of Sample Preparation added to the equilibrated substrate in the Procedure.
Principle
The method is based on a visual floculation endpoint.
Apparatus
Bottle-rotating apparatus
Use a suitable assembly, designed to rotate at a rate of 16 to 18 rpm, such as the Dries-Jacques Associates type model (Available from Dries-Jacques Associates, 1801 East North Avenue, Milwaukee, Wisc. 53202, USA.) or equivalent
Sample bottles
Use 125-ml squat, round, wide-mouth bottles such as those available as Catalog No. 2903 from Fisher Scientific Co. (Available from Fischer Scientific, 711 Forbes Av., Pittsburgh, PA 15219, USA.), or equivalent.
Substrate Solution
Dissolve 60 g of low-heat, nonfat dry milk (such as Peake Grade A (Available from Galloway West, Fond du Lac, Wisc. 54935, USA.)), or equivalent in 500 ml of a
solution, adjusted to pH 6.3 if necessary, containing in each ml 2.05 mg of sodium acetate (NaC2H3O2) and 1.11 mg of calcium chloride (CaCl2).
Standard Preparation
Use a standard-strength rennet; bovine rennet; milk-clotting enzyme, microbial (E. parasitica); or milk-clotting enzyme, microbial (Mucor species) as appropriate for the preparation to be assayed. Such standards, which are available from commercial coagulant manufacturers, should be of known activity. Dilute the standard-strength material 1 to 200 with water, and mix. Equilibrate to 30 before use, and prepare no more than 2 h prior to use.
Sample Preparation
Prepare aqueous solutions or dilutions of the sample to produce a final concentration such that the clotting time, as determined in the Procedure below, will be within 1 min of that of the Standard Preparation. Prepare no more than 1 h prior to use.
Procedure
Transfer 50.0 ml of the Substrate Solution into each of four 125-ml Sample Bottles. Place the bottles on the Bottle-rotating Apparatus, and suspend the apparatus in a water bath, maintained at 30 0.5, so that the bottles are at an angle or approximately 20 to 30 to the horizontal. Immerse the bottles so that the water level in the bath is about equal to the substrate level in the bottles. Begin rotating the apparatus at 16-18 rpm, then add 1.0 ml of the Sample Preparation to each of the two bottles, and record the exact time of addition. Add 1.0 ml of the Standard Preparation to each of the other two bottles, recording the exact time. Observe the rotating bottles, and record the exact time of the first evidence of clotting (i.e. when fine granules or flecks adhere to the sides of the bottle). Variations in the response of different lots of the substrate may cause variations in clotting time; therefore, the test samples and standards should be measured simultaneously on the same substrate. Average the clotting time, in sec, of the duplicate samples, recording the time for the Standard Preparation as Ts and that for the Sample Preparation as Tv.
Calculation
Calculate the activity of the enzyme preparation by the formula: Milk-clotting Units/ml = 100 x (Ts/Tv) x (Ds/Dv) in which 100 = the activity assigned to the Standard Preparation, Ds = the dilution factor for the Standard Preparation, and Dv = the dilution factor for the Sample Preparation. Note. The dilution factors should be expressed as fractions; e.g., a dilution of 1 to 200 should be expressed as 1/200.
Principle
This assay is based on the enzymatic hydrolysis of the peptide bonds of a defined gelatin substrate at pH 7.0 and 40. The corresponding reduction in substrate viscosity is determined with a calibrated viscometer. One Viscometric Protease Unit is defined as that activity which will produce a relative fluidity change of 0.01 per sec in a defined gelatine substrate under the conditions of the assay.
Special Apparatus
Calibrated viscometer
Size 100 Calibrated Cannon-Fenske Type Viscometer, or its equivalent, supplied as Catalog No. P2885-1001.
Stopwatches
Stopwatch calibrated in 1/10 min for determining the reaction time (Tr) and stopwatch calibrated in 1/5 sec for determining the efflux time (Tt).
Enzyme Preparation
Prepare an enzyme solution so that 1 ml of the final dilution will produce a relative fluidity change between 0.18 and 0.22 in 5 min under the conditions of the assay. Weigh the enzyme and quantitatively transfer to a glass mortar. Triturate the enzyme with distilled water and quantitatively transfer to an appropriate volumetric flask. Dilute the volume with distilled water and filter the enzyme solution through Whatman No. 1 filter paper, or equivalent, prior to use.
Procedure
Place the calibrated viscometer in the 40 0.1 waterbath in an exactly vertical position. Use only a clean viscometer. Cleaning is readily accomplished by drawing a large volume of detergent solution followed by distilled water through the viscometer. This can be accomplished by using an aspirator with a rubber tube connected to the narrow arm of the viscometer. Pipet 20 ml of gelatin substrate and 3 ml of phosphate buffer into a 50 ml Erlenmeyer flask. Allow at least two flasks for each enzyme sample and one flask for a substrate blank. Stopper the flasks and equilibrate them in the waterbath for 15 min. At zero time pipet 1 ml of the enzyme solution into the equilibrated substrate. Start the stopwatch calibrated in 0.1 min and mix solution thoroughly. Immediately pipet 10 ml of the reaction mixture into the wide arm of the viscometer. After approximately 2 min apply suction with a rubber tube connected to the narrow arm of the viscometer drawing the reaction mixture above the upper mark into the driving fluid head. Measure the efflux time by allowing the reaction mixture to freely flow down past the upper mark. As the meniscus of the reaction mixture falls past the upper mark, start the other stopwatch. At the same time record the reaction time in min from the first stopwatch (Tr). As the meniscus of the reaction mixture falls past the lower mark, record the time in sec from the second stopwatch (Tt). Immediately redraw the reaction mixture above the upper mark and into the fluid driving head. As the meniscus of the reaction mixture falls freely past the upper mark, restart the second stopwatch. At the same time, record the reaction time in min from the first stopwatch (Tr). As the meniscus of the reaction mixture falls past the lower mark, record the time in sec, from the second stopwatch (Tt). Repeat from redrawing the reaction mixture above the upper mark, until a total of 4 determinations is obtained over a reaction time (Tr) of not more than 15 min. Prepare a substrate blank by pipetting 1 ml of distilled water into 24 ml of buffered substrate. Pipet 10 ml of the reaction mixture into the wide arm of the viscometer.
Determine the time (Ts) in sec required for the meniscus to fall between the two marks. Use an average of 5 determinations for Ts. Prepare a water blank by pipetting 10 ml of equilibrated distilled water into the wide arm of the viscometer. Determine the time (Tw) in sec required for the meniscus to fall between the two marks. Use an average of 5 determinations for Tw.
Calculation
One Viscometric Protease Unit (VPU) is that activity which will produce a relative fluidity change of 0.01 per sec in a defined gelatin substrate under the conditions of the assay. Calculate the relative fluidities (Fr) and the times (Tn) for each of the four (4) efflux times (Tt) and reaction times (Tr) as follows: Fr = (Ts - Tw)/(Tt - Tw) Tn = 1/2 (Tt/60) + Tr = (Tt/120) + Tr where Fr = relative fluidity for each reaction time, Ts = average efflux time for the substrate blank in sec, Tw = average efflux time for the water blank in sec, Tt = efflux time of the reaction mixture in sec, Tr = elapsed time in min from zero time, i.e. the time from addition of the enzyme solution to the buffered substrate, until the beginning of the measurement of efflux time (Tt), Tn = reaction time in min (Tr), plus one-half of the efflux time (Tt) converted to min. Plot the four relative fluidities (Fr) as the ordinate against the four reaction times (Tr) as the abscissa. A straight line should be obtained. The slope of this line corresponds to the relative fluidity change per min and is proportional to the enzyme concentration. The slope of the best line through a series of experimental points is a better criterion of enzyme activity than is a single relative fluidity value. From the graph determine the Fr values at 10 and 5 min. They should have a difference in fluidity of not more than 0.22 nor less than 0.18. Calculate the activity of the enzyme unknown as follows: VPU/g = [1,000 (Fr10 - Fr5)] / (W x 300 x 0.01) = [333 (Fr10 - Fr5)] / W where Fr5 = relative fluidity at five (5) min of reaction time Fr10 = relative fluidity at ten (10) min of reaction time 300 = time of relative fluidity change in sec from Fr10 to Fr5
1,000 = milligrams per g W = weight in milligrams of enzyme added to the reaction mixture in a one (1) ml aliquot of enzyme solution 0.01 = change in relative fluidity per sec per VPU.
Principle
The assay is based on a 30-min proteolytic hydrolysis of casein at 37 and pH 7.0. Unhydrolyzed casein is removed by filtration, and the solubilized casein is determined spectrophotometrically.
TCA solution
Dissolve 18 g of trichloroacetic acid and 19 g of sodium acetate trihydrate in 800 ml of water in a 1,000-ml volumetric flask, add 20 ml of glacial acetic acid, dilute to volume with water, and mix.
Substrate solution
Dissolve 6.05 g of enzyme-grade tris(hydroxymethyl)aminomethane in 500 ml of water, add 8 ml of 1 N hydrochloric acid, and mix. Dissolve 7 g of Casein in this solution, and heat for 30 min in a boiling water bath, stirring occasionally. Cool to room temperature, and adjust to pH 7.0 with 0.2 N hydrochloric acid, adding the acid slowly, with vigorous stirring, to prevent precipitation of the casein. Transfer the mixture into a 1,000-ml volumetric flask, dilute to volume with water, and mix.
Sample Preparation
Using Tris Buffer, prepare a solution of the sample enzyme preparation so that 2 ml of the final dilution will contain between 10 and 44 PC units.
Procedure
Pipet 10.0 ml of the Substrate Solution into each of a series of 25 x 150-mm test tubes, allowing one tube for each enzyme test, one tube for each enzyme blank, and one tube for a substrate blank. Equilibrate the tubes for 15 min in a water bath maintained at 37 0.1. At zero time, rapidly pipet 2.0 ml of the Sample Preparation into the equilibrated substrate, starting the stopwatch at zero time. Mix, and replace the tubes in the waterbath. Add 2 ml of Tris Buffer (instead of the Sample Preparation) to the substrate blank. After exactly 30 min, add 10 ml of TCA Solution to each enzyme incubation and to the substrate blank to stop the reaction. (Caution: Do not use mouth suction for the TCA Solution.) Heat the tubes in the waterbath for an additional 30 min to allow the protein to coagulate completely. At the end of the second heating period, shake each tube vigorously, and filter through 11-cm Whatman No. 42, or equivalent, filter paper, discarding the first 3 ml of filtrate. Note. The filtrate must be perfectly clear. Determine the absorbance of each sample filtrate in a 1-cm cell, at 275 nm, with a suitable spectrophotometer, using the filtrate from the substrate blank to set the instrument at zero. Correct each reading by subtracting the appropriate enzyme blank reading, and record the value so obtained in Au.
Standard Curve
Transfer 100 mg of L-tyrosine, chromatographic-grade (Available from Calbiochem, La Jolla, Calif. 92037, USA.) or equivalent, previously dried to constant weight, to a 1,000ml volumetric flask. Dissolve in 60 ml of 0.1 N hydrochloric acid. When completely dissolved, dilute the solution to volume with water, and mix thoroughly. This solution contains 100 g of tyrosine in 1.0 ml. Prepare three more dilutions from this stock solution to contain 75.0, 50.0 and 25.0 g of tyrosine per ml. Determine the absorbance of the four solutions at 275 nm in a 1-cm cell with a suitable spectrophotometer versus 0.006 N hydrochloric acid. Prepare a plot of absorbance versus tyrosine concentration.
Calculation
One bacterial protease unit (PC) is defined as that quantity of enzyme that produces the equivalent of 1.5 g per ml of L-tyrosine per min under the conditions of the assay. From the Standard Curve, and by interpolation, determine the absorbance of a solution having a tyrosine concentration of 60 g per ml. A figure close to 0.0115 should be obtained. Divide the interpolated value by 40 to obtain the absorbance equivalent to
that of a solution having a tyrosine concentration of 1.5 g per ml and record the value thus derived as As. Calculate the activity of the sample enzyme preparation by the formula: PC/g = (Au/As) x (22/30W) in which 22 = the final volume, in ml of the reaction mixture, 30 = the time of the reaction, in min, and W = the weight of the original sample taken, in g.
Procedure: Pipet 10.0 ml of the Substrate Solution into each of a series of 25 x 150mm test tubes: one for each enzyme test and one for the substrate blank. Heat the tubes in a water bath at 40 for about 5 min. To each tube except the substrate blank add 2.0 ml of the Sample Preparation, and begin timing the reaction at the moment the solution is added; add 2.0 ml of the Acetate Buffer Solution to the substrate blank tube. Close the tubes with No. 4 rubber stoppers, and tap each tube gently for 30 sec against the palm of the hand to mix. Heat each tube in a water bath at 40 for exactly 30 min, and then pipet rapidly 10.0 ml of the Trichloroacetic Acid Solution into each tube. (Caution: Do not use mouth suction on the pipet.) Shake each tube vigourously against the stopper for about 40 sec, and then allow to cool to room temperature for 1 h, shaking each tube against the stopper at 10 to 12 min intervals during this period. Prepare enzyme blanks as follows: heat, in separate tubes, 10.0 ml of the Trichloroacetic Acid Solution in 10.0 ml of the Substrate Solution, shake well for 40 sec, and to this mixture add 2.0 ml of the preheated Sample Preparation. Shake again, and cool at room temperature for 1 h, shaking at 10 to 12 min intervals. At the end of 1 h, shake each tube vigourously, and filter through 11-cm Whatman No. 42, or equivalent, filter paper, refiltering the first half of the filtrate through the same paper. Determine the absorbance of each filtrate in a 1-cm cell, at 275 nm, with a suitable spectrophotometer, using the filtrate from the substrate blank to set the instrument to zero. Correct each reading by subtracting the appropriate enzyme blank reading, and record the value so obtained as AU (Note: If a corrected absorbance reading between 0.2 and 0.5 is not obtained, repeat the test using more or less of the enzyme preparation as necessary).
Standard Curve
Transfer 100.0 mg of L-tyrosine, chromatographic-grade or equivalent (Calciochem, La Jolla, Ca. 92037), previously dried to constant weight, to a 1,000-ml volumetric flask. Dissolve in 60 ml of 0.1 N hydrochloric acid. When completely dissolved, dilute the solution to volume with water, and mix thoroughly. This solution contains 100 g of tyrosine in 1.0 ml. Prepare three more dilutions from this stock solution to contain 75.0, 50.0, and 25.0 g of tyrosine per ml. Determine the absorbance of the four solutions at 275 nm in a 1-cm cell on a suitable spectrophotometer versus 0.006 N hydrochloric acid. Prepare a plot of absorbance versus tyrosine concentration. Determine the slope of the curve in terms of absorbance per g of tyrosine. Multiply this value by 1.10, and record it as As. A value of approximately 0.0084 should be obtained.
Calculation
One HUT unit of proteolytic (protease) activity is defined as that amount of enzyme that produces, in 1 min under the specified conditions, a hydrolysate whose absorbance at 275 nm is the same as that of a solution containing 1.10 g per ml of tyrosine in 0.006 N hydrochloric acid. Calculate the HUT per g of the original enzyme preparation by the formula, HUT/g = (AU/As) x (22/30W), in which 22 is the final volume of the test solution, 30 is the reaction time in min, and W is the weight of the original sample taken, in g (Note: The value for As, under carefully controlled and standardized conditions, is 0.0084; this value may be used for routine work in lieu of the value obtained from the standard curve, but the exact value
calculated from the standard curve should be used for more accurate results and in cases of doubt).
Procedure
Pipet 10.0 ml of Substrate Solution into each of a series of 25 x 150 mm test tubes, allowing at least two tubes for each sample, one for each enzyme blank, and one for a substrate blank. Stopper the tubes, and equilibrate them for 15 min in a water bath maintained at 37 0.1. At zero time, start the stopwatch, and rapidly pipet 2.0 ml of the Sample Preparation into the equilibrated substrate. Mix by swirling, and replace the tubes in the water bath.
(Note: The tubes must be stoppered during incubation). Add 2 ml of GlycineHydrochloric Acid Buffer (instead of the Sample Preparation) to the substrate blank. After exactly 30 min, add 10 ml of TCA Solution to each enzyme incubation and to the substrate blank to stop the reaction. (Caution: Do not use mouth suction for the TCA Solution.) In the following order, prepare an enzyme blank containing 10 ml of Substrate Solution, 10 ml of TCA Solution, and 2 ml of the Sample Preparation. Heat all tubes in the water bath for 30 min, allowing the precipitated protein to coagulate completely. At the end of the second heating period, cool the tubes in an ice bath for 5 min, and filter through Whatman No. 42 filter paper, or equivalent. The filtrates must be perfectly clear. Determine the absorbance of each filtrate in a 1-cm cell at 275 nm with a suitable spectrophotometer, against the substrate blank. Correct each absorbance by subtracting the absorbance of the respective enzyme blank.
Standard Curve
Transfer 181.2 mg of L-tyrosine, chromatographic-grade or equivalent (Calbiochem, La Jolla, Calif. 92037), previously dried to constant weight, to a 1,000-ml volumetric flask. Dissolve in 60 ml of 0.1 N hydrochloric acid. When completely dissolved, dilute the solution to volume with water, and mix thoroughly. This solution contains 1.00 mol of tyrosine in 1.0 ml. Prepare dilutions from this stock solution to contain 0.10, 0.20, 0.30, 0.40, and 0.50 mol per ml. Determine the absorbance of each dilution in 1-cm cell at 275 nm, against a water blank. prepare a plot of absorbance versus mol of tyrosine per ml. A straight line must be obtained. Determine the slope and intercept for use in the Calculation below. A value close to 1.38 should be obtained. The slope and intercept may be calculated by the least squares method as follows: Slope = [n(MA) - (M)(A)] / [n(M2) - (M)2] Intercept = [(A)(M2) - (M)(MA)] / [n(M2) - (M)2] in which n is the number of points on the standard curve, M is the mol of tyrosine per ml for each point on the standard curve, and A is the absorbance of the sample.
Calculation
One spectrophotometric acid protease unit is that activity that will liberate 1 mol of tyrosine per min under the conditions specified. The activity is expressed as follows: SAPU/g = ( A - I) x 22/(S x 30 x W), in which A is the corrected absorbance of the enzyme incubation filtrate; I is the intercept of the Standard Curve; 22 is the final volume of the incubation mixture, in ml; S is the slope of Standard Curve; 30 is the incubation time, in min; and W is the weight, in g, of the enzyme sample contained in the 2.0-ml aliquot of Sample Preparation added to the incubation mixture in the Procedure.
Principle
The assay is based on a 60 min proteolytic hydrolysis of a casein substrate at pH 6.0 and 40. Unhydrolyzed substrate is precipitated with trichloroacetic acid and removed by filtration; solubilized casein is then measured spectrophotometrically.
Test solution
Prepare a solution from the enzyme preparation so that 2 ml of the final dilution will give an absorbance in the Procedure between 0.2 and 0.5. Weigh the sample accurately, transfer it quantitatively to a glass mortar, and triturate with PhosphateCysteine-EDTA Buffer Solution. Transfer the mixture quantitatively into a volumetric flask of appropriate size, dilute to volume with Phosphate-Cysteine-EDTA Buffer Solution, and mix.
Procedure
Pipet 5 ml of Casein Substrate Solution into each of a series of 25 x 150 mm test tubes, allowing three tubes for the enzyme unknown, six for a papain standard curve, and nine for enzyme blanks. Equilibrate the tubes for 15 min in a water bath maintained at 40 O.1. At zero time, rapidly pipet 2 ml of each of the Diluted Standard Solutions, and 2-ml portions of the Test Solution, into the equilibrated substrate, starting the stopwatch at zero time. Mix each by swirling, stopper and place the tubes back in the water bath. After 60.0 min. add 3 ml of Trichloroacetic Acid Solution to each tube. (Caution: Do not use mouth suction.) Mix each tube immediately by swirling. Prepare enzyme blanks containing 5.0 ml of Casein Substrate Solution, 3.0 ml of Trichloroacetic Acid Solution, and 2.0 ml of one of the appropriate Diluted Standard Solutions or the Test Solution. Return all tubes to the water bath, and heat for 30.0 min allowing the precipitated protein to coagulate completely. Filter each mixture through Whatman No. 42, or equivalent, filter paper, discarding the first 3 ml of filtrate. The subsequent filtrate must be perfectly clear. Determine the absorbance of each filtrate in a 1-cm cell at 280 nm with a suitable spectrophotometer, against its respective blank.
Calculation
One papain unit (PU) is defined in this assay as that quantity of enzyme that liberates the equivalent of 1 g of tyrosine per h, under the conditions of the assay. Prepare a standard curve by plotting the absorbances of filtrates from the Diluted Standard Solutions against the corresponding enzyme concentrations, in mg/ml. By interpolation from the standard curve, obtain the equivalent concentration of the filtrate from the Test Solution. Calculate the activity of the enzyme preparation taken for analysis as follows: PU/mg = (A x C x 10)/W
in which A = the activity of USP Papain Reference Standard, in PU per mg, C = the concentration, in mg per ml, of Reference Standard from the standard curve, equivalent to the enzyme unknown, 10 = the total volume, in ml, of the final incubation mixture, and W = the weight, in mg, of original enzyme preparation in the 2-ml aliquot of Test Solution added to the incubation mixture.
Principle
Pullulanase hydrolyses alpha 1-6 glycosidic links in branched poly-saccharides and breaks down pullulan to yield maltotriose only. Pullulan is produced by deep fermentation of Pullularia pullulans. After the reaction is complete, the reducing sugars formed are estimated by the reaction with dinitrosalicylic acid. Thus one unit of Pullulanase is the activity which will produce reducing sugars equivalent to 1 mg of anhydrous maltose after one min, under the conditions of the assay.
Reagents
Pullulan solution
Add 1 g of standard pullulan (A suitable grade of Pullulan is available from A.B.M. Chemicals Limited, Woodley, Stockport, Cheshire, SK6 IPQ, United Kingdom.) to 70 ml of distilled water. Boil for 5 min, cool and add 10 ml of molar acetate buffer pH 5,0 then dilute to 100 ml. Filter if necessary. This solution can be stored up to two weeks in a refrigerator.
Procedure
Pipet 1 ml of substrate pullulan solution into a 17 x 1.5 cm test tube and place in a water bath at 50 for 5 min. Add 1 ml of enzyme solution and allow reaction to proceed for exactly 10 min. Stop reaction by adding 2 ml of D.N.S. reagent. Prepare a blank by adding 2 ml of D.N.S. reagent to substrate before the enzyme is added.
Place the two tubes in a boiling water bath for exactly 5 min and then cool rapidly and add 10 ml of distilled water. Mix solutions well by shaking. Measure the absorbance of the test solution against the blank using 2-cm glass cells at a wavelength of 540 nm.
Standardization
The reducing value measured is compared with that of a standard maltose solution. A standard maltose graph is not necessary as, for accurate results, the absorbance produced in the test should be between 0.2 - 0.5. As 1 mg of maltose will give an absorbance of 0.82, for the purpose of the calculation the definition is adjusted to read "0.4 units of activity will produce 0.4 mg of anhydrous maltose equivalent...". Therefore a standard maltose solution is made so that 1 ml contains 0.4 mg of anhydrous maltose and this solution is used for the test in place of the 1 ml of enzyme solution. The absorbance is read as before and should be 0.325. This reading is so constant that, if any difference is found, the wavelength calibration on the spectrophotometer should be checked. This is critical since very small errors in the wavelength can have large effects on the absorbance.
Calculation
For an unknown sample several dilutions are made up and tested. A graph of absorbance against enzyme concentration is plotted and the concentration of enzyme which will give an absorbance of 0.325 is found. Then, by definition this concentration of enzyme contains 0.4 Pullulanase units. Thus the activity of Pullulanase preparation is found by: Pullulanase activity/mg = 1,000 / mg of enzyme in test x (0.4 / 10)
Enzyme concentration mg in test Absorbance 0.002% 0.003% 0.004% 0.005% 0.006% 0.008% 0.010% 0.02 0.03 0.04 0.05 0.06 0.08 0.10 0.170 0.245 0.325 0.390 0.465 0.595 0.720
From the graph, an absorbance of 0.325 is given by 0.004% w/v enzyme solution. Therefore the activity equals
Figure. Pullulanase Preparation Assay for a 50 mg/kg Solution This can now be used to construct a standard graph of absorbance against Pullulanase units for a fixed enzyme concentration. This graph can be used for all further samples. If the 0.005% solution is taken as standard, then its absorbance of 0.39 must give 1,000 units/g (as above). From this, a graph can be constructed for any sample at a concentration of 0.005%
Enzyme concentration Absorbance Units/g 0.002% 0.003% 0.004% 0.005% 0.170 0.245 0.325 0.390 400 600 800 1,000
A graph is drawn on absorbance against units/g for a 0.005% enzyme solution (see Figure).
Example
For an enzyme made up to concentration of 0.0025%, 0.005% and 0.0075%, the absorbances were found to be:
Concentration Absorbance Units g 0.0025% 0.005% 0.0075 0,200 0.375 0.553 480 950 1,470
Thus the activity is found as follows: 0.0025% 480 x 0.005 / 0.0025 = 960 u/g 0.005% 950 x 0.005 / 0.005 = 950 u/g 0.0075% 1,470 x 0.005 / 0.0075 = 980 u/g Average = 953 units/g
VI. METHODS FOR FATS AND RELATED SUBSTANCES o ACID VALUE o CONGEALING RANGE o FREE FATTY ACIDS (Based on AOCS AOCS: American Oil Chemists' Society. Method Ca 5a-40) o HYDROXYL VALUE o IDENTIFICATION TESTS FOR FUNCTIONAL GROUPS Fatty Acids upon hydrolysis (A) Acetic acid (B) Succinic acid (C) Fumaric acid (D) Tartaric acid (E) Citric acid (F) Lactic acid (G) Glycerol (H)
o o o o o o o o
Polyols IODINE VALUE (Wijs Method) 1-MONOGLYCERIDE AND FREE GLYCEROL CONTENTS OXYETHYLENE GROUP DETERMINATION POLYGLYCEROL DETERMINATION IN POLYGLYCEROL ESTERS PROPYLENE GLYCOL DIMER AND TRIMER DETERMINATION SAPONIFICATION SAPONIFICATION VALUE SORBITAN ESTER CONTENT
CONGEALING RANGE
Melt in a glass tube (25 mm in diameter and 100 mm in length, the glass being 1 mm in thickness) about 5 g of the sample by heating gently to 15-20 above the expected congealing range. By means of a perforated cork, fasten the tube in a wide-mouthed bottle of clear glass, approximately 70 mm in diameter and 150 mm in height. Suspend a standard thermometer in the melted sample so that it will serve as a stirrer, cool if necessary, and stir the mass slowly until the mercury remains stationary for 30 sec. Discontinue stirring and allow the thermometer to hang, with the bulb in the centre of the sample, and observe the rise of the mercury column. The highest point to which it rises is the congealing temperature.
FREE FATTY ACIDS (Based on AOCS AOCS: American Oil Chemists' Society. Method Ca 5a-40)
Unless otherwise directed, weigh accurately the appropriate amount of the sample, indicated in the table below, into a 250-ml Erlenmeyer flask or other suitable container.
Add 2 ml of phenolphthalein TS to the specified amount of hot alcohol, neutralize with alkali to the first faint but permanent pink colour, and then add the hot neutralized alcohol to the sample container. Titrate with the appropriate normality of sodium hydroxide, shaking vigorously, to the first permanent pink colour of the same intensity as that of the neutralized alcohol. The colour must persist for at least 30 sec. Calculate the percentage of free fatty acids (FFA) in the sample by the formula VNe/W, in which V is the volume and N is the normality, respectively, of the sodium hydroxide used, W is the weight of the sample, in g, and e is the equivalence factor given in the monograph.
FFA Range (%) g of sample 0.00-0.2 0.2-1.0 1.0-30.0 30.0-50.0 50.0-100 56.4 0.2 28.2 0.2 7.05 0.05 7.05 0.05
HYDROXYL VALUE
Hydroxyl value is defined as the number of mg of potassium hydroxide required to neutralize the acetic acid capable of combining by acetylation with 1 g of sample. Weigh accurately the appropriate amount of sample according to the expected hydroxyl value and transfer it into a 250-ml glass-stoppered Erlenmeyer flask.
Pipet 5.0 ml of pyridine/acetic anhydride TS into the flask. (For samples having a 0-20 hydroxyl value, add an additional 5 ml of pyridine/acetic anhydride TS to the flask.) Thoroughly mix the contents by gently swirling. Pipet 5.0 ml of pyridine/acetic anhydride TS into an empty flask for the reagent blank. (If 10.0 ml of the reagent were used for the acetylation, use a 10.0-ml blank.) Place the flasks on a steam bath, under reflux condensers, and heat for 1 h. To hydrolyze excess acetic anhydride, add
sufficient water (not exceeding about 10 ml) through the condensers to the flasks. If the solution separates into two layers, add sufficient pyridine to obtain a homogeneous solution. Heat on a steam bath for 10 min with reflux condensers attached. Add 25 ml of neutralized n-butanol, about half of it through the condensers and the remainder to wash down the sides of the flasks after removal of the condensers. Add 1 ml of phenolphthalein TS and titrate to a faint pink endpoint with 0.5 N ethanolic KOH solution. To correct for free acid, mix about 10 g of the sample, accurately weighed, with 10 ml of pyridine (neutralized to phenolphthalein), add 1 ml of phenolphthalein TS and titrate to a faint pink endpoint with 0.5 N ethanolic potassium hydroxide. Calculate the hydroxyl value by the formula: Hydroxyl value = [(B + (WA/ C) - S) x N x 56.1] / W where A = ml of KOH solution required for the free acid determination, B = ml of KOH solution required for the reagent blank, C = weight of sample used for the free acid determination, S = ml of KOH solution required for titration of the acetylated sample, W = weight of sample used for acetylation, N = normality of the ethanolic KOH solution.
Figure a micro flame (see Figure) for about 1 min. Depending on the amount of succinic acid or succinimide, a red-violet or pink stain appears on the paper.
Glycerol (H)
Transfer 5 ml of the aqueous layer resulting from test A into a test tube. Add excess calcium hydroxide as a powder, place in boiling water for 5 min, shaking several times, cool and filter. Transfer one drop of the filtrate into a tube as indicated in the Figure and add about 50 mg of potassium hydrogen sulfate. Place a filter paper, moistened with Reagent for acrolein, on the top of the tube. Heat as indicated in the Figure. A blue coloured filter paper indicates the presence of glycerol. The colour changes to light red after addition of sodium hydroxide TS. The test cannot be employed in the presence of ethylene glycol or lactic acid, since they decompose under the prescribed conditions yielding acetaldehyde which reacts with the reagents in the same manner as acrolein.
Polyols
Principle
The sample is hydrolysed. Fatty acids are removed by ion exchange in combination with hexane extraction. The components of the filtrate are separated by thin layer chromatography.
Procedure
Reflux 1 g of sample with 15 ml of 0.5 N ethanolic potassium hydroxide for 1 h. Add 25 g of strong cation ion exchange resin (such as Amberlite I R 120, H-form), 50 ml of hexane and 25 ml of water. Stir the mixture for about 1 h. Filter off the resin and, after allowing the layers of the filtrate to separate, take the aqueous layer for TLC. Prepare a silicic acid G (Merck) plate and allow it to air dry at room temperature. Spot 2 to 5 l portions of the aqueous layer onto the plate and also 2 l of 5% solutions of glycerol, ethylene glycol and 1,2-propylene glycol. Develop the chromatogram using chloroform:acetone:5 N ammonia (10:80:10) as the solvent system. After development, dry the plate in a stream of air until the water and ammonia have been removed. Spray the plate with a solution of lead acetate (1% w/v in toluene) and heat the plate for 5 min at 110. 1,2-Diols are revealed as white spots on a brown background. The following are examples of Rf values that may be obtained:
Wijs Solution
Dissolve 13 g of resublimed iodine in 1,000 ml of glacial acetic acid. Pipet 10.0 ml of this solution into a 250-ml flask, add 20 ml of potassium iodide TS and 100 ml of water, and titrate with 0.1 N sodium thiosulfate adding starch TS near the endpoint. Record the volume required as A. Set aside about 100 ml of the iodine-acetic acid solution for future use. Pass chlorine gas, washed and dried with sulfuric acid, through the remainder of the solution until a 10.0-ml portion requires not quite twice the volume of 0.1 N sodium thiosulfate consumed in the titration of the original iodine solution. A characteristic colour change occurs when the desired amount of chlorine has been added. Alternatively, Wijs solution may be prepared by dissolving 16.5 g of iodine monochloride, IC1, in 100 ml of glacial acetic acid. Store the solution in amber bottles sealed with paraffin until ready for use, and use within 30 days.
Pipet 10.0 ml of Wijs Solution into a 500-ml Erlenmeyer flask containing 150 ml of recently boiled and cooled water and 15 ml of potassium iodide TS. Titrate immediately with 0.1 N sodium thiosulfate, recording the volume required as B.
Halogen ratio
Calculate the I/C1 ratio by the formula A/(B - A). The halogen ratio must be between 1.0 and 1.2. If the ratio is not within this range, the halogen content can be adjusted by the addition of the original solution or by passing more chlorine through the solution.
Procedure
The appropriate weight of the sample, in g, is calculated by dividing the number 25 by the expected iodine value. Melt the sample, if necessary, and filter it through a dry filter paper. Transfer the accurately weighed quantity of the sample into a clean, dry, 500-ml glass-stoppered bottle or flask containing 20 ml of carbon tetrachloride, and pipet 25.0 ml of Wijs Solution into the flask. The excess of iodine should be between 50% and 60% of the quantity added, that is, between 100% and 150% of the quantity absorbed. Swirl, and let stand in the dark for 30 min. Add 20 ml of potassium iodide TS and 100 ml of recently boiled and cooled water, and titrate the excess iodine with 0.1 N sodium thiosulfate, adding the titrant gradually and shaking constantly until the yellow colour of the solution almost disappears. Add starch TS, and continue the titration until the blue colour disappears entirely. Toward the end of the titration, stopper the container and shake it violently so that any iodine remaining in solution in the carbon tetrachloride may be taken up by the potassium iodide solution. Concomitantly, conduct two determinations on blanks in the same manner and at the same temperature.
Calculation
Calculate the iodine value by the formula: (B - S) x 12.69 N/W, in which B - S represents the difference between the volumes of sodium thiosulfate required for the blank and for the sample respectively, N is the normality of the sodium thiosulfate, and W is the weight, in g, of the sample taken.
Melt at not more than 10 above melting point, mix thoroughly and take a portion for analysis. Do not attempt to test samples which contain so much free glycerol that it separates when the sample solidifies.
The 1-monoglyceride content may be calculated in terms of a monoester other than the monostearate by dividing the molecular weight of the monoglyceride by 20 and substituting this value for 17.927 in the formula above.
Principle
The oxyethylene groups are converted to ethylene and ethyl iodide which can be determined by titration. By utilizing a conversion factor determined on a reference sample, it is possible to compute the polyoxyethylene ester content.
Apparatus
An arrangement of apparatus for the analysis is shown in the scale diagram (Figure). It consists in part of the reaction flasks (A), condenser, trap (B), and first absorption tube (C) of a Clark alkoxyl apparatus. These are followed by an absorption tube (D) made from a section of a spiral from a Widmer distillation column and a standard-taper (24/40) gas inlet adapter. Dimensions of the apparatus not readily determined from the diagram are as follows: carbon dioxide inlet, capillary, 1-mm inside diameter; flask A, 28-mm diameter, 12/18 standard-taper joint; condenser, 9-mm inside diameter; inlet to trap B, 2-mm inside diameter tube; inlet to trap C, 7/15 standard-taper joint, 2-mm inside diameter tube; trap C, 14-mm inside diameter; trap D, inner tube, 8-mm outside diameter, 2-mm opening at bottom of spiral; spiral, 1.75-mm rod, 23 turns, 8.5 rise per turn; trap D, outer tube, approximately 12.5-mm inside diameter, with side-arm 7 cm from top of spiral; side-arm, 3.5-mm inside diameter, 2 mm opening at bottom. The stopcock is lubricated with silicone grease. The absorption tubes may be conveniently
suspended by a series of properly spaced sheet-metal clips attached to a stick clamped at an angle of about 60.
Procedure
Fill trap B with a suspension of a small amount of red phosphorus in enough water to cover the inlet tube. Pipet 10 ml of acid silver nitrate TS into tube C, pipet 15 ml of bromine-bromide TS into tube D, and place 10 ml of a 10% potassium iodide solution in trap E. Place about 0.05 g of the sample, accurately weighed, in the reaction flask A, together with a Hengar boiling granule and 10 ml of hydriodic acid TS. Connect the flask to the apparatus, pass a slow stream of carbon dioxide through (about 1 bubble per sec), and heat the flask slowly in an oil bath to 140-145. Maintain the flask at this temperature for at least 40 min, until there is no longer any cloudy reflux in the condenser above the reaction flask, and until the supernatant liquid in the silver nitrate trap C has clarified almost completely. Five min before the completion of the reaction, heat the silver nitrate trap C to 50-60 in a hot water bath to drive out any dissolved olefin. On completion of the decomposition, disconnect tubes D and C cautiously in that order. Then disconnect the carbon dioxide source and remove the oil bath from flask A. Connect the spiral absorption tube, D, by its lower adapter to a 500-ml iodine-titration flask containing 10 ml of 10% potassium iodide solution and 150 ml of water. Remove the potassium iodide tube, E, and rinse the side-arm into it. Allow the bromine solution to run into the titration flask through the stopcock and rinse the tube and spiral with a few ml of water. Add the contents of the potassium iodide tube to the titration flask, stopper and allow to stand 5 min. Add 5 ml of dilute sulfuric acid TS and titrate at once with 0.05 N sodium thiosulfate, using 2 ml of starch TS as indicator.
Figure. Apparatus for determination of oxyethylene groups Rinse the contents of the silver nitrate trap C into a flask, dilute to 150 ml with water, heat to boiling, cool to room temperature, and titrate with 0.05 N ammonium thiocyanate, using 3 ml of ferric ammonium sulfate TS as indicator. Perform a blank determination omitting the sample.
Calculation
The volumes of sodium thiosulfate solution (S ml) of normality N and ammonium thiocyanate solution (S' ml) of normality N' used to titrate the contents of the bromine and silver nitrate traps are subtracted from the corresponding blank titrations (B and B' ml respectively) and the following calculations made:
% C2H40= [(B - S) x N x 2.2] / wt. of sample in g % C2H4O = [(B' - S') x N' x 4.4] / wt. of sample in g The sum of the values obtained from these calculations represents the total oxyethylene content of the sample. The % of polyoxyethylene ester can be estimated from the ratio of the % of oxyethylene in the unknown sample to that in a reference sample of known purity.
Procedure
Preparation of the polyol sample
Weigh about 0.5 g of sample and reflux with 20 ml of ethanolic potassium hydroxide solution (1 N) for 2 h. Reduce the volume of ethanol by evaporation at 45-50 in a stream of nitrogen. Add 10 ml of water and convert the soaps to free fatty acids by acidifying with concentrated hydrochloric acid. Extract the fatty acids from the aqueous phase with successive 20 ml portions of light petroleum (boiling range 40-60). Wash the combined petroleum extracts with water (20 ml) and combine the wash with the aqueous phase. Adjust the aqueous polyol solution to pH 7.0 with aqueous potassium hydroxide solution with the aid of a pH-meter. Evaporate to a small volume (2-3 ml) under reduced pressure and extract three times with 30 ml of boiling ethanol. Filter off any residue and evaporate the ethanol under reduced pressure to yield a viscous liquid sample of polyols. Dissolve a 0.1 g sample of polyol in 0.5 ml of warm pyridine (previously dried over potassium hydroxide) in a 10-ml capped vial. Add 0.2 ml hexamethyl disilazane, shake, add 0.2 ml trimethylchlorosilane and shake again. Place on a warm plate (about 80) for 3-5 min. Check that white fumes are present indicating an excess of reagent.
Gas-liquid chromatography
Any suitable gas chromatograph may be used equivalent to a Pye Model 104 fitted with a flame ionization detector and a column (1.5 m x 4 mm i.d.) packed with 3% OV-1 on Diatomite CQ (100-120 mesh) or on Gas Chrom Q (100-120 mesh). Recommended conditions are: oven temperature, programmed from 90 to 330 at 4-6/min; nitrogen carrier gas flow rate, 86 ml/min; injection block temperature, 275; detector block temperature, 350. Inject a 2.0 l sample of TMS derivatives of polyols. The resultant chromatogramme displays the following sequence of peaks:
Description (and typical attenuation settings) Overloaded Single peak (2 x 10) Single peak (2 x 10) Single peak (32 x 10) Single peak (2 x 10) Single peak (16 x 10)
Cyclic tetraglycerols Single peak (2 x 10) Tetraglycerols Pentaglycerols Hexaglycerols Heptaglycerols Octaglycerols Nonaglycerols Multiple peak (8 x 10) Single peak (4 x 10) Single peak (2 x 10) Single peak (2 x 10) Single peak (1 x 10) Barely discernible in the tail of peak 12
Calculation
Measure each peak area by a suitable method and correct for attenuation changes. % di-, tri- and tetraglycerols = (Sum of corrected areas of peaks 3 to 8 x 100) / (Sum of corrected areas of peaks 3 to 13) % polyglycerols equal to or greater than heptaglycerol = (Sum of corrected areas of peaks 11 to 13 x 100) / (Sum of corrected areas of peaks 3 to 13)
Reagents
Potassium hydroxide, ethanolic solution (56.1 g/l ethanol) Sodium hydroxide solution (50% w/v in water) Hydrochloric acid (1 + 1 by volume) Hexane Propylene glycol (1,2-propanediol) superior, (Matheson Scientific Company, Catalog No. C20670 or equivalent) Dipropylene glycol (1,1-oxydi-2-propanol) purified (Matheson Scientific Company, Catalog No. C18635 or equivalent) Tripropylene glycol 95 + %, (Fisher Scientific Company, special order, or equivalent) Triethylene glycol, specially purified (Fisher Scientific Company, special order or equivalent).
Procedure
Preparation of polyols
Weigh about 50 g of sample, to the nearest 0.01 g, together with about 2 g to nearest 0.001 g, of triethylene glycol (as internal standard) into a 1-L saponification flask. Add 350 ml of ethanolic potassium hydroxide solution and reflux under an air condenser for 2 h with stirring. Transfer the contents of the flask quantitatively to an 800-ml beaker. Wash the flask and condenser with 200 ml of hot distilled water and evaporate the combined sample solution and washings to about 200 ml on a steam bath. Acidify the hot residue to pH 2 by the dropwise addition, with agitation, of hydrochloric acid (1 + 1). Transfer the hot mixture quantitatively to a 2-L separator with 200 ml of hexane and shake. Allow the layers to separate. Transfer the lower aqueous layer to a 500-ml separator and add 200 ml of fresh hexane. Shake, then allow the layers to separate. Draw off the lower aqueous layer into a 600-ml beaker and add the hexane phase to the original 2-L separator. Wash the 500-ml separator with two further 200-ml portions of hexane and add these to the 2-L separator. Wash the original 800-ml beaker with 100 ml of water and add to the hexane solution. Mix thoroughly and allow the layers to separate. Draw off the aqueous layer into the 600-ml beaker containing the aqueous fractions. Wash the 800-ml beaker once more with 100 ml of water and add the drained aqueous layer to the combined aqueous fractions. Adjust the pH of the combined aqueous solution to pH 7.0-7.05 (using pH-meter) with sodium hydroxide solution and evaporate to about 150 ml on a steam bath. Transfer quantitatively to a 250 ml round bottom flask and concentrate further to about 50 ml by distilling through a vertical Vigreux column to prevent the loss of low boiling glycols. Decant the concentrated polyols from the precipitated salts, through a filter funnel containing Whatman No. 1 paper, into a 100-ml volumetric flask. Wash the salts and flask twice with 20 ml of water and add to the volumetric flask via the filter funnel. Dilute to the mark with water, mix well and use for the GLC polyol analysis. If salts reprecipitate in the volumetric flask refilter before sampling.
Gas-liquid chromatography
Any suitable gas chromatograph may be used equivalent in sensitivity to an F&M Model 810 or 5750 with dual flame ionization detectors and dual column (0.9 m x 5 mm i.d.) packed with 15% Carbowax 20 M on 80-100 Chromosorb W (acid-, base- and chloroform-washed). Recommended conditions of operation are: oven temperature, programmed from 150 to 230 at 2/min; helium carrier gas flow rate, 30 ml/min; injection block temperature, 290; detector block temperature, 250. Prepare a reference solution of glycols in water by weighing the glycol components, to the nearest 0.1 mg, into a 100 ml volumetric flask as follows: Propylene glycol: 1 g Dipropylene glycol: 0.01 g Tripropylene glycol: 0.005 g Triethylene glycol: 0.01 g Make up to the mark with water and mix. Inject 8.0 l of this reference standard solution and establish the sensitivity setting to yield measurable peaks. Similarly inject 8.0 l of the prepared sample solution.
Calculation
Measure each peak area by a suitable method, such as multiplying the peak height by the peak width at half the peak height, and calculate the % dimer and trimer in the sample as follows: (i) % dimer = (ADS x WDR) / ADR x (WIS x AIR) / (AIS x WIR) x 100 / W (ii) % trimer = (ATS x WTR) / ATR x (WIS x AIR) / (AIS x WIR) x 100 / W where ADS = peak area of dipropylene glycol (sample solution) ADR = peak area of dipropylene glycol (reference solution) ATS = peak area of tripropylene glycol (sample solution) ATR = peak area of tripropylene glycol (reference solution) AIS = peak area of triethylene glycol (sample solution) AIR = peak area of triethylene glycol (reference solution) W = weight (g) of sample of propylene glycol esters of fatty acids WDR = 1weight (g) of dipropylene glycol in the reference solution WTR = 1weight (g) of tripropylene glycol in the reference solution
WIS = 1weight (g) of triethylene glycol added to the sample solution WIR = 1weight (g) of triethylene glycol in the reference solution
1
Corrected for the actual content of polyol (e.g. WDR = weight of dipropylene glycol taken x % of assay). Then % of dimer and trimer of propylene glycol is the sum of (i) and (ii) above.
SAPONIFICATION
Weigh accurately about 20 g of the sample and subject to alkaline hydrolysis by refluxing for 2 h with ethanolic potassium hydroxide TS containing a quantity of potassium hydroxide 100% in excess of the calculated amount required to saponify the sample completely. After hydrolysis, convert the ethanolic soap solution to an aqueous solution by the addition of water and evaporation of the alcohol on a steam bath. Acidify the hot aqueous soap solution with sulfuric acid to liberate the fatty acid. Extract the acid solution with 3 portions of petroleum ether to remove the fatty acid. Evaporate the petroleum ether extracts on a steam bath and dry the residue to constant weight under vacuum at 75 to recover the fatty acid. Multiply the weight of recovered fatty acid by 100/W to obtain the yield of fatty acid from a 100-g sample (where W is the exact weight of sample taken). The fatty acid can be identified by determination of the physical and chemical constants, e.g. the solidification temperature, or by gas-liquid chromatography. Neutralize the aqueous polyol solution to pH 7 with potassium hydroxide. Evaporate the polyol solution to a moist residue on a steam bath and extract the polyol from the salts with 3 portions of hot absolute ethanol. Evaporate off the alcohol on a steam bath and dry the residue to constant weight under vacuum at 75 to yield the polyol moiety of the sample. Multiply the weight of recovered polyol by 100/W to obtain the yield of polyols from a 100-g sample (where W is the exact weight of sample taken).
Procedure
Melt the sample, if necessary, and filter it through a dry filter paper to remove any traces of moisture. Unless otherwise directed, weigh accurately into a 250-ml flask a sample of such size (usually about 4-5 g) that the titration of the sample solution after saponification will require between 45 and 55% of the volume of 0.5 N hydrochloric acid required for the blank. Add 50.0 ml of ethanolic potassium hydroxide TS from a pipet and allow the pipet to drain for a definite period of time. Prepare and conduct blank determinations simultaneously with the sample and similar in all respects. Connect an air condenser to each flask and boil gently but steadily, with occasional mixing, until the sample is completely saponified. (This usually requires about 1 h for normal samples). After the flasks and condensers have cooled somewhat but not sufficiently for the contents to gel, wash down the inside of the condensers with a few ml of distilled water. Disconnect the condensers, add about 1 ml of phenolphthalein TS
to reach flask, and titrate with 0.5 N hydrochloric acid until the pink colour has just disappeared. Saponification value = [56.1 x N (A - B)] / W where A = ml of HC1 required for the titration of the blank, B = ml of HC1 required for the titration of the sample, W = weight of sample in g, and N = normality of the HC1.
Procedure
Saponification and recovery of the polyol
Weigh accurately about 25 g of the sample into a 500-ml round-bottomed boiling flask. Add 250 ml of ethanol and a quantity of potassium hydroxide 100% in excess of the calculated amount required for saponification (approximately 7.5 g). Boil the mixture for 2 h under reflux. Transfer the saponification mixture to an 800-ml beaker. Rinse the flask with about 100 ml of water and add to the mixture. Place the beaker on a steam bath to evaporate the alcohol. Add water occasionally to replace the ethanol. When the odour of ethanol can no longer be detected, adjust the volume of the soap solution to approximately 250 ml with hot water. Acidify the hot soap solution with stirring using sufficient 1:1 sulfuric acid to provide a 10% excess. Heat and stir the mixture until the fatty acid layer separates. Transfer the hot mixture to a 500-ml separating funnel using hot water to rinse the beaker. Cool the contents of the funnel and extract three times with 100-ml portions of petroleum ether. Combine the petroleum ether extracts in a second funnel and wash once with 100 ml of water. Combine the water wash with the aqueous phase in an 800-ml beaker. Neutralize the polyol solution with 10% aqueous potassium hydroxide solution to pH 7 using a pH meter. Place the beaker in a steam bath and evaporate the solvent to incipient dryness. Extract the residue four times with 150-ml portions of boiling absolute ethanol. Filter the combined extracts into a 1-L suction flask through a 10-cm Buchner funnel containing a 1-3-cm bed of silicagel. Wash the funnel with absolute ethanol. Transfer the filtrate and washings to a 1,000-ml volumetric flask. Cool to room temperature and dilute to volume with ethanol. Use this as the sample solution for gasliquid chromatography.
Gas-liquid chromatography
The experimental operating variables employed for the isosorbide analyses are not critical, hence the conditions listed below are typical of those employed when analyzing such samples. Minor fluctuations in temperature and argon flow rate do not affect resolution or analytical results. Column length: 1-3 m Column packing: Carbowax 20 M 15% Column support: Chromosorb W 80/100 mesh Carrier gas: Argon Detector type: FID Temperature of injection port: 295 Column temperature: 195 Sample size: 5 l
Calculation
The isosorbide content of a 5 l aliquot of the recovered polyol solution is estimated directly from a calibration curve prepared from a standard sorbitan ester or by multiplying the observed peak area by the slope of the curve (g of isosorbide per unit area). % Sorbitan ester = (I x 20) / (f x W) where I = No. of g of isosorbide found in a 5 l aliquot of recovered polyol solution by gas chromatography, W = No. of g of sorbitan ester taken for analysis, and f = fractional isosorbide yield from standard sorbitan esters (see Note 1). Note 1. A known sample of sorbitan ester is treated as described under Saponification and recovery of the polyol above. 5 g aliquots of the solution are subjected to the gas chromatographic procedure. The fractional yield of isosorbide is calculated from the weight of sample corrected to a dry, fatty-acid-free basis. Note 2. The procedure is estimated to have an accuracy of 5%.
VII. METHODS FOR FLAVOURING SUBSTANCES o ACETAL DETERMINATION o ACID VALUE o ALDEHYDE DETERMINATION o ALDEHYDE AND KETONE DETERMINATION o CHLORINATED COMPOUNDS LIMIT TEST o ESTER DETERMINATION o SOLUBILITY IN ETHANOL
Procedure
Weigh accurately the quantity of the sample specified in the monograph, and transfer it into a 125-ml Erlenmeyer flask. Add 30 ml of Hydroxylamine hydrochloride solution, and reflux on a steam bath for exactly 60 min. Allow the con denser to drain into the flask for 5 min after removing the flask from the steam bath. Detach and rapidly cool the flask to room temperature. Add bromophenol blue TS as indicator, and titrate with 0.5 N ethanolic potassium hydroxide to pH 3.4, or to the same light colour as produced in the original hydroxylamine hydrochloride solution on adding the indicator. Calculate the ml of 0.5 N ethanolic potassium hydroxide consumed per g of sample (a). Using a separate portion of the sample, proceed as directed under Aldehyde Determination. Calculate the ml of 0.5 N ethanolic potassium hydroxide consumed per g of sample (b). Calculate the percentage of Acetals (AC) by the formula: AC = (a - b)e in which e = the equivalence factor given in the monograph.
ACID VALUE
Dissolve about 10 g of sample, accurately weighed, in 50 ml of ethanol, previously neutralized to phenolphthalein TS with 0.1 N sodium hydroxide. Add 1 ml of phenolphthalein TS and titrate with 0.1 N sodium hydroxide until the solution remains faintly pink after shaking for 10 sec, unless otherwise directed. Calculate the Acid Value (AV) by the formula: AV = (5.61 x S) / W in which S = the number of ml of 0.1 N sodium hydroxide consumed in the titration of the sample, and W = the weight of the sample in g.
Procedure
Transfer an accurately weighed quantity of sample specified in the monograph into a 125-ml Erlenmeyer flask. Add 30 ml of Hydroxylamine hydrochloride solution, mix thoroughly, and allow to stand at room temperature for 10 min, unless otherwise specified. Perform a blank determination simultaneously with the sample determination. Titrate the liberated hydrochloric acid with 0.5 N ethanolic potassium hydroxide to a greenish yellow endpoint, using bromophenol blue TS, as the indicator, or preferably titrate to a pH of 3.4 using a suitable pH meter. Calculate the percentage of Aldehyde (A) by the formula: A = [(S - b)(100e)] / W in which S = the number of ml of 0.5 N ethanolic potassium hydroxide consumed in the titration of the sample, b = the number of ml of 0.5 N ethanolic potassium hydroxide consumed in the titration of the blank, e = the equivalence factor given in the monograph, and W = the weight of the sample in mg.
Procedure
Transfer an accurately weighed quantity of the sample specified in the individual monograph into a 250-ml glass-stoppered flask, add 75.0 ml of the Hydroxylamine solution, and stopper the flask. If the component to be determined is an aldehyde, allow the mixture to stand at room temperature for 1 h, unless otherwise directed in the monograph. If the component to be determined is a ketone, attach the flask to a
suitable condenser, and reflux the mixture for 1 h, unless otherwise directed in the monograph, and then cool to room temperature. Titrate the solution with 0.5 N hydrochloric acid to a greenish yellow end-point using bromophenol blue TS, as indicator, or preferably to a pH of 3.4 using a suitable pH-meter. Perform a blank determination simultaneously with the sample determination. Calculate the percent of Aldehyde or Ketone by the formula: AK = [(b - S)(100e)] / W in which AK = percentage of aldehyde or ketone, b = the number of ml of 0.5 N hydrochloric acid consumed in the titration of the blank, S = the number of ml of 0.5 N hydrochloric acid consumed in the titration of the sample, e = the equivalence factor given in the monograph, and W = the weight of the sample in mg.
ESTER DETERMINATION
Transfer an accurately weighed quantity of the sample specified in the monograph into a 125-ml Erlenmeyer flask containing a few boiling stones. Add to this flask, and, simultaneously, to a similar flask for a blank test, 25.0 ml of 0.5 N ethanolic potassium hydroxide. Connect each flask to a reflux condenser, and heat the mixtures on a steam bath for exactly 1 h, unless otherwise directed in the monograph. Allow the mixtures to cool, add 10 drops of phenolphthalein TS, to each flask, and titrate the excess alkali in each flask with 0.5 N hydrochloric acid. Calculate the percentage of Ester (E) in the sample by the formula: E = [(b - S)(100e)] / W in which b = the number of ml of 0.5 N hydrochloric acid consumed in the titration of the blank, S = the number of ml of 0.5 N hydrochloric acid consumed in the titration of the sample, e = the equivalence factor given in the monograph,
SOLUBILITY IN ETHANOL
Unless otherwise stated transfer a 1 ml sample into a calibrated 10-ml glass-stoppered cylinder graduated in 0.1-ml subdivisions, and add slowly, in small portions, ethanol, the concentration and quantity of which are specified in the monograph. Maintain the temperature at 20. A clear solution free from foreign matter should be obtained.
VIII. METHODS FOR PHOSPHATES o CYCLIC PHOSPHATE DETERMINATION o PHOSPHATE DETERMINATION AS P205 o WATER-INSOLUBLE MATTER
Reagents
Solvent A (basic)
Mix together: 400 ml isopranol 200 ml isobutanol 300 ml deionised water 10 ml 0.880 sp.gr. ammonia solution
Solvent B (basic)
Mix together: 750 ml isopropanol 250 ml deionised water Add: 50 g trichloro acetic acid and 2.5 ml 0.880 sp.gr. ammonia solution
Spray reagent
Add: 5 ml 60% perchloric acid 1 ml conc. HC1 (1.18 sp.gr.) 1 g ammonium molybdate to 50 ml deionised water make to 100 ml with deionised water
Apparatus
Chromatography tank
Suitable for ascending paper chromatography.
Chromatography paper
Schleicher and Schuell 2043 b. (Available with Shleicher and Schuell, Inc. 543 Washington Street, Keene N.H. 03431, USA.)
U.V. Lamp
Wavelength of U.V. 250 nm.
Shandon Microcaps (Shandon Southern Instruments Inc., 515 Broad Street, Szwickley, PA 15143, USA.)
1 l capacity.
Procedure
Draw faint pencil lines 2.5 cm from the bottom edge and 2.5 cm from the right-hand side of a 23 cm square piece of the chromatography paper. With a Shandon Microcap, apply 1 l of a 10% w/v solution of the sample at the intersection of the two pencil lines. Allow the paper to dry, curve it into a cylinder, and secure with plastic clips. Stand the cylinder in the tank containing the basic solvent (Solution A), the immersion depth being about 6 mm and allow the solvent front to rise to a height of 20 cm. Remove the paper from the tank and mark the position of the solvent front. Dry the paper in an air oven at 50 and cut off the excess above the solvent front. Develop the paper in acid solvent (Solution B), with the previous right-hand edge to the bottom of the cylinder, until the solvent front has travelled 20 cm. Remove and dry the paper and spray with the acid ammonium molybdate solution. Develop the spots produced by placing the paper under the U.V. lamp for a few min. Mark out a separate piece of chromatography paper as described above. At the intersection of the pencil lines apply 1 l of each of the meta phosphate standard solutions in turn, drying the paper after each application. Treat this standard paper in a similar manner to that described for the sample. Both tests must be run concurrently using the same solvents, tanks and spray. Compare the sample and standard chromatograms, and identify the 'spots' with the aid of the Rf values given in the Table. Rf values for ortho-, pyro- and cyclic phosphates
Phosphate Rf basic Rf acid Tri-meta 0.49 0.13 0.05 0.02 0.01 0.71 0.40
Tetra-meta 0.36 Hexa-meta 0.27 Octa-meta 0.21 Ortho Pyro 0.32 0.26
Values should be taken as a guide only. If a spot of particular interest is too weak, the chromatogram should be repeated using 2 or 5 l sample solution instead of 1 l. About 2 l of each of the various phosphates should be visible. An approximation of the quantities of each component in the sample will be gained by a visual comparison of the two chromatograms. For a more accurate measurement, cut out each spot and analyze for total phosphorus by the following method. Soak each cut out area of chromatography paper in 25.00 ml of 0.1 N ammonium hydroxide solution for at least 1 h. Pipet a 20.00 ml aliquot of the resulting solution into a 50 ml volumetric flask, add 5 ml of 10 N sulfuric acid and heat in a boiling water bath for 30 min to hydrolyse the cyclic phosphates to orthophosphate. Cool to room temperature, add 1 ml of 12.5% ammonium molybdate solution, shake the flask and then add 1 ml of 0.6% hydrazine hydrochloride. Make up to volume with water and place the flask in a boiling water bath for exactly 10 min. Cool rapidly in a cold water bath and measure the absorbance of the solution in a spectrophotometer at 830 nm using distilled water as the reference solution. Perform a blank determination using an equal area of chromatography paper known not to include any phosphate spots and subtract the blank value from the test values. Determine the amount of phosphorus present by reference to a calibration curve of absorbance at 830 nm obtaind using samples of standard amounts of potassium dihydrogen orthophosphate. Where a spot is ill-defined compare with the standard chromatogram and cut out the zone where the spot should appear. Cut out the area occupied by all the metaphosphates to obtain total cyclic content.
Calculation
If x = l of a 10% solution of sample put on paper y = g P obtained by attached method %P in sample = y / x
Method II
Transfer about 1.5 g of the sample, accurately weighed, into a 500-ml volumetric flask, add 100 ml of water and 25 ml of nitric acid, and boil for 10 min on a hot plate. Cool, dilute to volume with water and mix. Pipet 20.0 ml of this solution into a 500 ml Erlenmeyer flask, add 100 ml of water and heat just to boiling. Add with stirring 50 ml of quimociac TS, then cover with a watch glass and boil for 1 min in a well ventilated hood. Cool to room temperature, swirling occasionally while cooling, then filter through a tared crucible (or fritted glass crucible of medium porosity), and wash with five 25-ml portions of water. Dry at about 225 for 30 min, cool and weigh. Each mg of precipitate thus obtained is equivalent to 32.074 g of P205.
WATER-INSOLUBLE MATTER
Treat 10 g of sample, accurately weighed, with 100 ml of hot water and filter through a tared filtering crucible. Wash the insoluble residue with hot water, dry at 105 for 2 h, cool and weigh.
IX. MICROBIOLOGICAL METHODS o TOTAL (AEROBIC) PLATE COUNT o COLIFORMS AND E-COLI o SALMONELLA o ENUMERATION OF YEASTS AND MOULDS o MEDIA AND REAGENTS
2. Petri dishes, glass (15 x 100 mm) or plastic (15 x 90 mm). 3. Pipets, 1, 5, and 10 ml, graduated in 0.1 ml units. 4. Dilution bottles, 6 oz (160 ml), borosilicate-resistant glass, with rubber stoppers or plastic screw caps. 5. Water bath, for tempering agar, thermostatically controlled to 45 1. 6. Incubator, 35 1. 7. Colony counter, dark-field, Quebec, or equivalent, with suitable light source and grid plate. 8. Tally register. 9. Thermometers (mercury) appropriate range; accuracy checked.
Procedure
Using separate sterile pipets, prepare decimal dilutions of 10-2, 10-3, 10-4, and others as appropriate, of sample homogenate by transferring 10 ml of previous dilution to 90 ml of diluent. Avoid sampling foam. Shake all dilutions 25 times in 30 cm (1 ft) arc within 7 sec. Pipet 1 ml of each dilution into separate, duplicate, appropriately marked petri dishes. Reshake dilution bottle 25 times in 30 cm arc within 7 sec if dilution stands more than 3 min before pipeting test portion into petri dish. Add 12-15 ml plate count agar (cooled to 44-46) to each plate within 15 min of original dilution. Add agar immediately to petri dishes when sample diluent contains hygroscopic materials. Pour agar and dilution water control plates for each series of samples. Immediately mix sample dilutions and agar medium thoroughly and uniformly by alternate rotation and back-and-forth motion of plates on flat level surface. Let agar solidify, invert petri dishes, and incubate promptly for 48 2 h at 35. After incubation, count duplicate plates in suitable range (25-250 colonies), using colony counter and tally register; record results per dilution plate counted. Duplicate plates of at least 1 of 3 dilutions should be in 25-250 colony range. When only 1 dilution is in appropriate range, compute average count per g for dilution and report as total plate count per g (Table 1, Sample No. 1). When 2 dilutions are in appropriate range, determine average count per dilution before averaging 2 dilution counts to obtain total plate count per g (Table 1, Sample No. 2). If none or only 1 of duplicate plates of required dilution yields 25-250 colonies, proceed as in Guidelines, below. Round off counts to 2 significant figures only at time of conversion to total plate counts. When rounding off numbers, raise second digit to next higher number only when third digit from left is 5 or greater, and replace dropped digit with zero. If third digit is 4 or less, replace third digit with zero and leave second digit the same.
Guidelines for calculating and reporting total plate counts in uncommon cases
Report all total plate counts computed from duplicate plates containing less than 25 or more than 250 colonies as estimated counts. Use the following as a guide: a. Plates with fewer than 25 colonies. When duplicate plates of lowest dilution have fewer than 25 colonies, count actual number on each duplicate of that dilution, average the number of colonies per plate, and multiply by dilution factor to obtain estimated total
plate count. Mark total plate count with asterisk to denote that it was estimated from counts outside 25-250 per plate range (Table 1, Sample No. 3). b. Plates with more than 250 colonies. When number of colonies per plate exceeds 250, count colonies in those portions of plate that are representative of colony distribution. Mark calculated total plate count with asterisk to denote that it was estimated from counts outside 25-250 per plate range (Table 1, Sample No. 4). Spreaders. Spreading colonies are usually of 3 distinct types: 1) a chain of colonies, not too distinctly separated, that appears to be caused by disintegration of a bacterial clump; 2) one that develops in film of water between agar and bottom of dish; and 3) one that forms in film of water at edge or on surface of agar. If plates prepared from sample have excessive spreader growth such that (a) area covered by spreaders, including total area of repressed growth, exceeds 50% of plate area, or (b) area of repressed growth exceeds 25% of plate area, report plates as spreader. Determine average count for each dilution; report arithmetic average of these values as total plate count. (See Table 1, Sample No. 5). When it is necessary to count plates containing spreaders not eliminated by (a) or (b) above, count each of the 3 distinct spreader types as one source. For the first type, if only one chain exists, count it as a single colony. If one or more chains appear to originate from separate sources, count each source as one colony. Do not count each individual growth in such chains as a separate colony. Types 2 and 3 usually result in distinct colonies and are counted as such. Combine the spreader count and the colony count to compute the total plate count. Duplicate plates, one with 25-250 colonies, the other with more than 250 colonies. When one plate contains 25-250 colonies and the duplicate contains more than 250 colonies, count both plates and include the plate with more than 250 colonies in computing total plate count (Table 1, Sample No. 6). Duplicate plates, one plate of each dilution with 25-250 colonies. When one plate of each dilution contains 25-250 colonies and the duplicate contains more than 250 colonies or fewer than 25 colonies, count all 4 plates and include plates with more than 250 or fewer than 25 colonies in computing the total plate count (Table 1, Sample No. 7). Duplicate plates, both plates of one dilution with 25-250 colonies and only one duplicate of the other dilution with 25-250 colonies. When both plates of one dilution contain 25-250 colonies and only one duplicate of the other dilution contains 25-250 colonies, count all 4 plates and include the plate with fewer than 25 or the plate with more than 250 colonies in computing aerobic plate count (Table 1, Sample No. 8). Table 1. Examples of computation of total plate count (2 plates/dilution poured)
Sample No.
TNTC
175
16
TNTC 2 TNTC TNTC 3 18 14 4 TNTC TNTC 5 TNTC TNTC 6 TNTC TNTC 7 TNTC TNTC 8 TNTC TNTC TNTC TNTC *(Asterisk): estimated count
208 224 245 2 0 TNTC TNTC 245 230 245 278 225 255 210 240 260 230
17 25 30 0 0 523 487 35 Spreader 23 20 21 40 18 28 270,000 30 28 230,000 270,000 260,000 290,000 5,100,000* 1,600* 250,000
TNTC : Too numerous to count. Colony count is significantly beyond count range of 250 colonies.
Procedure
Aseptically weigh 25 g sample into sterile, wide-mouth, screw-cap jar (500 ml) or other appropriate container. Add 225 ml sterile lactose broth and mix well. Cap jar securely and let stand 60 min at room temperature. Mix well by swirling and determine pH with
test paper. Adjust pH, if necessary, to 6.8 0.2. Loosen jar cap about 1/4 turn and incubate 24 2 h at 35. Tighten lid and gently shake incubated sample mixture; transfer 1 ml mixture to 10 ml selenite cystine broth and another 1 ml mixture to 10 ml tetrathionate broth. Incubate 24 2 h at 35. Mix (vortex, if tube) and streak 3 mm loopful incubated selenite cystine broth on bismuth sulfite (BS) agar, xylose lysine desoxycholate (XLD) agar, and Hektoen enteric (HE) agar. (Prepare BS plates the day before streaking and store in dark at room temperature until streaked.) Repeat with 3 mm loopful of tetrathionate broth. Incubate plates 24 2 h at 35. Examine plates for presence of colonies suspected to be Salmonella, as follows: a. Hektoen enteric (HE) agar: Blue-green to blue colonies with or without black centers. Many cultures of Salmonella may produce colonies with large, glossy black centers or may appear as almost completely black colonies. Atypically, a few Salmonella species produce yellow colonies with or without black centers. b. Bismuth sulfite (BS) agar: Typical Salmonella colonies may appear brown, gray, or black; sometimes they have a metallic sheen. Surrounding medium is usually brown at first, but may turn black in time with increased incubation, producing the so-called halo effect. Some strains may produce green colonies with little or no darkening of surrounding medium. c. Xylose lysine desoxycholate (XLD) agar: Pink colonies with or without black centers. Many cultures of Salmonella may have large, glossy black centers or may appear as almost completely black colonies. Atypically, a few Salmonella species produce yellow colonies with or without black centers. Select 2 or more colonies typical or suspected to be Salmonella from each selective agar. Inoculate into triple sugar iron (TSI) agar and lysine iron agar (LIA). If BS agar plates have no colonies typical or suspected to be Salmonella or no growth whatsoever, incubate them an additional 24 h. Lightly touch the very center of the colony to be picked with sterile inoculating needle and inoculate TSI agar slant by streaking slant and stabbing butt. Without flaming, inoculate LIA by stabbing butt twice and then streaking slant. Since lysine decarboxylation reaction is strictly anaerobic, the LIA slants must have deep butt (4 cm). Store picked selective agar plates at 5-8. Incubate TSI agar and LIA slants at 35 for 24 2 h and 48 2 h, respectively. Cap tubes loosely to maintain aerobic conditions while incubating slants to prevent excessive H2S production. Salmonella in culture typically produces alkaline (red) slant and acid (yellow) butt, with or without production of H2S (blackening of agar) in TSI agar. In LIA, Salmonella typically produces alkaline (purple) reaction in butt of tube. Consider only distinct yellow in butt of tube as acidic (negative) reaction. Do not eliminate cultures that produce discoloration in butt of tube solely on this basis. Most Salmonella cultures produce H2S in LIA. Re-examine 48 h BS agar plates for colonies suspected to be Salmonella. Pick 2 or more of these colonies, as described above, and continue procedure. Retain all cultures presumed to be Salmonella on TSI agar (alkaline slant and acid butt) for biochemical tests, whether corresponding LIA reaction is positive (alkaline butt) or negative (acid butt). Do not exclude TSI culture that appears to be bacterium other than Salmonella if reaction in LIA is typical (alkaline butt) for Salmonella. Treat these
cultures as presumptive positive and submit them to further examination. LIA is useful in detecting S. arizonae and atypical strains of Salmonella that utilize lactose and/or sucrose. Discard only cultures that appear not to be Salmonella on TSI agar (acid slant and acid butt) if corresponding LIA reactions are atypical (acid butt) for Salmonella. Test retained presumed-positive TSI agar cultures as directed below, to determine if they are Salmonella species, including S. arizonae. If TSI cultures fail to give typical reactions for Salmonella, pick additional suspicious colonies from selective medium plate not giving presumed-positive culture and inoculate TSI agar and LIA slants as described above. Apply biochemical tests to: a. Three presumptive TSI agar cultures recovered from set of plates streaked from selenite cystine broth, if present, and presumptive TSI agar cultures recovered from plates streaked from tetrathionate broth, if present. b. If 3 presumptive-positive TSI cultures are not isolated from 1 set of agar plates, test other presumptive-positive TSI agar cultures, if isolated, by biochemical and serological tests. Examine a minimum of 6 TSI cultures for each 25 g analytical unit.
Identification of Salmonella
Mixed cultures: Streak TSI agar cultures that appear to be mixed on MacConkey agar, HE agar, or XLD agar. Incubate plates 24 2 h at 35. Examine plates for presence of colonies suspected to be Salmonella, as follows: a. MacConkey agar. Typical colonies appear transparent and colourless, sometimes with dark center. Colonies of Salmonella will clear areas of precipitated bile caused by other organisms sometimes present. b. Hektoen enteric (HE) agar. See Procedure, above. c. Xylose lysine desoxycholate (XLD) agar. See Procedure, above. Transfer at least 2 colonies suspected to be Salmonella to TSI agar and LIA slants as described above, and continue as in Procedure above.
Pure cultures:
a. Urease test (conventional). With sterile needle, inoculate growth from each presumed-positive TSI agar slant culture into tubes of urea broth. Since occasional, uninoculated tubes of urea broth turn purple-red (positive test) on standing, include uninoculated tube of this broth as control. Incubate 24 2 h at 35. b. Optional urease test (rapid). Transfer two 3 mm loopfuls of growth from each presumed-positive TSI agar slant culture into tubes of rapid urea broth. Incubate 2 h in 37 0.5 water bath. Discard all cultures giving positive test. Retain for further study all cultures that give negative test (no change in colour of medium).
broth and incubate 4-6 h at 35 until visible growth occurs (to test on same day); or 2) trypticase soy-tryptose broth and incubate 24 2 h at 35 (to test on following day). Add 2.5 ml formalinized physiological saline solution to 5 ml of either broth culture. b. Select 2 formalinized broth cultures and test with Salmonella polyvalent flagellar (H) antisera. Place 0.5 ml of appropriately diluted Salmonella polyvalent flagellar (H) antiserum in 10 x 75 mm or 13 x 100 mm serological test tube. Add 0.5 ml antigen to be tested. Prepare saline control by mixing 0.5 ml formalinized physiological saline solution with 0.5 ml formalinized antigen. Incubate mixtures in 48-50 water bath. Observe at 15 min intervals and read final results in 1 h. Positive--agglutination in test mixture and no agglutination in control. Negative--no agglutination in test mixture and no agglutination in control. Nonspecific--agglutination in both test mixture and control. Test the cultures giving such results with Spicer-Edwards antisera, below. Spicer-Edwards serological test: Use this test as an alternative to the polyvalent flagellar (H) test. It may also be used with cultures giving nonspecific agglutination in polyvalent flagellar (H) test. Perform Spicer-Edwards flagellar (H) antisera test as described above. Perform additional biochemical tests (below) on cultures giving positive flagellar test results. If both formalinized broth cultures are negative, perform serological tests on 4 additional broth cultures (above). If possible, obtain 2 positive cultures for additional biochemical testing. If all urease-negative TSI cultures from sample give negative serological flagellar (H) test results, perform additional biochemical tests.
on standing, include uninoculated tube of this broth as control. Incubate 48 2 h at 35, but examine after 24 h. Most Salmonella species cultures give negative test (green or unchanged colour) in this broth. 3) Indole test. Transfer 5 ml of 24 h tryptophane broth culture to empty test tube. Add 0.2-0.3 ml Kovacs' reagent. Most Salmonella cultures give negative test (lack of deep red colour at surface of broth). Record intermediate, varying shades of orange and pink as . 4) Serological flagellar (H) tests for Salmonella. If either polyvalent flagellar (H) test (above) or the Spicer-Edwards flagellar (H) test tube test (above) has not already been performed, either test may be performed here. 5) Discard as not Salmonella any culture that shows either positive indole test and negative serological flagellar (H) test, or positive KCN test and negative lysine decarboxylase test. Additional biochemical tests. Classify as Salmonella those cultures which exhibit typical Salmonella reactions for test Nos. 1-11, shown in Table 1. If one TSI culture from 25 g sample is classified as Salmonella, further testing of other TSI cultures from the same 25 g sample is unnecessary. Cultures that contain demonstrable Salmonella antigens as shown by positive Salmonella flagellar (H) test but do not have biochemical characteristics of Salmonella should be purified and retested. Perform the following additional tests on cultures that do not give typical Salmonella reactions for test Nos. 1-11 in Table 1 and that consequently do not classify as Salmonella. a. Phenol red lactose broth or purple lactose broth 1) Inoculate broth with small amount of growth from unclassified 24-48 h TSI agar slant. Incubate 48 h at 35, but examine after 24 h. Positive--acid production (yellow colour) and gas production in inner fermentation vial. Consider production of acid only as positive reaction. Most cultures of Salmonella give negative test result, indicated by no gas formation in inner fermentation vial and red (with phenol red as indicator) or purple (with bromcresol purple as indicator) colour throughout medium. Table 1. Biochemical and serological reactions of Salmonella
species reactions + + + -
2. Lysine decarboxylase purple butt (LIA) 3. H2S (TSI and LIA) 4. Urease blackening purple-red colour
5. Lysine decarboxylase purple colour broth 6. Phenol red dulcitol broth 7. KCN broth 8. Malonate broth
yellow colour
yellow colour and/or no gas; no colour gas change growth blue colour at surface violet colour at surface agglutination no growth no colour change
+b -c
9. Indole test 10. Polyvalent flagellar test 11. Polyvalent somatic test 12. Phenol red lactose broth 13. Phenol red sucrose broth
no agglutination
agglutination
no agglutination
yellow colour and/or no gas; no colour gas change yellow colour and/or no gas; no colour gas change no colour change diffuse yellow colour no growth; no colour change
-c
+ v
14. Voges-Proskauer test pink-to-red colour 15. Methyl red test 16. Simmons citrate
a
2. Indole testPolyvalent flagellar (H) test orSpicer-Edwards flagellar test 3. Lysine decarboxylaseKCN broth 4. Phenol red lactose broth 5. Phenol red sucrose broth 6. KCN brothVoges-Proskauer testMethyl red test
a
positive (violet colour at surface)negative (no agglutination) negative (yellow colour)positive (growth) positive (yellow colour and/or gas) positive (yellow colour and/or gas) positive (growth)positive (pink-to-red colour)negative (diffuse yellow colour)
Test malonate broth positive cultures further to determine if they are Salmonellaarizonae.
b
Do not discard positive broth cultures if corresponding LIA cultures give typical Salmonella reactions; test further to determine if they are Salmonella species. 2) Discard as not Salmonella, cultures that give positive lactose tests, except cultures that give acid slants in TSI agar and positive reactions in LIA, or cultures that give positive malonate broth reactions. Perform further tests on these cultures to determine if they are S. arizonae. b. Phenol red sucrose broth or purple sucrose broth. Follow procedure described above. Discard as not Salmonella, cultures that give positive sucrose tests, except those that give acid slants in TSI agar and positive reactions in LIA. c. MR-VP broth. Inoculate medium with small amount of growth from each unclassified TSI agar slant suspected to contain Salmonella. Incubate 48 2 h at 35. 1) Perform Voges-Proskauer (VP) test at room temperature as follows: Transfer 1 ml of 48 h culture to test tube and incubate remainder of MR-VP broth additional 48 h at 35. Add 0.6 ml alpha-naphthol and shake well. Add 0.2 ml 40% KOH solution and shake. To intensify and speed reaction, add a few crystals of creatine. Read results after 4 h: development of pink-to-ruby red colour throughout medium is positive test. Most cultures of Salmonella are VP-negative, indicated by absence of development of pinkto-red colour throughout broth. 2) Perform methyl red test as follows: To 5 ml of 96 h MR-VP broth, add 5-6 drops of methyl red indicator. Read results immediately. Most Salmonella cultures give positive test, indicated by diffuse red colour in medium. A distinct yellow color is negative test. Discard as not Salmonella cultures that give positive KCN and VP tests and negative methyl red test. d. Simmons citrate agar. Inoculate this agar, using needle containing growth from unclassified TSI agar slant. Inoculate by streaking slant and stabbing butt. Incubate 96 2 h at 35. Read results as follows. Positive--presence of growth, usually accompanied by colour change from green to blue. Most cultures of Salmonella cultures are citrate-positive. Negative--no growth or very little growth and no colour change.
Classification of cultures: Classify as Salmonella, cultures that have reaction patterns of Table 1. Discard as not Salmonella, cultures that give results listed in any subdivision of Table 2. If neither of 2 TSI cultures carried through biochemical tests confirms the isolate as Salmonella, perform biochemical tests, on remaining ureasenegative TSI cultures from same 25 g sample.
Procedures
Prepare sterile agar medium (250 ml portions in prescription bottles or flasks, autoclaved 15 min at 121 and 15 psi). Temper to 45 1 in water bath. Prepare medium well in advance and let solidify before re-melting and tempering. Do not remelt solidified medium more than once or under pressure. An Arnold steam chest is recommended. Once medium has been tempered, it can be held for 2-3 h before use, provided water level of water bath is 2-3 cm above surface of agar in aliquot container. Medium of choice is potato dextrose agar, although other media listed above may be used. Potato dextrose-salt agar is especially useful for analyzing samples containing "spreader" molds (Mucor, Rhizopus, etc.) since the added NaC1 effectively inhibits their growth but readily allows detection of other yeast-mold propagules. To inhibit bacterial growth, amend agar medium with either antibiotics or sterile 10% tartaric acid solution (to be done after agar has been tempered and immediately before pouring plates) as follows: a. Antibiotics. Use of antibiotics is preferred to tartaric acid solution because stock solutions are relatively easy to prepare and a low agar pH, inhibitory to some yeast and mold species, does not result. Chlortetra-cycline-HCl, at agar medium concentration of 40 ppm, is recommended. Other antibiotics may be used (e.g., chloramphenicol, streptomycin) but should always be used at the same concentration as chlortetracycline-HCl and in addition to it. Prepare stock solutions by dissolving 1 g antibiotic in 100 ml of sterile distilled water and filtering through a 0.45 m membrane. Store stock solutions in dark at 4-8. Shelf life should exceed 1 month. Equilibrate stock solutions to room temperature immediately before use. If agar medium is in 250 ml aliquots, add 1 ml of 100 ml stock solution to obtain 40 ppm concentration. If medium aliquots are greater or less, adjustments will be necessary.
b. Tartaric acid solution. A 10% solution may be used to adjust agar medium to pH 3.5 0.1. Sterilize solution by filtering through 0.45 m membrane. Titrate to determine amount of solution needed to adjust pH to 3.5. Type and aliquot volume of medium will effect amount of solution needed. After adding solution to medium, verify pH by letting a portion of medium solidify and checking with pH meter. Do this for every new lot of medium prepared. Prepare sample and make appropriate dilutions. Dilutions of 10-6 should suffice. Use sterile cotton-plugged pipet to place 1 ml portions of sample dilutions into prelabled 15 x 100 mm petri plates (plastic or glass), and immediately add 20-25 ml tempered agar medium containing either antibiotic(s) or tartaric acid solution. Mix contents by gently swirling plates clockwise then counterclockwise, taking care to avoid spillage on dish lid. Add agar within 1-2 min after adding dilution. Otherwise, dilution may begin to adhere to dish bottom (especially if sample is high in starch content and dishes are plastic) and may not mix uniformly. Plate each dilution in triplicate, using wide bore pipets. From preparation of first sample dilution to pouring of final plate, no more than 20 min, preferably 10 min, should elapse. Incubate plates in dark at 22-25. Do not stack plates higher than 3 and do not invert. Let plates remain undisturbed until time for counting. Count plates after 5 days of incubation. Do not count plates after 3 days since handling of plates could result in secondary growth from dislodged spores, making 5 day counts invalid. Count plates containing 10-150 colonies. If mainly yeasts are present, plates with 150 colonies are usually countable. However, if substantial amounts of mould are present, depending on the type of mould, the upper countable limit may have to be lowered at the discretion of the analyst. Report results in colonies (col)/g or (col)/ml based on an average count of the triplicate set. Round off counts to 2 significant figures. If third digit is 6 or above, round off to digit above (e.g., 456 = 460); if 4 or below, round off to digit below (e.g., 454 = 450). If third digit is 5, round off to digit below if first 2 digits are an even number (e.g., 445 = 440); round off to digit above if first 2 digits are an odd number (e.g., 455 = 460).
Agar: 20 g Distilled water: 1 litre Mix thoroughly and heat with agitation. Boil about 1 min to obtain uniform suspension. (Precipitate will not dissolve.) Cool to 45-50. Suspend precipitate by gentle agitation, and pour 20 ml portions into sterile 15 x 100 mm petri dishes. Let plates dry about 2 h with lids partially removed; then close plates. Final pH, 7.6 0.2. Do not autoclave. Prepare plates on day before streaking and store in dark. Selectivity decreases in 48 h.
EC Broth
Trypticase or tryptose: 20 g Bile salts No. 3: 1.5 g Lactose: 5 g K2HPO4: 4 g KH2PO4: 1.5 g NaC1: 5 g Distilled water: 1 litre Distribute 8 ml portions to 16 x 150 mm test tubes containing inverted 10 x 75 mm fermentation tubes. Autoclave 15 min at 121. Final pH 6.9 0.2.
NaNH4HPO44H2O: 1.5 g K2HPO4: 1 g MgSO47H2O: 0.2 g Sodium citrate2H2O: 3 g Distilled water: 1 litre Dispense into screw-cap tubes as desired. Autoclave 15 min at 121. Final pH, 6.2 0.2. This formulation is listed in Official Methods of Analysis of the AOAC and Standard Methods for the Examination of Water and Wastewater of the APHA. It differs from the composition of commercially available dehydrated media. The latter have been found to be satisfactory.
Lactose Broth
Beef extract: 3 g Peptone: 5 g Lactose: 5 g Distilled water: 1 litre For E. coli: Dissolve ingredients and dispense 10 ml portions into 20 x 150 mm tubes containing inverted 10 x 75 mm fermentation vials. Autoclave 15 min at 121. Final pH 6.9 0.2. For Salmonella: Dispense 225 ml portions into 500 ml Erlenmeyer flasks. After autoclaving 15 min at 121 and just before use, aseptically adjust volume to 225 ml. Final pH, 6.9 0.2.
Ferric ammonium citrate: 0.5 g Sodium thiosulfate (anhydrous): 0.04 g Bromcresol purple: 0.02 g Agar: 15 g Distilled water: 1 litre Heat to dissolve ingredients. Dispense 4 ml portions into 13 x 100 mm screw-cap tubes. Autoclave 12 min at 121. Let solidify in slanted position to form 4 cm butts and 2.5 cm slants. Final pH, 6.7 0.2.
MacConkey Agar
Proteose peptone or polypeptone: 3 g Peptone or gelysate: 17 g Lactose: 10 g Bile salts No. 3 (or bile salts mixture): 1.5 g NaC1: 5 g Neutral red: 0.03 g Crystal violet: 0.001 g Agar: 13.5 g Distilled water: 1 litre Suspend ingredients and heat with agitation to dissolve. Boil 1-2 min. Autoclave 15 min at 121, cool to 45-50, and pour 20 ml portions into sterile 15 x 100 mm petri dishes. Dry at room temperature with lids closed. Do not use wet plates. Final pH, 7.1 0.2.
Malonate Broth
Yeast extract: 1 g (NH4)2SO4: 2 g K2HPO4: 0.6 g KH2PO4: 0.4 g NaC1: 2 g Sodium malonate: 3 g
Dextrose: 0.25 g Bromthymol blue: 0.025 g Distilled water: 1 litre Dissolve by heating, if necessary. Dispense 3 ml portions into 13 x 100 mm test tubes. Autoclave 15 min at 121. Final pH, 6.7 0.2.
MR-VP Broth
Buffered peptone: 7 g Glucose: 5 g K2HPO4: 5 g Distilled water: 1 litre Dissolve ingredients in 800 ml water with gentle heat. Filter, cool to 20, and dilute to 1 liter. Autoclave 12-15 min at 121. Final pH, 6.9 0.2. For Salmonella: Dispense 10 ml into 16 x 150 mm test tubes, and autoclave 12-15 min at 121.
tubes containing inverted 6 x 50 mm fermentation tubes. Autoclave 10 min at 118. Final pH, 7.4 0.2. Alternatively, dissolve ingredients, omitting carbohydrate, in 800 ml distilled water with heat and occasional agitation. Dispense 2.0 ml portions into 13 x 100 mm test tubes containing inverted fermentation tubes. Autoclave 15 min at 118 and let cool. Dissolve carbohydrate in 200 ml distilled water and sterilize by passing solution through bacteria-retaining filter. Aseptically add 0.5 ml sterile filtrate to each tube of sterilized broth after cooling to less than 45. Shake gently to mix. Final pH, 7.4 0.2.
Potato infusion: 200 ml Dextrose: 20 g Agar: 20 g Distilled water: 1 litre To prepare potato infusion, boil 200 g sliced, unpeeled potatoes in 1 liter distilled water for 30 min. Filter through cheesecloth, saving effluent, which is potato infusion. Mix in other ingredients and boil to dissolve. Autoclave 15 min at 121. Dispense 20-25 ml portions into sterile 15 x 100 mm petri dishes. Final pH, 5.6 0.2. Medium should not be re-melted more than once. For potato dextrose salt agar, prepare potato dextrose agar, as above, and add 75 g NaC1 per litre.
Polypeptone: 5 g Lactose: 4 g Sodium selenite (NaHSeO3): 4 g Na2HPO4: 5.5 g KH2PO4: 4.5 g L-Cystine: 0.01 g Distilled water : 1 litre Heat with agitation to dissolve. Dispense 10 ml portions to sterile 16 x 150 mm test tubes. Heat 10 min in flowing steam. Do not autoclave. Use same day as prepared.
Suspend ingredients in 1 litre distilled water, mix, and heat to boiling. (Precipitate will not dissolve completely.) Cool to less than 45. Store at 5-8. Final pH, 8.4 0.2.
Distilled water
1 litre
These two media are interchangeable for general use. For use with V. parahaemolyticus, add 25 g NaC1 per litre to either formula. Suspend ingredients of Medium 1 in distilled water, mix thoroughly, and heat with occasional agitation. Boil about 1 min to dissolve ingredients. Fill 16 x 150 mm tubes 1/3 full and cap or plug to maintain aerobic conditions. Autoclave Medium 1 for 15 min at 118. Prepare Medium 2 in the same manner as Medium 1, except autoclave 15 min at 121. Before the media solidify, incline tubes to obtain 4-5 cm slant and 2-3 cm butt. Final pH, 7.3 0.2 for Medium 1 and 7.4 0.2 for Medium 2.
Urea Broth
Urea: 20 g Yeast extract: 0.1 g KH2PO4: 9.1 g
Na2HPO4: 9.5 g Phenol red: 0.01 g Distilled water: 1 litre Dissolve ingredients in distilled water. Do not heat. Sterilize by filtration through 0.45 m membrane. Aseptically dispense 1.5-3.0 ml portions to 13 x 100 mm sterile test tubes. Final pH, 6.8 0.2.
Heat with agitation just until medium boils. Do not overheat. Pour into plates when medium has cooled to 50. Let dry about 2 h with covers partially removed. Then close plates. Final pH, 7.4 0.2. Do not store more than 1 day.
Reagents
Butterfield's Phosphate-Buffered Dilution Water Stock solution
KH2PO4: 34 g Distilled water: 500 ml Adjust pH to 7.2 with 1 N NaOH. Bring volume to 1 litre with distilled water. Sterilize 15 min at 121. Store in refrigerator.
Dilution blanks
Take 1.25 ml of above stock solution and bring volume to 1 litre with distilled water. Dispense into bottles to 90 or 99 1 ml. Sterilize 15 min at 121.
Kovacs' Reagent
p-Dimethylaminobenzaldehyde: 5 g Amyl alcohol (normal only): 75 ml HC1 (concentrated): 25 ml Dissolve p-dimethylaminobenzaldehyde in normal amyl alcohol. Slowly add HC1. Store at 4. To test for indole, add 0.2-0.3 ml reagent to 5 ml of 24 h bacteria culture in tryptone broth. Dark red colour in surface layer is positive test for indole. For enteropathogenic E. coli, also test at 72 h if negative at 24 h.
Solution 2
Potassium hydroxide: 40 g Distilled water to make 100 ml Voges-Proskauer (VP) test. At room temperature, transfer 1 ml of 48 h culture to test tube and add 0.6 ml solution 1 and 0.2 ml solution 2. Shake after adding each solution. To intensify and speed reaction, add a few creatine crystals to mixture. Read results 4 h after adding reagents. Development of eosin pink colour is a positive test.
X. IDENTIFICATION TESTS
o
Acetate Aluminum Ammonium Benzoate Bicarbonate Bisulfite Bromate Bromide Calcium Carbonate Chloride Citrate Copper Ferrocyanide Iodide Iron Lactate Magnesium Manganese Nitrate Nitrite Peroxide Phosphate Potassium Sodium Sulfate Sulfite Tartrate Thiosulfate Zinc
X. IDENTIFICATION TESTS
Acetate
Acetic acid or acetates, when warmed with sulfuric acid and alcohol, form ethyl acetate, recognizable by its characteristic odour. With neutral solutions of acetates, ferric
chloride TS produces a deep red colour which is destroyed by the addition of a mineral acid.
Aluminum
Solutions of aluminum salts yield with ammonia TS a white, gelatinous precipitate which is insoluble in an excess of ammonia TS. A similar precipitate is produced by sodium hydroxide TS or sodium sulfide TS, but it dissolves in an excess of either reagent.
Ammonium
Sodium hydroxide TS decomposes ammonium salts with the evolution of ammonia, recognizable by its odour and its alkaline effect upon moistened red litmus paper. The decomposition is accelerated by warming.
Benzoate
Neutral solutions of benzoates yield a salmon-coloured precipitate with ferric chloride TS. From moderately concentrated solutions of benzoate, dilute sulfuric acid TS precipitates free benzoic acid, which is readily soluble in ether.
Bicarbonate
See Carbonate.
Bisulfite
See Sulfite.
Bromate
Solutions of bromates acidified with nitric acid (1 in 20), yield a white, crystalline precipitate with the addition of 2 or 3 drops of silver nitrate TS, which dissolves by heating. A pale yellow precipitate is produced with the addition of 1 drop of sodium nitrite TS. Solutions of bromates acidified with nitric acid (1 in 20), produce a yellow to reddish brown colour with the addition of 5 or 6 drops of sodium nitrite TS. With the addition of 1 ml of chloroform and stirring, the chloroform layer becomes a yellow to reddish brown colour.
Bromide
Free bromine is liberated from solutions of bromides upon the addition of chlorine TS, dropwise. When shaken with chloroform, the bromine dissolves, colouring the chloroform red to reddish brown. A yellowish white precipitate, which is insoluble in nitric acid and slightly soluble in ammonia TS, is produced when solutions of bromides are treated with silver nitrate TS.
Calcium
Insoluble oxalate salts are formed when solutions of calcium salts are treated in the following manner: using 2 drops of methyl red TS as indicator, neutralize a solution of a calcium salt (1 in 20) with ammonia TS. A white precipitate of calcium oxalate forms upon the addition of ammonium oxalate TS. This precipitate is insoluble in acetic acid but dissolves in hydrochloric acid. Calcium salts moistened with hydrochloric acid impart a transient yellowish red colour to a non-luminous flame.
Carbonate
Carbonates and bicarbonates effervesce with acids, yielding a colourless gas which produces a white precipitate immediately when passed into calcium hydroxide TS. Cold solutions of soluble carbonates are coloured red by phenolphthalein TS, whereas solutions of bicarbonates remain unchanged or are slightly changed.
Chloride
Solutions of chlorides yield with silver nitrate TS a white, curdy precipitate which is insoluble in nitric acid but soluble in a slight excess of ammonia TS. Chlorine, recognizable by its distinctive odour, is evolved when solutions of chloride are warmed with potassium permanganate and dilute sulfuric acid TS.
Citrate
When a few mg of a citrate are added to a mixture of 15 ml of pyridine and 5 ml of acetic anhydride, a carmine red colour is produced.
Copper
When solutions of cupric compounds are acidified with hydrochloric acid, a red film of metallic copper is deposited upon a bright untarnished surface of metallic iron. An excess of ammonia TS, added to a solution of a cupric salt, produces first a bluish precipitate and then a deep blue-coloured solution. Solutions of cupric salts yield with potassium ferrocyanide TS a reddish brown precipitate, insoluble in dilute acids.
Ferrocyanide
To 10 ml of a 1% solution of the sample add 1 ml of ferric chloride TS. A dark blue precipitate is formed.
Iodide
Solutions of iodides, upon the addition of chlorine TS, dropwise, liberate iodine which colours the solution yellow to red. Chloroform is coloured violet when shaken with this solution. The iodine thus liberated gives a blue colour with starch TS. Silver nitrate TS produces in solutions of iodides a yellow, curdy precipitate which is insoluble in nitric acid and in ammonia TS.
Iron
Solutions of ferrous and ferric compounds yield a black precipitate with ammonium sulfide TS. This precipitate is dissolved by cold dilute hydrochloric acid TS with evolution of hydrogen sulfide.
Ferric salts
Potassium ferrocyanide TS produces a dark blue precipitate in acid solutions of ferric salts. With an excess of sodium hydroxide TS, a reddish brown precipitate is formed. Solutions of ferric salts produce with ammonium thiocyanate TS a deep red colour which is not destroyed by dilute mineral acids.
Ferrous salts
Potassium ferricyanide TS produces a dark blue precipitate in solutions of ferrous salts. This precipitate, which is insoluble in dilute hydrochloric acid, is decomposed by sodium hydroxite TS. Solutions of ferrous salts yield with sodium hydroxide TS a greenish white precipitate, the colour rapidly changing to green and then to brown when shaken.
Lactate
When solutions of lactates are acidified with sulfuric acid, and potassium permanganate TS is added and the mixture heated, acetaldehyde, recognizable by its distinctive odour, is evolved.
Magnesium
Solutions of magnesium salts in the presence of ammonium chloride yield no precipitate with ammonium carbonate TS, but a white, crystalline precipitate, which is insoluble in ammonia TS, is formed upon the subsequent addition of sodium phosphate TS.
Manganese
Solution of manganous salts yield with ammonium sulfide TS a salmon-coloured precipitate which dissolves in acetic acid.
Nitrate
When a solution of a nitrate is mixed with an equal volume of sulfuric acid, the mixture cooled, and a solution of ferrous sulfate superimposed, a brown colour is produced at the junction of the two liquids. Brownish red fumes are evolved when a nitrate is heated with sulfuric acid and metallic copper. Nitrates do not decolourize acidified potassium permanganate TS (distinction from nitrites).
Nitrite
Nitrites yield brownish red fumes when treated with dilute mineral acids or acetic acid. A few drops of potassium iodide TS and a few drops of dilute sulfuric acid TS added to a solution of a nitrite liberate iodine which colours starch TS blue.
Peroxide
Solutions of peroxides slightly acidified with sulfuric acid yield a deep blue colour upon the addition of potassium dichromate TS. On shaking the mixture with an equal volume of ether and allowing the liquids to separate, the blue colour is transferred to the ether layer.
Phosphate
Neutral solutions of orthophosphates yield with silver nitrate TS a yellow precipitate, which is soluble in dilute nitric acid TS or in ammonia TS. With ammonium molybdate TS, a yellow precipitate, which is soluble in ammonia TS, is formed.
Potassium
Potassium compounds impart a violet colour to a non-luminous flame if not masked by the presence of small quantities of sodium. In neutral, concentrated or moderately concentrated solutions of potassium salts, sodium bitartrate TS slowly produces a white, crystalline precipitate which is soluble in ammonia TS and in solutions of alkali hydroxides or carbonates. The precipitation may be accelerated by stirring or rubbing the inside of the test tube with a glass rod or by the addition of a small amount of glacial acetic acid or ethanol.
Sodium
Sodium compounds, after conversion to chloride or nitrate, yield with cobalt-uranyl acetate TS a golden-yellow precipitate, which forms after several min agitation. Sodium compounds impart an intense yellow colour to a non-luminous flame.
Sulfate
Solutions of sulfates yield with barium chloride TS a white precipitate which is insoluble in hydrochloric and nitric acids. Sulfates yield with lead acetate TS a white precipitate which is soluble in ammonium acetate solution. Hydrochloric acid produces no precipitate when added to solutions of sulfates (distinction from thiosulfates).
Sulfite
When treated with dilute hydrochloric acid TS sulfites and bisulfites yield sulfur dioxide, recognizable by its characteristic odour. This gas blackens filter paper moistened with mercurous nitrate TS.
Tartrate
When a few mg of a tartrate are added to a mixture of 15 ml of pyridine and 5 ml of acetic anhydride, an emerald green colour is produced.
Thiosulfate
Solutions of thiosulfates yield with hydrochloric acid a white precipitate which soon turns yellow, liberating sulfur dioxide, recognizable by its odour. The addition of ferric
chloride TS to solutions of thiosulfates produces a dark violet colour which quickly disappears.
Zinc
Zinc salts, in the presence of sodium acetate, yield a white precipitate with hydrogen sulfide. This precipitate, which is insoluble in acetic acid, is dissolved by dilute hydrochloric acid TS. A similar precipitate is produced by ammonium sulfide TS in neutral or alkaline solutions. Solutions of zinc salts yield with potassium ferrocyanide TS a white precipitate which is insoluble in dilute hydrochloric acid TS.
XI. STANDARD BUFFER SOLUTIONS o BUFFER TEST SOLUTIONS Buffer TS (pH 2) Buffer TS (pH 5) Buffer TS (pH 5.45) Buffer TS (pH 6.5) Buffer acetate TS (pH 5.0) Barbital buffer solution (pH 7.6) Citric acid buffer solution Formic acid buffer solution (pH 2.5) Phosphate buffer solution (pH 7.0) Phosphate buffer solution (pH 7.5) o STANDARD BUFFER SOLUTION Reagent Solutions Composition of Standard Buffer Solutions
Buffer TS (pH 5)
Add 51.5 ml of 0.2 M disodium hydrogen phosphate to 48.5 ml of 0.1 M citric acid.
Procedure
To prepare a standard buffer solution having a pH within the range 1.2 to 10.0, combine the appropriate solutions, prepared above, as shown in the following table, and dilute with water to make 200 ml. The standard pH values given in this table are considered to be reproducible to within 0.02 of the pH unit specified at 25.
1.2 1.3 1.4 1.5 1.6 1.7 1.8 1.9 2.0 2.1 2.2
85.0 67.2 53.2 41.4 32.4 26.0 20.4 16.2 13.0 10.2 7.8
2.2 2.4 2.6 2.8 3.0 3.2 3.4 3.6 3.8 4.0
49.5 42.2 35.4 28.9 22.3 15.7 10.4 6.3 2.9 0.1
5.8 6.0 6.2 6.4 6.6 6.8 7.0 7.2 7.4 7.6 7.8 8.0
3.6 5.6 8.1 11.6 16.4 22.4 29.1 34.7 39.1 42.4 44.5 46.1
8.0 8.2 8.4 8.6 8.8 9.0 9.2 9.4 9.6 9.8 10.0
3.9 6.0 8.6 11.8 15.8 20.8 26.4 32.1 36.9 40.6 43.7
Ammonium Standard Solution Barium Standard Solution Barium Chloride Standard Solution Chromium Standard Solution Condensed Formaldehyde Standard Solution Dithizone Standard Solution Formaldehyde Standard Solution Iron Standard Solution Lead Standard Solution Lead Standard Solution for Dithizone test Magnesium Standard Solution Mercury Standard Solution
Methanol Standard Solution Nitrate Standard Solution Phosphate Standard Solution Potassium Phosphate, Monobasic, Standard Solution Selenium Standard Solution Thiamine Hydrochloride Standard Solution Zinc Standard Solution
into a 1,000-ml volumetric flask, dilute to volume with water, and mix. Each ml of this solution contains 10 g PO4.
Acetic Acid TS Acetic Acid TS, Dilute Acetic Acid TS, Strong Acetic Anhydride/Benzol TS Acetic Anhydride/Pyridine TS Acetic Periodic Acid TS Alcohols Alcoholic Potassium Hydroxide TS Alizarin Yellow GG TS Alizarin Yellow GG/Thymolphthalein TS Alkaline Cupric Tartrate TS Alkaline Mercuric-Potassium Iodide TS Alkaline Tartrate Solution TS 1-Amino-2-Naphthol-4-Sulfonic Acid TS Ammonia TS Ammonia TS, Dilute Ammonia TS, Strong Ammonia TS, Dilute (PbT) Ammonia TS, Ethanolic Ammonia/Ammonium Chloride Buffer TS Ammoniacal Silver Nitrate TS Ammonium Acetate TS Ammonium Acetate Citrate TS (PbT)
Ammonium Carbonate TS Ammonium Chloride TS Ammonium Chloride/Ammonium Hydroxide TS Ammonium Citrate TS (PbT) Ammonium Molybdate TS Ammonium Molybdate/Sulfuric Acid TS Ammonium Oxalate TS Ammonium Sulfanilate TS Ammonium Sulfide TS Ammonium Thiocyanate TS Ammonium Thiocyanate/Cobalt Nitrate TS Amylase TS Anthrone TS Antimony TS, Standard Antimony Trichloride TS Arsenic TS, Dilute Arsenic TS, Strong Arsenous Acid TS Barium Chloride TS Barium Diphenylamine Sulfonate TS Benedict's Qualitative Reagent Benzidine TS Bertrand's TS, A Bertrand's TS, B Bertrand's TS, C Bertrand's TS, D 2,2'-Bipyridine TS Bismuth Nitrate TS (I) Bismuth Nitrate TS (II) Borax Buffer (PbT) Boric Acid TS Bromide/Bromate TS Bromine TS Bromine/Acetic Acid TS Bromine/Bromide TS Bromine/Glacial Acetic Acid TS Bromine/Hydrochloric Acid TS Bromine/Potassium Bromide TS Bromocresol Blue TS Bromocresol Green TS Bromocresol Green/Methyl Red TS Bromocresol Purple TS Bromophenol Blue TS Bromophenol Blue TS Bromophenol Blue/Sodium Hydroxide TS Bromothymol Blue TS Buffer TS Calcium Chloride TS Calcium Hydroxide TS Carr-Price TS Ceric Ammonium Nitrate TS Chloral Hydrate TS Chlorine TS Chromate TS, Standard Chromic Acid TS
Chromium Trioxide TS Chromotropic Acid TS Citric Acid Buffer Solution Cobaltous Chloride TS Cobaltous Chloride TSC Cobalt-Uranyl Acetate TS Congo Red TS Copper Sulfate Solution TS Cresol Red TS Cresol Red/Thymol Blue TS Crystal Violet TS Cupric Acetate TS, Strong Cupric Citrate TS, Alkaline Cupric Nitrate TS Cupric Sulfate TS Cupric Sulfate TSC Cupric Sulfate/Ammonia TS Cupric Tartrate TS, Alkaline Cyanogen Bromide TS Denigs' Reagent 4,4'-Diaminodiphenylamine TS Di--Naphthylthiocarbazone/Chloroform TS 2,6-Dichlorophenol-Indophenol TS 2,7-Dihydroxynaphthalene TS p-Dimethylaminobenzaldehyde TS Dimethylglyoxime TS 2,4-Dinitrophenylhydrazine TS Diphenylamine TS Diphenylcarbazide TS Diphenylcarbazone TS Diphenylthiocarbazone Solution (PbT) alpha,alpha-Dipyridyl TS Dithizone TS Dithizone TS, Extraction Dithizone TS, Standard Dragendorff TS Eosin Y TS Eriochrome Black TS Ethanol Ethanol, Absolute Ethanol, Aldehyde-free Ethanol TS, Purified Absolute Ethanol, 90% Ethanol, 80% Ethanol TS, 72% Ethanol 70% Ethanolic Potassium Hydroxide TS p-Ethoxychrysoidin TS Fehling's TS Ferric Ammonium Sulfate TS Ferric Ammonium Sulfate/Hydrochloric Acid TS Ferric Chloride TS Ferric Chloride TSC Ferric Chloride TS, Ethanolic Ferric Chloride TS, Dilute
Ferric Chloride/Hydrochloric Acid TS Ferric Sulfate TS Ferric Sulfate TS, Acid Ferrous Sulfate TS Ferrous Sulfate TS, Acid Fluorescein TS Folin-Ciocalteu TS Formaldehyde TS Formalin/Sulfuric Acid TS Fuchsin/Sulfurous Acid TS Hydriodic Acid TS Hydrochloric Acid TS, Brominated Hydrochloric Acid TS, Dilute Hydrochloric Acid, Dilute (PbT) Hydrochloric Acid TS, Stannated Hydrogen Peroxide TS Hydrogen Sulfide TS Hydroxylamine Hydrochloride TS 8-Hydroxyquinoline TS Indigo Carmine TS Iodine TS Iron Indicator TS Iron TS, Standard Lead TS, Standard Lead Acetate TS Lead Acetate TS, Basic Lead Subacetate TS Lead Subacetate TS, Dilute Litmus TS Manganese Sulfate TS Magnesia Mixture TS Magnesium Sulfate TS Malachite Green TS Mayer's TS Mercuric Acetate TS Mercuric Chloride TS Mercuric-Potassium Iodide TS Mercuric-Potassium Iodide TS, Alkaline Mercuric Nitrate TS Mercuric Sulfate TS Mercurous Nitrate TS p-Methylaminophenol Sulfate TS Methylene Blue TS Methylene Blue TS, Diluted Methyl Orange TS Methyl Orange/Xylencyanol FF TS Methyl Red TS Methyl Red/Methylene Blue TS Methylrosaniline Chloride TS Methyl Violet TS Millon's TS Murexide Indicator Preparation Naphthalenediol TS 1-Naphthol TS Naphthol Green TS
alpha-Naphtholbenzein TS Nessler's TS Neutral Red TS Ninhydrin TS Nitric Acid TS, Dilute Nitric Acid/Sulfuric Acid TS Nitrite Standard TS o-Nitrobenzaldehyde TS Orthophenanthroline TS Oxalic Acid TS Oxalic Acid/Sulfuric Acid TS 8-Oxyquinoline TS Phenol Red TS Phenolphthalein TS Phenolphthalein/Thymol Blue TS Phenolsulfonphthalein TS Phenylhydrazine Hydrochloride/Sodium Acetate TS p-Phenylphenol TS Phloroglucin/Hydrochloric Acid TS Phosphomolybdic Acid TS Phosphotungstic Acid TS Picric Acid TS Platinic Chloride TS Platinum/Cobalt TSC Potassium Acetate TS Potassium Acetate in Acetic Acid TS Potassium Bichromate TS Potassium Bromate/Potassium Bromide TS Potassium Chloride/Hydrochloric Acid TS Potassium Chromate TS Potassium Cyanate TS Potassium Cyanide TS (PbT) Potassium Dichromate TS Potassium Ferricyanide TS Potassium Ferrocyanide TS Potassium Hydroxide TS Potassium Hydroxide TS, Ethanolic Potassium Iodate TS Potassium Iodide TS Potassium Permanganate TS Potassium Permanganate/Phosphoric Acid TS Potassium Pyroantimonate TS Potassium Sodium Tartrate TS Potassium Sulfate TS Pyridine/Acetic Anhydride TS Pyridinium Chloride/Chloroform TS Quimociac TS Quinaldine Red TS Salicylaldehyde TS Schiff's TS Schiff's TS, Modified Silicotungstic Acid TS Silver Ammonionitrate TS Silver Ammonium Nitrate TS Silver Nitrate TS
Silver Nitrate TS, Acid Silver Nitrate Spray TS Sodium Acetate TS Sodium Azide TS Sodium Bisulfite TS Sodium Bitartrate TS Sodium Borate TS Sodium Carbonate TS Sodium Chloride TS Sodium Cobaltinitrite TS Sodium Ethoxide TS Sodium Fluorescein TS Sodium Fluoride TS Sodium Hydrogen Sulfite TS Sodium Hydroxide TS Sodium Hydroxide TS (5%), Methanolic Sodium Indigotindisulfonate TS Sodium Nitrite TS Sodium Nitroferricyanide TS Sodium Nitroprusside TS Sodium Phosphate TS Sodium Phosphate TS, Dibasic Sodium Phosphate TS, Monobasic Sodium Starch Glycolate TS (5%) Sodium Starch Glycolate TS (1%) Sodium Sulfide TS Sodium Sulfide TS (PbT) Sodium Thiosulfate TS Stannous Chloride TS Starch TS Starch Iodide Paste TS Starch Mucilage TS Sulfanilic Acid TS Sulfanilic Acid/alpha-Naphthylamine TS Sulfuric Acid TS Sulfuric Acid TS, Dilute Sulfuric Acid/Periodic Acid TS Tannic Acid TS Tannic Acid/Glacial Acetic Acid TS Tartrate Solution TS, Alkaline Thymol Blue TS Thiourea TS Thymolphthalein TS Tin (II) Sulfate TS Triketohydrindene Hydrate TS Trinitrophenol TS Uranyl Acetate TS Uranyl Zinc Acetate TS Vanadic Acid/Molybdic Acid TS Xylenol Orange TS Zinc Amalgam TS Zinc Sulfate TS Zinc Sulfate TS, Standard Zirconium/Alizarin TS Zwikker's TS
To 25 g of acetic anhydride add sufficient dehydrated pyridine to make 100 ml. Prepare freshly before use.
Acetic Periodic Acid TS
Dissolve 5.4 g of periodic acid in 100 ml of distilled water and then add 1900 ml of glacial acetic acid and mix thoroughly. Store the solution in a dark glass-stoppered bottle or store in the dark in a clear glass-stoppered bottle.
Alcohols
See ethanols.
Alcoholic Potassium Hydroxide TS
Dissolve 0.2 g of 1-amino-2-naphthol-4-sulfonic acid in 195 ml of sodium bisulfite solution (3 in 20) and 5 ml of anhydrous sodium sulfite solution (1 in 5), and filter if necessary. Stopper tightly, and store in a dark, cold place. Use within 10 days of preparation.
Ammonia TS
A solution containing between 9.5% and 10.5% of NH3 (approximately 6 N). Prepare by diluting 400 ml of ammonium hydroxide (28%) with sufficient water to make 1,000 ml.
Ammonia TS, Dilute
Dilute ammonia TS, which complies with the following test: to 20 ml of ammonia TS add 1 ml of potassium cyanide TS (PbT), dilute to 50 ml with water and add 2 drops of sodium sulfide TS (PbT); no darkening should be produced.
Ammonia TS, Ethanolic
A 9 to 11% w/v solution of NH3 in ethanol. A transparent, colourless liquid having a strong odour of ammonia. Specific gravity is about 0.80. Store in a rubber-stoppered container and in a cold place.
Ammonia/Ammonium Chloride Buffer TS
(Approx. pH 10). Dissolve 67.5 g of ammonium chloride (NH4C1) in water, add 570 ml of ammonium hydroxide (28%) and dilute with water to 1,000 ml.
Ammoniacal Silver Nitrate TS
Add ammonia TS, dropwise, to a 1 in 20 solution of silver nitrate until the precipitate that first forms is almost, but not entirely, dissolved. Filter the solution, and store in a dark bottle. (Note. Ammoniacal silver nitrate TS forms explosive compounds on standing. Do not store this solution, but prepare a fresh quantity for each series of determination. Neutralize the excess reagent and rinse all glassware with hydrochloric acid immediately after completing a test.)
Ammonium Acetate TS
Dissolve 12.5 g of ammonium acetate (CH3COONH4) and 12.5 g of ammonium citrate [C3H4OH(COOH)(COONH4)2] in water, add strong ammonia TS until the solution is alkaline to thymol blue paper and add water to 100 ml. Purify with a 0.002% w/v solution of dithizone in chloroform, and finally shake the solution with chloroform to remove excess of dithizone.
Ammonium Carbonate TS
Dissolve 20 g of ammonium carbonate and 20 ml of ammonia TS in sufficient water to make 100 ml.
Ammonium Chloride TS
Mix equal volumes of water and strong ammonia TS, and saturate with ammonium chloride.
Ammonium Citrate TS (PbT)
Dissolve 40 g of citric acid in 90 ml of water. Add 2 or 3 drops of phenol red TS, then cautiously add strong ammonia TS until the solution acquires a reddish colour. Remove any lead that may be present by extracting the solution with 20-ml portions of dithizone extraction TS until the dithizone solution retains its orange-green colour.
Ammonium Molybdate TS
Dissolve 6.5 g of finely powdered molybdic acid (85%) in a mixture of 14 ml of water and 14.5 ml of strong ammonia TS. Cool the solution, and add it slowly, with stirring, to a well-cooled mixture of 32 ml of nitric acid and 40 ml of water. Allow to stand for 48 h, and filter through glass wool. This solution deteriorates upon standing and is unsuitable for use if, upon the addition of 2 ml of sodium phosphate TS to 5 ml of the solution, an abundant yellow precipitate does not form at once or after slight warming. Store it in the dark. If a precipitate forms during storage use only the clear, supernatant solution.
Ammonium Molybdate/Sulfuric Acid TS
Dissolve 18.8 g of ammonium molybdate in 300 ml of water, and add 150 ml of sulfuric acid and sufficient water to make 500 ml.
Ammonium Oxalate TS
A 3.0% w/v solution of ammonium oxalate [(COONH4)2] in water (approximately 0.5 N).
Ammonium Sulfanilate TS
To 2.5 g of sulfanilic acid add 15 ml of water and 3 ml of ammonia TS and mix. If necessary, add with stirring, more ammonia TS, until the acid dissolves. Adjust the pH of the solution to about 4.5 with dilute hydrochloric acid TS, using bromocresol green TS as an outside indicator, and dilute to 25 ml.
Ammonium Sulfide TS
Saturate ammonia TS with hydrogen sulfide (H2S), and add two-thirds of its volume of ammonia TS. Residue on ignition: not more than 0.05%. The solution is not rendered turbid either by magnesium sulfate TS or by calcium chloride TS (carbonate). This solution is unsuitable for use if an abundant precipitate of sulfur is present. Store it in a small, well-filled, dark amber-coloured bottle, in a cold, dark place.
Ammonium Thiocyanate TS
Dissolve 17.4 g of ammonium thiocyanate and 2.8 g of cobalt nitrate in sufficient water to make 100 ml.
Amylase TS
To 0.2 g of amylase (crystal), add 100 ml of water, shake well and filter. Prepare freshly before use.
Anthrone TS
Dissolve about 0.1 g of anthrone in 100 g of sulfuric acid. Prepare freshly before use.
Antimony TS, Standard
Dissolve 2.742 g of antimony potassium tartrate in water, and dilute to 100 ml; dilute 5 ml of this solution to 500 ml with water. Each ml of the solution contains 0.001 mg of Sb.
Antimony Trichloride TS
Wash the surface of antimony trichloride with anhydrous chloroform until the washings become transparent. Add anhydrous chloroform to antimony trichloride to make a saturated solution. Store in a tight container shaded from light and in a cold place. Prepare freshly before use.
Arsenic TS, Dilute
Mix 1 ml of strong arsenic TS with sufficient water to produce 100 ml. The dilute solution of arsenic must be freshly prepared. 1 ml contains 0.01 mg of arsenic.
Arsenic TS, Strong
Dissolve 0.132 g of arsenic trioxide in 50 ml of hydrochloric acid (a 25% w/v solution of HC1 in water) and add sufficient water to 100 ml.
Arsenous Acid TS
Dissolve 1 g of arsenous acid in 30 ml of sodium hydroxide solution (1 in 40), and heat. Cool, and slowly add sufficient glacial acetic acid to 100 ml.
Barium Chloride TS
Dissolve 50 mg of benzidine in 10 ml of glacial acetic acid, dilute to 100 ml with water and mix. (Caution: benzidine is toxic.)
Bertrand's TS, A
Dissolve 40 g of fine cupric sulfate in sufficient water to make 1,000 ml. Fill a glassstoppered container almost to the top, and store.
Bertrand's TS, B
Dissolve 200 g of potassium sodium tartrate and 150 g of sodium hydroxide in sufficient water to make 1,000 ml. Store in a rubber-stoppered container.
Bertrand's TS, C
Dissolve 50 g of ferric sulfate (shall not reduce potassium permanganate solution) in sufficient water. Add 200 ml of sulfuric acid, and add sufficient water to make 1,000 ml.
Bertrand's TS, D
Dissolve 5 g of potassium permanganate in sufficient water to make 1,000 ml. Standardization: Dissolve 0.25 g of ammonium oxalate in 100 ml of water, and add 2 ml of sulfuric acid. Heat this solution to the temperature of 60 to 70, and titrate with Bertrand's TS, D. If the volume of Bertrand's TS, D consumed is designated as a ml, each 1 ml of Bertrand's TS, D is equivalent to (0.2238/a)g of Cu.
2,2'-Bipyridine TS
Reflux 5 g of bismuth nitrate (Bi(NO3)35H2O), in 7.5 ml of nitric acid and 10 ml of water until dissolved, cool, filter and dilute the solution to 250 ml.
Bismuth Nitrate TS (II)
Dissolve 5 g of bismuth nitrate (Bi(NO3)35H2O) in 25 ml of water and 25 ml of glacial acetic acid and dilute to 250 ml.
Borax Buffer (PbT)
Dissolve 3.0 g of borax in 90 ml of water, and extract with successive portions, each of 5 ml of 1 volume of diphenylthiocarbazone solution PbT and 4 volumes of chloroform, with vigorous shaking, until the extract is blue or purple in colour; continue the extraction with successive portions, each of 10 ml of chloroform, until the extract is colourless; reject the extracts, and dilute the solution to 100 ml with water.
Boric Acid TS
Dissolve 5 g boric acid in 500 ml distilled water in a 1,000-ml measuring flask. Add 25 ml alcoholic indicator solution (67 mg methyl red and 33 mg bromocresol green in 100 ml 96% ethanol) and 200 ml ethanol. Make up to volume with distilled water. The boric acid indicator solution is red. 5 ml must turn green with not more than 3 drops of 0.01 N NaOH.
Bromide/Bromate TS
(About 0.1 N bromine) (7.991 g Br per litre). Dissolve 3 g of potassium bromate (KBrO3) and 15 g of potassium bromide (KBr) in sufficient water to make 1,000 ml and standardize the solution as follows: transfer about 25 ml of the solution, accurately measured, into a 500-ml iodine flask and dilute with 120 ml of water. Add 5 ml of hydrochloric acid, stopper the flask and shake it gently. Then add 5 ml of potassium iodide TS, re-stopper, shake the mixture, allow it to stand for 5 min and titrate the liberated iodine with 0.1 N sodium thiosulfate, adding starch TS near the end of the titration. Calculate the normality. Store this solution in a dark amber coloured, glassstoppered bottle.
Bromine TS
(Bromine water). A saturated solution of bromine, prepared by agitating 2 to 3 ml of bromine (Br2) with 100 ml of cold water in a glass-stoppered bottled, the stopper of which should be lubricated with petrolatum. Store it in a cold place, protected from light.
Bromine/Acetic Acid TS
Dissolve 5 ml of bromine in 145 ml of potassium acetate in acetic acid TS. Prepare this solution fresh daily.
Bromine/Bromide TS
Add 1 ml of bromine to 300 ml of glacial acetic acid saturated with dry potassium bromide (5 g). 15 ml of this solution require about 50 ml of 0.05 N sodium thiosulfate. This solution is stored in a dark bottle and kept in the dark. It is standardized at least once a day during use.
Bromine/Glacial Acetic Acid TS
Dissolve about 1.5 g of bromine in sufficient glacial acetic acid to make about 100 ml. Each 1 ml of this solution is equivalent to about 2 ml of 0.1 N sodium thiosulfate.
Bromine/Hydrochloric Acid TS
Dissolve 30 g of bromine and 30 g of potassium bromide in sufficient water to make 100 ml.
Bromocresol Blue TS
Dissolve 0.05 g of bromocresol green in 100 ml of ethanol, and filter if necessary. For pH determinations, dissolve 0.05 g in 1.4 ml of 0,05 N sodium hydroxide, and dilute with carbon dioxide-free water to 100 ml.
Bromocresol Green/Methyl Red TS
Dissolve 0.25 g of bromocresol purple in 20 ml of 0.05 N sodium hydroxide, and dilute with water to 250 ml.
Bromophenol Blue TS
Dissolve 0.1 g of bromophenol blue in 100 ml of dilute ethanol (1 in 2), and filter if necessary. For pH determinations, dissolve 0.1 g in 3.0 ml of 0.05 N sodium hydroxide, and dilute with carbon dioxide-free water to 200 ml.
Bromophenol Blue TS
(For citric acid). Mix bromophenol blue TS with equal volume of ethanol, adjust pH to 7.0 by adding 0.01 N sodium hydroxide solution.
Bromophenol Blue/Sodium Hydroxide TS
Dissolve 0.1 g of bromophenol blue in 3 ml of 0.05 N sodium hydroxide by mixing well, and add sufficient water to 25 ml.
Bromothymol Blue TS
Dissolve 0.1 g of bromothymol blue in 100 ml of dilute ethanol (1 in 2), and filter if necessary. For pH determinations, dissolve 0.1 g in 3.2 ml of 0.05 N sodium hydroxide, and dilute with carbon dioxide-free water to 200 ml.
Buffer TS
A solution containing approximately 0.14 g of Ca(OH)2 in each 100 ml. To prepare, add 3 g of calcium hydroxide [Ca(OH)2] to 1,000 ml of water, and agitate the mixture vigorously and repeatedly during 1 h. Allow the excess calcium hydroxide to settle, and decant or draw off the clear supernatant liquid.
Carr-Price TS
Weigh an unopened (100 g) bottle of antimony trichloride. Open the bottle and empty the contents into a wide-mouthed, glass-stoppered amber bottle containing approximately 100 ml of chloroform. By difference, obtain the weight of antimony trichloride and then add sufficient chloroform to supply 100 ml for each 25 g. Dissolve by warming or shaking for several hours and filter through sodium sulfate into a clean, dry, amber bottle with ground glass stopper. This solution may be stored at room temperature but should be kept in the dark when not in use. The reagent is apparently stable for long periods of time, but it is convenient to make up sufficient amounts to last for one month. Rinse all glassware coming in contact with this reagent with chloroform, a mixture of ethanol and ether or dilute or concentrated hydrochloric acid before washing, since the antimony oxychloride which forms is insoluble in water.
Ceric Ammonium Nitrate TS
Dissolve 6.25 g of ceric ammonium nitrate [(NH4)2Ce(NO3)6] in 100 ml of 0.25 N nitric acid. Prepare the solution fresh every third day.
Chloral Hydrate TS
(Chlorine water). A saturated solution of chlorine in water. Place the solution in a small, completely filled, light-resistant container. Chlorine TS, even when kept from light and air, is apt to deteriorate. Store it in a cold, dark place. For full strenght, prepare this solution fresh.
Chromate TS, Standard
Dissolve 0.0566 g potassium dichromate (K2Cr2O7) in 1,000 ml of water. Each ml contains 0.02 mg of Cr.
Chromic Acid TS
Dissolve 2.0 g of chromotropic acid (4,5-dihydroxy-2,7-naphthalene-disulfonic acid, disodium salt) in 40 ml of water in a 1-litre volumetric flask. Dilute to volume with 15 M sulfuric acid.
Citric Acid Buffer Solution
Dissolve 2 g of cobaltous chloride (CoC126H2O) in 1 ml of hydrochloric acid and sufficient water to make 100 ml.
Cobaltous Chloride TSC
Dissolve about 65 g cobaltous chloride (CoC126H2O) in enough of a mixture of 25 ml of hydrochloric acid and 975 ml of water to make 1,000 ml. Place exactly 5 ml of this solution in a 250-ml iodine flask, add 5 ml of hydrogen peroxide TS and 15 ml of 20% sodium hydroxide solution. Boil for 10 min, cool, and add 2 g of potassium iodide and 20 ml of 25% sulfuric acid. When the precipitate has dissolved, titrate the liberated iodine with 0.1 N sodium thiosulfate, using starch TS as indicator. Each ml of 0.1 N sodium thiosulfate is equivalent to 23.8 mg of CoC126H2O. Adjust the final volume of the solution by adding enough of the hydrochloric acid and water mixture so that each ml contain 59.5 mg of CoC126H2O.
Cobalt-Uranyl Acetate TS
Dissolve, with warming, 40 g of uranyl acetate [UO2(C2H3O2)22H2O] in a mixture of 30 g glacial acetic acid and sufficient water to make 500 ml. Similary, prepare a solution containing 200 g of cobaltous acetate [Co(C2H3O2)24H2O] in a mixture of 30 g of glacial acetic acid and sufficient water to make 500 ml. Mix the two solutions while still warm, and cool to 20. Maintain the temperature at 20 for about 2 h to separate the excess salts from solution, and then filter through a dry filter.
Congo Red TS
Dissolve 0.10 g of congo red (sodium diphenyl-diazo-bis-alphanaphthylaminesulfonate) (C32H22N6O6S2Na2) in 20 ml of 90% ethanol and add sufficient water to make 100 ml.
Copper Sulfate Solution TS
Dissolve 34.639 g of CuSO45H2O in water, dilute to 500 ml, and filter through glass wool or paper. Determine the Cu content of the solution (preferably by electrolysis), and adjust the content to 440.9 mg Cu/25 ml.
Cresol Red TS
Triturate 0.10 g of cresol red in a mortar with 26.2 ml of 0.01 N sodium hydroxide until solution is complete, then dilute the solution with water to 250 ml.
Cresol Red/Thymol Blue TS
A 1% solution of methyl violet (methyl-rosaniline chloride; crystal violet) in glacial acetic acid.
Cupric Acetate TS, Strong
(Benedict's qualitative reagent). With the aid of heat, dissolve 173 g of sodium citrate (C6H5Na3O72H2O) and 117 g of sodium carbonate (Na2CO3H2O) in about 700 ml of water, and filter through paper, if necessary. In a separate container dissolve 17.3 g of cupric sulfate (CuSO45H2O) in about 100 ml of water, and slowly add this solution, with constant stirring, to the first solution. Cool the mixture, dilute to 100 ml, and mix.
Cupric Nitrate TS
Dissolve about 65 g of cupric sulfate (CuSO45H2O) in enough of a mixture of 25 ml of hydrochloric acid and 975 ml of water to make 1,000 ml. Pipet 10.0 ml of this solution in a 250-ml iodine flask, add 40 ml of water, 4 ml of acetic acid, and 3 g of potassium iodide. Titrate the liberated iodine with 0.1 N sodium thiosulfate, using starch TS as indicator. Each ml of 0.1 N sodium thiosulfate is equivalent to 24.97 mg of CuSO45H2O. Adjust the final volume of the solution by adding enough of the mixture of hydrochloric acid and water to make each ml contain 62.4 mg of CuSO45H2O.
Cupric Sulfate/Ammonia TS
Dissolve 0.4 g of cupric sulfate in 50 ml mixture of ammonia TS and solution of citric acid (1 in 5) in the ratio of 2:3.
Cupric Tartrate TS, Alkaline
(Fehling's TS). [The Copper Solution (A)]. Dissolve 34.66 g of carefully selected, small crystals of cupric sulfate (CuSO45H2O) showing no trace of efflorescence or of adhering moisture, in sufficient water to make 500 ml. Store this solution in a small, tight container. [The Alkaline Tartrate Solution (B)]. Dissolve 173 g of crystallized potassium sodium tartrate (KNaC4H4O64H2O) and 50 g of sodium hydroxide (NaOH) in sufficient water to make 500 ml. Store this solution in a small, alkali-resistant container. For use, mix exactly equal volumes of Solutions A and B at the time required.
Cyanogen Bromide TS
Dissolve 5 g of cyanogen bromide in water to make 50 ml. Caution. Prepare this solution under a hood, as cyanogen bromide volatilizes at room temperature and the vapour is highly irritating and poisonous.
Denigs' Reagent
Triturate 4,4'-diaminodiphenylamine sulfate with a small amount of ethanol, and add ethanol again. Transfer this solution to a flask connected to a reflux condenser, heat on a water bath, and prepare a saturated solution.
Di--Naphthylthiocarbazone/Chloroform TS
Add 0.1 g of di--naphthylthiocarbazone to 100 ml of carbon tetra-chloride. Dilute this solution 1:40 with chloroform.
2,6-Dichlorophenol-Indophenol TS
Warm 0.1 g of 2,6-dichlorophenol-indophenol sodium (C12H6C12NNaO2) with 100 ml of water and filter. The solution must be used within 3 days of preparation.
2,7-Dihydroxynaphthalene TS
Dissolve 0.1 g of 2,7-dihydroxynaphthalene in 1,000 ml of sulfuric acid and allow the solution to stand until the initial yellow colour disappears. If the solution is very dark, discard it and prepare a new solution from a different supply of sulfuric acid. This solution is stable for approximately one month if stored in a dark bottle.
p-Dimethylaminobenzaldehyde TS
Dissolve 0.125 g of p-dimethylaminobenzaldehyde in a cooled mixture of 65 ml of sulfuric acid and 35 ml of water, and add 0.05 ml of ferric chloride TS. Use within 7 days after preparation.
Dimethylglyoxime TS
Dissolve 0.2 g of 2,4-dinitrophenylhydrazine in 100 ml of 85% sulfuric acid. Filter through a glass-filter (G3) if necessary. Store in a light-shaded bottle and in a dark, cold place. Use within 2 weeks of preparation.
Diphenylamine TS
A 1% w/v solution of diphenylamine [(C6H5)2NH] in sulfuric acid. The solution should be colourless.
Diphenylcarbazide TS
Dissolve 0.125 g of diphenylcarbazide [(C6H5NHNH)2CO] in a mixture of 25 ml acetone and 25 ml water. To be prepared immediately before use.
Diphenylcarbazone TS
An approximately 1% w/v solution of diphenylcarbazone (C13H12N4O) in ethanol. Store this solution in a brown bottle.
Diphenylthiocarbazone Solution (PbT)
Extract 15 ml of a 0.1% w/v solution of diphenylthiocarbazone (C6H4N:NCSNHNHC6H5) in chloroform, with 2 successive portions, each of 50 ml of water containing 5 ml of dilute ammonia TS; acidify the combined extracts with dilute hydrochloric acid PbT, and extract with 100 ml of chloroform; wash the extract with 2 successive portions, each of 10 ml of water, and filter through a dry filter. Determine the approximate strength of this solution by the method for determination of zinc (see titanium dioxide monograph), using 5 ml of standard zinc sulfate TS diluted to 25 ml with water in place of the 25 ml of acid solution used in the determination; dilute with chloroform so that 3 ml is approximately equivalent to each ml of standard zinc sulfate TS. This solution must be freshly prepared.
alpha,alpha-Dipyridyl TS
Dissolve 30 mg of dithizone in 1,000 ml of chloroform, and add 5 ml of ethanol. Store the solution in a refrigerator. Before use shake a suitable volume of the dithizone extraction solution with abouth half its volume of 1% nitric acid, discarding the nitric acid. Do not use more than 1 month old.
Dithizone TS, Standard
Dissolve 10 mg of dithizone in 1,000 ml of chloroform. Keep the solution in a glassstoppered, lead-free bottle, suitably wrapped to protect it from light, and store in a refrigerator.
Dragendorff TS
Solution 1: Weigh 0.85 g of basic bismuth nitrate, and dissolve in 10 ml of acetic acid and 40 ml of water. Solution 2: Weigh 8 g of potassium iodide, and dissolve in 20 ml of water. Mix 5 ml of Solution 1, 5 ml of Solution 2, 20 ml of acetic acid, and 100 ml of water before use.
Eosin Y TS
Dissolve 0.2 g of eriochrome black T and 2 g of hydroxylamine hydrochloride (NH2OHHC1) in sufficient methanol to make 50 ml, and filter. Store the solution in a light-resistant container and use within 2 weeks.
Ethanol
To 1,000 ml of ethanol, add 5 ml of sulfuric acid and 20 ml of water, and distil. Add 10 g of silver nitrate and 1 g of potassium hydroxide to a 1,000 ml portion of this distillate, boil for 3 h by connecting a reflux condenser, and recover the ethanol by distillation.
Ethanol TS, Purified Absolute
Add about 0.1% potassium permanganate and 0.1% potassium hydroxide to absolute ethanol and distil in an all-glass apparatus.
Ethanol, 90%
Dissolve 50 mg of p-ethoxychrysoidin monohydrochloride in a mixture of 25 ml of water and 25 ml of ethanol, add 3 drops of hydrochloric acid, stir vigorously, and filter if necessary to obtain a clear solution.
Fehling's TS
Dissolve about 55 g of ferric chloride (FeCl36H2O) in sufficient of a mixture of 25 ml of hydrochloric acid and 975 ml of water to make 1,000 ml. Pipet 10 ml of this solution in a 250-ml iodine flask, add 15 ml of water and 3 g of potassium iodide, and allow the mixture to stand for 15 min. Dilute with 100 ml of water, and titrate the liberated iodine with 0.1 N sodium thiosulfate, adding starch TS. Each ml of 0.1 N sodium thiosulfate is equivalent to 27.03 mg of FeCl36H2O. Adjust the final volume of the solution by the addition of enough of the mixture of hydrochloric acid and water, so that each ml contains 45.0 mg of FeCl36H2O.
Ferric Chloride TS, Ethanolic
A 0.2% w/v solution of ferric chloride (FeCl36H2O) in absolute ethanol. Prepare this solution fresh.
Ferric Chloride TS, Dilute
To 2 ml of ferric chloride TS, add sufficient water to make 100 ml. Prepare freshly before use.
Ferric Chloride/Hydrochloric Acid TS
Dissolve 5 g of ferric chloride (FeCl36H2O) in 5 ml of hydrochloric acid and sufficient water to make 100 ml.
Ferric Sulfate TS
Add 500 ml of water to 50 g of ferric sulfate, and mix thoroughly. To this mixture, add 200 ml of sulfuric acid, dissolve by shaking well, and add sufficient water to make 1,000 ml.
Ferric Sulfate TS, Acid
Add 7.5 ml of sulfuric acid to 100 ml of water, and dissolve 80 g of ferrous sulfate in the mixture with the aid of heat. Mix 7.5 ml of nitric acid and 20 ml of water, warm, and add to this the ferrous sulfate solution. Concentrate the mixture until, with the sudden emission of a red coloured vapour, the black colour of the liquid changes to red. Test for the absence of ferrous iron, and, if necessary, add a few drops of nitric acid and boil again. When the solution is cold, add sufficient water to make 110 ml.
Ferrous Sulfate TS
Dissolve 8 g of clear crystals of ferrous sulfate (FeSO47H2O) in about 100 ml of recently boiled and thoroughly cooled water. Prepare this solution fresh.
Ferrous Sulfate TS, Acid
Dissolve 7 g of ferrous sulfate crystals in 90 ml of recently boiled and thoroughly cooled water, and add sufficient sulfuric acid to make 100 ml. Standardize frequently with 0.1 N potassium permanganate (approximately 0.25 N).
Fluorescein TS
Into a 150-ml flask introduce 10 g of sodium tungstate (Na2WO42H2O), 2.5 g of sodium molybdate (Na2MoO42H2O), 70 ml of water, 5 ml of phosphoric acid, and 10 ml of hydrochloric acid. Reflux the mixture gently for about 10 h, and add 15 g of lithium sulfate (Li2SO4H2O), 50 ml of water, and few drops of bromine. Boil the mixture, without the condenser, for 15 min or until the excess bromine is expelled. Cool, dilute with water to 100 ml, and filter. The filtrate has no greenish tint. Before use, dilute 1 part of filtrate with 1 part of water.
Formaldehyde TS
A solution containing approximately 37.0% w/v of HCHO. It may contain methanol to prevent polymerization.
Formalin/Sulfuric Acid TS
Mix 0.2 ml of formaldehyde TS with 10 ml of sulfuric acid. Prepare freshly before use.
Fuchsin/Sulfurous Acid TS
Dissolve 0.5 g of basic fuchsin in 300 ml of hot water, and cool. Add a solution of 5 g anhydrous sodium sulfite dissolved in 50 ml of water while stirring, and add 5 ml of hydrochloric acid with shaking. Dilute with water to 500 ml, and allow to stand for 5 h. Store in a light-shaded bottle, and in a cold place.
Hydriodic Acid TS
Distil hydriodic acid over red phosphorus, passing carbon dioxide through the apparatus during the distillation. The constant-boiling mixture distilling over a 126127, which is colourless or nearly colourless, is used. Place the acid in a small, brown, glass-stoppered bottle previously swept out with carbon dioxide, seal with paraffin, and store in a cool, dark place.
Hydrochloric Acid TS, Brominated
A solution containing 10% w/v of HC1. Prepare by diluting 266 ml of hydrochloric acid (36%) with sufficient water to make 1,000 ml.
Hydrochloric Acid, Dilute (PbT)
A solution containing approximately 10% w/v of HCl; it complies with the following test: make 10 ml alkaline with ammonia dilute, PbT add 1 ml of potassium cyanide solution PbT, dilute to 50 ml with water, and add 2 drops of a 10% sodium sulfide solution in water. No darkening is produced.
Hydrochloric Acid TS, Stannated
Mix 1 ml of a solution of stannous chloride TS with 100 ml of hydrochloric acid (a 25% w/v solution of HC1 in water).
Hydrogen Peroxide TS
A solution containing between 2.5 and 3.5 g of H2O2 in each 100 ml. It may contain suitable preservatives, totalling not more than 0.05%.
Hydrogen Sulfide TS
A saturated solution of hydrogen sulfide made by passing H2S into cold water. Store it in a small, dark, amber-coloured bottle, filled nearly to the top. It is unsuitable unless it possesses a strong odour of H2S, and unless it produces at once a copious precipitate of sulfur when added to an equal volume of ferric chloride TS. Store in a cold dark place.
Hydroxylamine Hydrochloride TS
Dissolve 20 g of hydroxylamine hydrochloride (HONH2HCl) in sufficient water to make approximately 65 ml. Transfer to a separatory funnel, add a few drops of thymol blue pH indicator, then add strong ammonia TS until the solution assumes a yellow colour. Add 10 ml of a 4% solution of sodium diethyldithiocarbamate, mix well, and allow to stand for 5 min. Extract this solution with succesive 10 to 15-ml portions of chloroform until a 5-ml portion of the chloroform extract does not assume a yellow colour when shaken with a dilute cupric sulfate solution. Add diluted hydrochloric acid PbT until the solution is pink, and then dilute with sufficient water to make 100 ml.
8-Hydroxyquinoline TS
Dissolve a quantity of indigo carmine (sodium indigotindisulfonate) equivalent to 0.18 g of C16H8O8N2S2Na2, in sufficient water to make 100 ml. This solution should be used within 60 days of preparation.
Iodine TS
Dissolve 14 g of iodine in a solution of 36 g of potassium iodide in 100 ml of water, add 3 drops of hydrochloric acid, and dilute with water to 1,000 ml.
Iron Indicator TS
Place 62.5 g of ferric ammonium sulfate in a one-litre bottle, dissolve in 500 ml of water, add 450 ml of concentrated nitric acid, and mix.
Iron TS, Standard
Dissolve 0.70 g of Fe(NH4)2(SO4)26H2O in 50 ml of water and add 20 ml of dilute H2SO4(1:15). Dilute to 1,000 ml with water and mix thoroughly. Dilute 10 ml of this solution to 100 ml with water. Each ml contains 0.01 mg of Fe.
Lead TS, Standard
Dissolve 0.1598 g of lead nitrate [Pb(NO3)2] in water to which has been added 1 ml of nitric acid and dilute to 1,000 ml. Then dilute 10 ml of this solution to 100 ml. Each ml contains 0.01 mg of lead. This solution must be freshly prepared.
Lead Acetate TS
Dissolve 9.5 g of clear, transparent crystals of lead acetate [Pb(COOCH3)23H2O] in sufficient recently boiled water to make 100 ml. Store in a well-stoppered bottle.
Lead Acetate TS, Basic
Mix 10 parts of finely pulverized lead oxide (PbO) with 30 parts of lead acetate [Pb(COOCH3)23H2O] and 5 parts of water and heat gently in a closed vessel shaking repeatedly, until the mixture is white. Add 95 parts of water, heat for 1 h, shaking repeatedly, allow to cool and filter. Add water if necessary to obtain a solution of specific gravity 1.225-1.230.
Lead Subacetate TS
Triturate 14 g of lead monoxide (PbO) to a smooth paste with 10 ml of water, and transfer the mixture to a bottle, using an additional 10 ml of water for rinsing. Dissolve 22 g of lead acetate [Pb(COOCH3)23H20] in 70 ml of water, and add the solution to the lead oxide mixture. Shake it vigorously for 5 min, then set it aside, shaking it frequently over 7 days. Finally filter, and add enough recently boiled water through the filter to make 100 ml.
Dilute 3.25 ml of lead subacetate TS with sufficient water, recently boiled and cooled, to make 100 ml. Store in a small, well-filled, tight container.
Litmus TS
Boil 10 g of litmus of reagent purity with 40 ml of ethanol (90%) for 1 h and pour away the clear liquid, repeat this operation twice with 30 ml of ethanol (90%). Digest the washed litmus with 100 ml of boiling water for 1 h, cool and filter.
Manganese Sulfate TS
Dissolve 90 g of manganese sulfate in 200 ml of water, 175 ml of phosphoric acid and 350 ml of diluted sulfuric acid (1 in 2). Add sufficient water to 1,000 ml.
Magnesia Mixture TS
Dissolve 5.5 g of magnesium chloride (MgCl26H2O) and 7 g of ammonium chloride (NH4Cl) in 65 ml of water, add 35 ml of ammonia TS, set the mixture aside for a few days in a well-stoppered bottle, and then filter. If the solution is not perfectly clear, filter again before use.
Magnesium Sulfate TS
Dissolve 12 g of crystals of magnesium sulfate (MgSO47H2O), selected for freedom from efflorescence, in water to make 100 ml.
Malachite Green TS
A 6% w/v solution of mercuric acetate [Hg(COOCH3)2] in glacial acetic acid. Store in a tight container protected from direct sun-light.
Mercuric Chloride TS
A 6.5% w/v solution of mercuric chloride (HgCl2) in water (approximately 0.5 N).
Mercuric-Potassium Iodide TS
(Mayer's TS). Dissolve 1.358 g of mercuric chloride (HgCl2) in 60 ml of water. Dissolve 5 g of potassium iodide (KI) in 10 ml of water. Mix the two solutions, and add water to make 100 ml.
Mercuric-Potassium Iodide TS, Alkaline
(Nessler's TS). Dissolve 10 g of potassium iodide (KI) in 10 ml of water, and add slowly with stirring, a saturated solution of mercuric chloride until a slight red precipitate remains undissolved. To this mixture add an ice-cold solution of 30 g of potassium hydroxide (KOH) in 60 ml of water, then add 1 ml more of the saturated solution of mercuric chloride. Dilute with water to 200 ml. Allow the precipitate to settle, and draw off the clear liquid. A 2-ml portion of this reagent, when added to 100 ml of a 1 in 300,000 solution of ammonium chloride in ammonia-free water, produces at once a yellowish brown colour.
Mercuric Nitrate TS
Dissolve 40 g of yellow mercuric oxide (HgO) in a mixture of 32 ml of nitric acid and 15 ml of water. Store in a light-shaded, glass-stoppered bottle (approximately 4 N).
Mercuric Sulfate TS
(Denigs' TS). Mix 5 g of yellow mercuric oxide (HgO) with 40 ml of water, and while stirring slowly add 20 ml of sulfuric acid, then add another 40 ml of water, and stir until completely dissolved (approximately 0.5 N).
Mercurous Nitrate TS
Dissolve 200 g of mercury in nitric acid and add sufficient water to produce 1,000 ml. Mercurous nitrate TS should be kept in a bottle containing a little metallic mercury.
p-Methylaminophenol Sulfate TS
Dissolve 2 g of p-methylaminophenol sulfate [(HOC6H4NHCH3)2H2SO4] in 100 ml of water. To 10 ml of this solution add 90 ml of water and 20 g of sodium bisulfite. Confirm the suitability of this solution by the following test: add 1 ml of the solution to each of four tubes containing 25 ml of 0.5 N sulfuric acid and 1 ml of ammonium molybdate TS. Add 5 g of phosphate (PO4) to one tube, 10 g to a second, and 20 g to a third, using 0.5, 1.0, and 2.0 ml, respectively, of Phosphate Standard Solution, and allow to stand for 2 h. The solutions in the three tubes should show readily perceptible differences in blue colour corresponding to the relative amounts of phosphate added, and the one to which 5 g of phosphate was added should be perceptibly bluer than the blank.
Methylene Blue TS
Dissolve 0.125 g of methylene blue in 100 ml of ethanol, and dilute with ethanol to 250 ml.
Methylene Blue TS, Diluted
Dissolve 1 g of methyl orange and 1.4 g of xylencyanol FF in 500 ml of 50% v/v ethanol.
Methyl Red TS
Dissolve 0.1 g of methyl red in 100 ml of ethanol, and filter if necessary. For pH determinations, dissolve 0.1 g in 7.4 ml of 0.05 N sodium hydroxide, and dilute with carbon dioxide-free water to 200 ml.
Methyl Red/Methylene Blue TS
To 2 ml of mercury in an Erlenmeyer flask add 20 ml of nitric acid. Shake the flask under a hood to break up the mercury into small globules. After about 10 min add 35 ml of water and, if a precipitate or crystals appear, add sufficient dilute nitric acid (1 in 5, prepared from nitric acid free from the oxides which have been removed by blowing air through it until it is colourless) to dissolve the separated solid. Add sodium hydroxide solution (1 in 10), dropwise, with thorough mixing, until the curdy precipitate that forms after the addition of each drop no longer redissolves but is dispersed to form a suspension. Add 5 ml more of the dilute nitric acid, and mix well. Prepare this solution fresh.
Murexide Indicator Preparation
Add 0.4 g of murexide to 40 g of powdered potassium sulfate, and grind in a glass mortar to a homogeneous mixture. (Tablets containing 0.4 mg of murexide admixed with potassium sulfate or potassium chloride are available commercially.)
Naphthalenediol TS
Dissolve 0.1 g of 2,7-dihydroxynaphthalene in 1,000 ml of sulfuric acid and allow the solution to stand in the dark until the yellow colour has disappeared (at least 18 h).
1-Naphthol TS
A 0.2% w/v solution of ninhydrin (triketohydrindene hydrate, C9H4O3H2O) in water. Prepare this solution fresh.
Nitric Acid TS, Dilute
A solution containing about 10% w/v of HNO3. Prepared by diluting 105 ml of nitric acid (70%) with water to make 1,000 ml.
Nitric Acid/Sulfuric Acid TS
Prepare about 1,000 ml of nitric acid (32-35% w/v of HNO3) by diluting 420 ml of nitric acid (70%) with 580 ml of distilled water, and add 30 ml of sulfuric acid.
Nitrite Standard TS
Dissolve 1.5 g of sodium nitrite (NaNO2) in 1,000 ml of carbon dioxide-and ammoniafree water. Each contains 1 mg of NO2.
o-Nitrobenzaldehyde TS
Dissolve 0.15 g of orthophenanthroline (C12H8N2H2O) in 10 ml of a solution of ferrous sulfate, prepared by dissolving 1.48 g of clear crystals of ferrous sulfate (FeSO47H2O) in 100 ml water. The ferrous sulfate solution must be prepared immediately before dissolving the orthophenanthroline. Store the solution in well-closed containers.
Oxalic Acid TS
Add an equal volume of sulfuric acid to water, and cool. To a 500 ml portion of the solution, add 25 g of oxalic acid.
8-Oxyquinoline TS
Dissolve 2 g of 8-oxyquinoline in 6 ml of glacial acetic acid. Add sufficient water to 100 ml. Prepare freshly before use.
Phenol Red TS
(Phenolsulfonphthalein TS). Dissolve 0.1 g of phenolsulfonphthalein in 100 ml of ethanol, and filter if necessary. For pH determinations, dissolve 0.1 g in 5.7 ml of 0.05 N sodium hydroxide, and dilute with carbon dioxide-free water to 200 ml.
Phenolphthalein TS
Dissolve 0.2 g of phenolphthalein (C20H14O4) in 60 ml of 90% ethanol and add sufficient water to make 100 ml.
Phenolphthalein/Thymol Blue TS
Dissolve 2 g of phenolphthalein and 0.1 g of thymol blue in 100 ml of absolute ethanol, and filter if necessary. Prepare freshly before use.
Phenolsulfonphthalein TS
Dissolve 0.5 g of phenylhydrazine hydrochloride in 10 ml of sodium acetate TS, and filter if necessary. Prepare freshly before use.
p-Phenylphenol TS
Dissolve 0.1 g of phloroglucin in 1 ml of ethanol, add 9 ml of hydrochloric acid, and mix well. Store in a dark place.
Phosphomolybdic Acid TS
Dissolve 5 g of phosphomolybdic acid (20MoO32H3PO448H2O) in water, filter and dilute to 100 ml with water.
Phosphotungstic Acid TS
Transfer 1.246 g of potassium chloroplatinate (K2PtC16), and 1.00 g of crystallized cobaltous chloride, (CoCl26H2O), into a 1,000-ml volumetric flask, dissolve in about 200 ml of water and 100 ml of hydrochloric acid, dilute to volume with water, and mix. (Use this solution only when specified in an individual monograph.)
Potassium Acetate TS
Dissolve 10 g of potassium acetate in 100 ml of a solution consisting of 90 ml of glacial acetic acid and 10 ml of acetic anhydride.
Potassium Bichromate TS
Dissolve 1.4 g of potassium bromate and 8.1 g of potassium bromide in sufficient water to make 100 ml.
Potassium Chloride/Hydrochloric Acid TS
Dissolve 50 g of potassium cyanide in sufficient purified water to make 100 ml. Remove the lead by shaking with portions of the dithizone extraction TS. Part of the dithizone remains in the aqueous phase but can be removed, if desired, by washing with chloroform. The strong potassium cyanide solution is then diluted to a concentration of 10 g per 100 ml.
Potassium Dichromate TS
Place a few g (5 to 10) of potassium hydroxide in a 2-litre flask, add 1 to 1.5 L of of 95% ethanol and boil on a water bath under reflux condenser from 30 to 60 min. Distil and collect the ethanol. Dissolve 40 g of potassium hydroxide, low in carbonate, in 1,000 ml of the distilled ethanol keeping the temperature below 15.5 while the alkali is being dissolved. This solution should remain clear.
Potassium Iodate TS
A 16.5% w/v solution of potassium iodide (KI) in water (approximately N). Store in a light-resistant container.
Potassium Permanganate TS
To 75 ml of phosphoric acid, add sufficient water to 500 ml, and dissolve 15 g of potassium permanganate in the solution.
Potassium Pyroantimonate TS
To 2 g of potassium pyroantimonate, add 100 ml of water. Boil the solution for about 5 min, cool quickly, and add 10 ml of 15% potassium hydroxide solution. Allow to stand for one day, and filter.
Potassium Sodium Tartrate TS
Mix 3 volumes of pyridine with 1 volume of acetic anhydride. Prepare freshly before use.
Pyridinium Chloride/Chloroform TS
Place 75 g of anhydrous pyridine (C5H5N) and approximately 400 ml of chloroform in a 2-litre graduated cylinder. Weigh the cylinder and cool it in an ice water bath. Bubble dry hydrogen chloride slowly through the solution. At intervals of several min interrupt the flow of gas, remove, dry and weigh the cylinder and its contents to determine the rate of flow of the gas. When approximately 35 g have been added, stop the flow of gas, warm the mixture to room temperature and expel the vapours with a stream of dry air. Add 100 ml of anhydrous pyridine and dilute to 1,000 ml with chloroform. When most of the reagent has been used, discard the last 100 ml.
Quimociac TS
Dissolve 70 g of sodium molybdate (Na2MoO42H2O) in 150 ml of water (Solution A). Dissolve 60 g of citric acid in a mixture of 85 ml of nitric acid and 150 ml of water, and cool (Solution B). Gradually add Solution A to Solution B, with stirring, to produce Solution C. Dissolve 5.0 ml of synthetic quinoline in a mixture of 35 ml of nitric acid and 100 ml of water (Solution D). Gradually add Solution D to Solution C, mix well, and allow to stand overnight. Filter the mixture, add 280 ml of acetone to the filtrate, dilute to 1,000 ml with water, and mix. Store in a polyethylene bottle. Caution. This reagent contains acetone. Do not use near an open flame. Operations involving heating or boiling should be conducted in a well-ventilated hood.
Quinaldine Red TS
Aqueous solution of 0.125 g of crystalline rosaline chlorohydrate in 1,000 ml and discolourized with sulfurous acid.
Schiff's TS, Modified
Dissolve 0.2 g of rosaniline hydrochloride (C20H20ClN3) in 120 ml of hot water. Cool, add 2 g of sodium bisulfite (NaHSO3) followed by 2 ml of hydrochloric acid, and dilute to 200 ml with water. Store in a brown bottle at 15 or lower.
Silicotungstic Acid TS
Dissolve 10 g of silicotungstic acid (SiO212WO326H2O) in water and neutralize with 10% sodium hydroxide solution to a methyl red endpoint. Dilute to approximately 100 ml.
Silver Ammonionitrate TS
Dissolve 1 g of silver nitrate in 20 ml of water. Add ammonia TS, dropwise, with constant stirring, until the precipitate is almost but not entirely dissolved. Filter, and store in a tight, light-resistant container.
Silver Nitrate TS
A 4.2% w/v solution of silver nitrate (AgNO3) in water (approximately 0.25 N).
Silver Nitrate TS, Acid
Dissolve 15 g of silver nitrate in 50 ml of water, add 400 ml of ethanol and several drops of concentrated nitric acid. This solution is standardized against 0.05 N ammonium thiocyanate by the Volhard method. The solution is very stable.
Silver Nitrate Spray TS
Prepare the following two solutions: (a) Dissolve 50 g of silver nitrate in 450 ml of distilled water. Store in an amber bottle. (b) Add 120 ml of concentrated ammonium hydroxide to 330 ml of distilled water. When required combine equal volumes of solutions (a) and (b) for use as spray reagent.
Sodium Acetate TS
Prepare a solution of sodium bisulfite in water (approximately 0.5 N). Check the pH and if necessary, adjust to the range 3.0 to 4.5 with dilute sulfuric acid or sodium hydroxide.
Sodium Bitartrate TS
A 1% w/v solution of sodium bitartrate (NaHC4H4O6H2O) in water (approximately N). Prepare this solution fresh.
Sodium Borate TS
Dissolve 10 g of sodium in 120 ml of absolute ethanol, using the following method: remove surplus oil from the sodium metal with filter paper, weigh in benzol and again dry on a filter paper. Cut the weighed metal into small pieces about the size of a pea and carefully add one or two pieces at a time to a 500-ml conical flask which is fitted with a water-cooled reflux condenser and contains the 120 ml of ethanol.
Sodium Fluorescein TS
Dry about 0.5 g of sodium fluoride (NaF) at 200 for 4 h. Weigh accurately 0.222 g of the dried sodium fluoride, and dissolve it in sufficient water to make exactly 100 ml. Transfer 10.0 ml of this solution into a 1,000-ml volumetric flask, dilute to volume with water, and mix. Each ml of this final solution corresponds to 0.01 mg of fluorine (F).
Sodium Hydrogen Sulfite TS
A 33.3% w/v solution of sodium hydrogen sulfite in water. Prepare freshly before use.
Sodium Hydroxide TS
Dissolve 5 g of sodium hydroxide in 5 ml of water, then add sufficient methanol to make 100 ml. Use supernate.
Sodium Indigotindisulfonate TS
A 10% w/v solution of sodium nitrite in water. Prepare freshly before use.
Sodium Nitroferricyanide TS
A 5% w/v solution of sodium nitroferricyanide [Na2Fe(NO)(CN)52H2O] in water. Prepare this solution fresh.
Sodium Nitroprusside TS
A 12% w/v solution of clear crystals of dibasic sodium phosphate (Na2HPO47H2O) in water.
Sodium Phosphate TS, Monobasic
A 62.4% w/v solution of monobasic sodium phosphate (NaH2PO42H2O) in water (approximately 4 M).
Sodium Starch Glycolate TS (5%)
Moisten 5 g of sodium starch glycolate with a few drops of ethanol, add 100 ml of water and boil for 2-3 min, and cool.
Sodium Starch Glycolate TS (1%)
Dilute 10 ml of sodium starch glycolate TS (5%) to 50 ml with distilled water. Prepare freshly before use.
Sodium Sulfide TS
A 10% w/v solution of sodium sulfide (Na2S9H2O) in water. Prepare this solution fresh.
Sodium Sulfide TS (PbT)
Dissolve 10 g of sodium sulfide (PbT) in sufficient water to make 100 ml and filter.
Sodium Thiosulfate TS
Dissolve 3.2 g of stannous chloride (SnCl22H2O) in 40 ml of 0.3 N hydrochloric acid. Transfer the solution to a 100-ml volumetric flask and dilute to the mark with 0.3 N hydrochloric acid. Prepare fresh daily. The stannous chloride solution should be titrated with sulfuric periodic acid TS before use and adjusted so that 10.0 ml of the stannous chloride reagent will titrate 10.2 ml of the periodic acid reagent. For the titration, 5 ml of concentrated hydrochloric acid are added to 10 ml of stannous chloride plus 1 ml of starch indicator (a blue colour indicates the endpoint).
Starch TS
Triturate 1 g of arrowroot starch with 10 ml of cold water, and pour slowly, with constant stirring, into 200 ml of boiling water. Boil the mixture until a thin, translucent fluid is obtained. (Longer boiling than necessary renders the solution less sensitive.) Allow to settle, and use only the clear, supernatant liquid. Prepare this solution fresh.
Heat 100 ml of water in a 250-ml beaker to boiling, add a solution of 0.75 g of potassium iodide (KI) in 5 ml of water, then add 2 g of zinc chloride (ZnCl2) dissolved in 10 ml of water, and, while the solution is boiling, add with stirring a smooth suspension of 5 g of potato starch in 30 ml of cold water. Continue to boil for 2 min, then cool. Store in a well-closed container in a cool place. This mixture must show a definite blue streak when a glass rod dipped in a mixture of 1 ml of 0.1 M sodium nitrite, 500 ml of water, and 10 ml of hydrochloric acid, is streaked on a smear of the paste.
Starch Mucilage TS
A 0.8% w/v solution of sulfanilic acid (p-NH2C6H4SO3HH2O) in acetic acid. Store in a tight container.
Sulfanilic Acid/alpha-Naphthylamine TS
Dissolve 0.5 g of sulfanilic acid in 150 ml of acetic acid. Dissolve 0.1 g of alphanaphthylamine in 0.26 g of hydrochloric acid and 150 ml of acetic acid, and mix. When a pink colour is produced upon standing, add zinc dust to discolourize.
Sulfuric Acid TS
Add a quantity of sulfuric acid of known concentration to sufficient water to adjust the final concentration to between 94.5 and 95.5% of H2SO4.
Sulfuric Acid TS, Dilute
A solution containing 10% w/v of H2SO4. Prepare by cautiously adding 57 ml of sulfuric acid (95-98%) or sulfuric acid TS to about 100 ml of water, then cool to room temperature, and dilute with water to 1,000 ml (approximately 2 N).
Sulfuric Acid/Periodic Acid TS
Dissolve 3.42 g of periodic acid (H5IO6) in 100 ml of 0.25 M sulfuric acid. Transfer the solution to a 500-ml volumetric flask and dilute to the mark with 0.25 M sulfuric acid (approximately 0.03 M sulfuric acid/periodic acid).
Tannic Acid TS
Dissolve 1 g of tannic acid (tannin) in 1 ml of ethanol, and add water to make 10 ml. Prepare this solution fresh.
Tannic Acid/Glacial Acetic Acid TS
Dissolve 10 mg of tannic acid in 80 ml of glacial acetic acid while shaking, and add 32 ml of phosphoric acid. Prepare freshly before use.
Tartrate Solution TS, Alkaline
Dissolve 34.6 g of potassium sodium tartrate (Rochelle salt) and 10 g of sodium hydroxide in water, dilute to 100 ml, let stand two days, and filter through glass wool.
Thymol Blue TS
Dissolve 0.1 g of thymol blue in 100 ml of ethanol, and filter if necessary. For pH determinations, dissolve 0.1 g in 4.3 ml of 0.05 N sodium hydroxide, and dilute with carbon dioxide-free water to 200 ml.
Thiourea TS
Add 10 g of tin (II) sulfate to 100 ml of 1% sulfuric acid. Agitate continuously for several hours decanting the solution from the insoluble fraction at frequent intervals.
Triketohydrindene Hydrate TS
(Picric acid TS). Dissolve the equivalent of 1 g of anhydrous trinitrophenol in 100 ml of hot water. Cool the solution, and filter if necessary.
Uranyl Acetate TS
Dissolve 10 g of uranyl acetate [(CH3COO)2UO22H2O)] by heating with 50 ml of water and 5 ml of acetic acid (a solution containing approximately 30% w/v of CH3COOH, in water, approximately 5 N). Dissolve 3 g of zinc acetate [(CH3COO)2Zn] in 30 ml of water and 3 ml of 30% w/v acetic acid (approximately 5 N). Mix the two solutions, allow to cool to room temperature, and remove by filtration any solid material which separates.
Vanadic Acid/Molybdic Acid TS
Dissolve 1.12 g of ammonium metavanadate in about 300 ml of warm water, add 250 ml of nitric acid. Combine the cooled solution with another solution of 27 g of ammonium molybdate in about 400 ml of warm water, then add sufficient amount of water to make 1,000 ml. Use after 3 to 4 days of preservation in coloured bottle.
Xylenol Orange TS
Zinc Amalgam TS
Add about 10 g of granulated zinc to sufficient mercury, about 20 ml, to produce a liquid amalgam on cooling, and heat at 150, with stirring, until the zinc is dissolved. Zinc amalgam may be used repeatedly until the content of zinc is reduced to 0.2% w/w, as determined by the following process. Fill a pycnometer with mercury at 25 1, and weigh. Repeat the operation, using the amalgam. Calculate the proportion of zinc from the formula: Percentage w/w of zinc = (13.534 - A) / 0.000875 where A = (wt of amalgam - 13.534) / wt of mercury
Zinc Sulfate TS
Dissolve 0.440 g of zinc sulfate in sufficient water to produce 1,000 ml, and dilute 50 ml of the solution to 1,000 ml with water. Each ml of the solution contains 5 g of zinc.
Zirconium/Alizarin TS
Dissolve 0.80 g of zirconium nitrate [Zr(NO3)25H2O] in water, add a few drops of 4 N nitric acid, and make up to 100 ml with water. Dissolve 0.10 g of alizarin sulfonate monohydrate in 20 ml of water, and make up to 100 ml with ethanol. Mix 1 ml of the first solution with 1 ml of the second solution and add 18 ml of water. This solution must be clear and the dilution should be freshly prepared.
Zwikker's TS
Mix 1 ml of pyridine with 4 ml of a 10% aqueous solution of copper sulfate and 5 ml of water.
Normal Solutions Molar Solutions Preparation and Methods of Standardization 0.1 N Ammonia, (3.505 g of NH4OH per litre) 0.1 N Ammonium Thiocyanate, (7.612 g of NH4SCN per litre) 0.01 M Barium Chloride 0.1 N Bromine, (7.990 g of Br per litre) 0.1 N Ceric Sulfate, (33.22 g of Ce(SO4)2 per litre) 0.01 N Ceric Sulfate, for Tocopherol Assay (3.322 g of Ce(SO4)2 per litre) 0.05 M Disodium Ethylenediaminetetraacetate (EDTA), (16.811 g of C10H14O8N2Na2 per litre) 0.1 N Ferrous Ammonium Sulfate, (28.405 g of FeSO4(NH4)2SO4 per litre) 10 N Hydrochloric Acid 6 N Hydrochloric Acid 2 N Hydrochloric Acid
1 N Hydrochloric Acid, (36.461 g of HC1 per litre) 0.5 N Hydrochloric Acid 0.1 N Hydrochloric Acid 0.02 N Hydrochloric Acid 0.01 N Hydrochloric Acid 0.002 N Hydrochloric Acid 0.001 N Hydrochloric Acid 0.5 N Hydroxylamine Hydrochloride, (34.745 g of NH2OHHCl per litre) 0.1 N Iodine, (12.690 g of iodine per litre) 0.1 N Lithium Methoxide, (3.797 g of CH3OLi per litre) 0.1 N Magnesium Chloride, (4.761 g of MgC12 per litre) 0.1 M Mercuric Nitrate, (32.46 g of Hg(NO3)2 per litre) 0.1 N Oxalic Acid, (4.502 g of H2C2O4 per litre) 0.1 N Perchloric Acid, (10.046 g of HClO4 per litre) 0.1 N Potassium Acid Phthalate, (20.42 of KHC6H4(COO)2 per litre) 0.1 N Potassium Bromate, (2.784 g of KBrO3 per litre) 0.1 N Potassium Dichromate, (4.903 g of K2Cr2O7 per litre) 0.5 N Potassium Hydroxide, Ethanolic 1 N Potassium Hydroxide, (56.109 g of KOH per litre) 0.5 N Potassium Hydroxide 0.1 N Potassium Hydroxide 0.05 M Potassium Iodate, (10.70 g of KIO3 per litre) 0.1 N Potassium Permanganate, (3.161 g of KMnO4 per litre) 0.01 M Potassium Sulfate, (1.743 g of K2SO4 per litre) 0.1 N Silver Nitrate, (16.99 g of AgNO3 per litre) 0.05 N Sodium Arsenite, (3.248 g of NaAsO2 per litre) 0.1 N Sodium Chloride, (5.844 g of NaCl per litre) 1 N Sodium Hydroxide, (39.997 g of NaOH per litre) 0.5 N Sodium Hydroxide 0.2 N Sodium Hydroxide 0.1 N Sodium Hydroxide 0.05 N Sodium Hydroxide 0.02 N Sodium Hydroxide 0.01 N Sodium Hydroxide 0.1 N Sodium Methoxide, in Pyridine, (5.40 g of CH3ONa per litre) 0.1 M Sodium Nitrite, (7.900 g of NaNO2 per litre) 0.1 N Sodium Thiosulfate, (15.82 g of Na2S2O3 per litre) 0.01 N Sodium Thiosulfate 4 N Sulfuric Acid 1 N Sulfuric Acid, (49.039 g of H2SO4 per litre) 0.5 N Sulfuric Acid 0.2 N Sulfuric Acid 0.1 N Sulfuric Acid 0.02 N Sulfuric Acid 0.01 N Sulfuric Acid 0.5 N Sulfuric Acid, Ethanolic 0.1 M Thorium Nitrate, (48.01 g of Th(NO3)4 per litre) 0.1 N Titanous Chloride, (15.426 g of TiC13 per litre) 0.5 N Triethanolamine, (74 g of N(CH2CH2OH)3 per litre) 0.01 M Zinc Acetate, (1.835 g of Zn(CH3COO)2 per litre) 0.025 M Zinc Chloride, (3.407 g of ZnC12 per litre) 0.05 M Zinc Sulfate, (8.072 g of ZnSO4 per litre)
Molar Solutions
A molar solution contains 1 g molecular weight of the solute per litre of solution. The molarities of such solutions are designated as 1 M; 0.1 M; 0.05 M; etc.
0.01 N Ceric Sulfate, for Tocopherol Assay (3.322 g of Ce(SO4)2 per litre)
Dissolve 4.2 g of ceric sulfate, Ce(SO4)24H2O, or 5.5 g of the acid sulfate Ce(HSO4)4, in about 500 ml of water containing 28 ml of sulfuric acid, and dilute to 1,000 ml. Allow the solution to stand overnight, and filter. Standardize this solution daily as follows: weigh accurately about 275 mg of hydroquinone, C6H6O2, dissolve it in sufficient 0.5 N ethanolic sulfuric acid to make 500
ml, and mix. To 25 ml of this solution add 75 ml of 0.5 N sulfuric acid, 20 ml of water, and 2 drops of diphenylamine TS. Titrate with the ceric sulfate solution at a rate of about 25 drops per 10 sec until the red point is reached which persists for 10 sec. Perform a blank determination using 100 ml of 0.5 N ethanolic sulfuric acid, 20 ml of water, and 2 drops of diphenylamine TS, and make any necessary correction. Calculate the normality of the ceric sulfate solution by the formula 0.05W/55.057V, in which W is the weight, in mg, of the hydroquinone sample taken, and V is the volume, in ml, of the ceric sulfate solution consumed in the titration.
10 N Hydrochloric Acid
Prepare and standardize, as directed under 1 N hydrochloric acid, using 950 ml of hydrochloric acid.
6 N Hydrochloric Acid
Prepare and standardize, as directed under 1 N hydrochloric acid, using 570 ml of hydrochloric acid.
2 N Hydrochloric Acid
Prepare and standardize, as directed under 1 N hydrochloric acid, using 190 ml of hydrochloric acid.
permanent, pale pink colour is produced. Calculate the normality. Store this solution in a tightly stoppered bottle protected from light.
acidified with nitric acid. Dry the precipitate at 110 to constant weight. Each 14.332 mg of silver chloride obtained is equivalent to 1 ml of 0.1 N silver nitrate. Protect the silver chloride from light as much as possible during the determination.
hydroxide. Standardize and store, as directed under 1 N sodium hydroxide. Restandardize frequently.
starch iodide paste TS. When the titration is complete, the endpoint should be reproducible after the mixture has been standing for 1 min. Calculate the molarity. Each 17.22 mg of sulfanilamide is equivalent to 1 ml of 0.1 M sodium nitrite.
4 N Sulfuric Acid
This solution contains 196.155 g of H2SO4 per 1,000 ml. Using 120 ml of sulfuric acid, prepare and standardize, as directed under 1 N sulfuric acid.
XV. ANNEXES o ANNEX 1 - BERTRAND TABLE o ANNEX 2 - REPORT AND OTHER DOCUMENTS RESULTING FROM PREVIOUS SESSIONS OF THE JOINT FAO/WHO EXPERT COMMITTEE ON FOOD ADDITIVES
XV. ANNEXES
ANNEX 1 - BERTRAND TABLE Bertrand Table (1)
Weight of Sugars (mg) Weight of Copper equivalent to Sugars (mg) Invert Sugar Dextrose Galactose Maltose Lactose 10 11 12 13 20.6 22.6 24.6 26.5 20.4 22.4 24.3 26.3 19.3 21.2 23.0 24.9 11.2 12.3 13.4 14.5 14.4 15.8 17.2 18.6
14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53
28.5 30.5 32.5 34.5 36.4 38.4 40.4 42.3 44.2 46.1 48.0 49.8 51.7 53.6 55.5 57.4 59.3 61.1 63.0 64.8 66.7 68.5 70.3 72.2 74.0 75.9 77.7 79.5 81.2 83.0 84.8 86.5 88.3 90.1 91.9 93.6 95.4 97.1 98.8 100.6
28.3 30.2 32.2 34.2 36.2 38.1 40.1 42.0 43.9 45.8 47.7 49.6 51.5 53.4 55.3 57.2 59.1 60.9 62.8 64.6 66.5 68.3 70.1 72.0 73.8 75.7 77.5 79.3 81.1 82.9 84.7 86.4 88.2 90.0 91.8 93.6 95.4 97.1 98.9 100.6
26.7 28.6 30.5 32.2 34.2 36.0 37.9 39.7 41.6 43.4 45.2 47.0 48.9 50.7 52.5 54.4 56.2 58.0 59.7 61.5 63.3 65.0 66.8 68.6 70.4 72.1 73.9 75.6 77.4 79.1 80.8 82.5 84.3 86.0 87.7 89.5 91.2 92.9 94.6 96.3
15.6 16.7 17.8 18.9 20.0 21.1 22.2 23.3 24.4 25.5 26.6 27.7 28.9 30.0 31.1 32.2 33.3 34.4 35.5 36.5 37.6 38.7 39.8 40.9 41.9 43.0 44.1 45.2 46.3 47.4 48.5 49.5 50.6 51.7 52.8 53.9 55.0 56.1 57.1 58.2
20.0 21.4 22.8 24.2 25.6 27.0 28.4 29.8 31.1 32.5 33.9 35.2 36.6 38.0 39.4 40.7 42.1 43.4 44.8 46.1 47.4 48.7 50.1 51.4 52.7 54.1 55.4 56.7 58.0 59.3 60.6 61.9 63.3 64.6 65.9 67.2 68.5 69.8 71.1 72.4
54 55
102.2 104.0
102.3 104.1
98.0 99.7
59.3 60.3
73.7 74.9
90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100
161.1 162.6 164.2 165.7 167.3 168.8 170.3 171.9 173.4 175.0 176.5
162.0 163.6 165.2 166.7 168.3 169.9 171.5 173.1 174.6 176.2 177.8
157.6 159.2 160.8 162.4 164.0 165.6 167.2 168.8 170.4 172.0 173.6
98.0 99.0 100.1 101.1 102.2 103.2 104.2 105.3 106.3 107.4 108.4
119.1 120.3 121.6 122.8 124.0 125.2 126.5 127.7 128.9 130.2 131.4
ANNEX 2 - REPORT AND OTHER DOCUMENTS RESULTING FROM PREVIOUS SESSIONS OF THE JOINT FAO/WHO EXPERT COMMITTEE ON FOOD ADDITIVES
Documents marked with an "x" may be obtained on request from: Division of Environmental Health, World Health Organization, 1211 Geneva 27, Switzerland, or from Food Quality and Standards Service, Food and Agriculture Organization of the United Nations, 00100 Rome, Italy. 1. General principles governing the use of food additives (First report of the Expert Committee). FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 15, 1957; WHO Technical Report Series, No. 129, 1957 (out of print). 2. Procedures for the testing of intentional food additives to establish their safety for use (Second report of the Expert Committee). FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 17, 1958; WHO Technical Report Series, No. 144, 1958 (out of print). 3. Specifications for identity and purity of food additives (anti-microbial preservatives and antioxidants) (Third report of the Expert Committee). These specifications were subsequently revised and published as Specifications for identity and purity of food additives, vol. I. Antimicrobial preservatives and antioxidants, Rome, Food and Agriculture Organization of the United Nations, 1962 (out of print). 4. Specifications for identity and purity of food additives (food colours) (Fourth report of the Expert Committee). These specifications were subsequently revised and published as Specifications for identity and purity of food additives, vol. II. Food colours, Rome, Food and Agriculture Organization of the United Nations, 1963 (out of print). 5. Evaluation of the carcinogenic hazards of food additives (Fifth report of the Expert Committee). FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 29, 1961; WHO Technical Report Series, No. 220, 1961 (out of print). 6. Evaluation of the toxicity of a number of antimicrobials and antioxidants (Sixth report of the Expert Committee). FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 31, 1962; WHO Technical Report Series, No. 228, 1962.
7. Specifications for the identity and purity of food additives and their toxicological evaluation: emulsifiers, stabilizers, bleaching and maturing agents (Seventh report of the Expert Committee). FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 25, 1964; WHO Technical Report Series, No. 281, 1964 (out of print). 8. Specifications for the identity and purity of food additives and their toxicological evaluation: food colours and some antimicrobials and antioxidants (Eighth report of the Expert Committee). FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 38, 1965; WHO Technical Report Series, No. 309, 1965 (out of print). 9.x Specifications for identity and purity and toxicological evaluation of some antimicrobials and antioxidants. FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 38A, 1965; WHO/Food Add/24.65. 10.x Specifications for identity and purity and toxicological evaluation of food colours. FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 38B, 1966; WHO/Food Add/66.25. 11. Specifications for the identity and purity of food additives and their toxicological evaluation: some antimicrobials, antioxidants, emulsifiers, stabilizers, flour-treatment agents, acids and bases (Ninth report of the Expert Committee). FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 40, 1966; WHO Technical Report Series, No. 339, 1966. 12. Specifications for the identity and purity of food additives and their toxicological evaluation: some emulsifiers and stabilizers and certain other substances (Tenth report of the Expert Committee). FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 43, 1967; WHO Technical Report Series, No. 373, 1967. 13.x Toxicological evaluation of some antimicrobials, antioxidants, emulsifiers, stabilizers, flour-treatment agents, acids, and bases. FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 40A, B, C; WHO/Food Add/67.29. 14. Specifications for the identity and purity of food additives and their toxicological evaluation: some flavouring substances and non-nutritive sweetening agents (Eleventh report of the Expert Committee). FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 44, 1968; WHO Technical Report Series, No. 383, 1968. 15.x Toxicological evaluation of some flavouring substances and non-nutritive sweetening agents. FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 44A, 1968; WHO/Food Add/68.33. 16.x Specifications and criteria for identity and purity of some flavouring substances and non-nutritive sweetening agents. FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 44B, 1969; WHO/Food Add/69.31. 17. Specifications for the identity and purity of food additives and their toxicological evaluation: some antibiotics (Twelfth report of the Expert Committee). FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 45, 1969; WHO Technical Report Series, No. 430, 1969. 18.x Specifications for the identity and purity of some antibiotics. FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 45A, 1969; WHO/Food Add/69.34. 19. Specifications for the identity and purity of food additives and their toxicological evaluation: some food colours, emulsifiers, stabilizers, anticaking agents and certain
other substances (Thirteenth report of the Expert Committee). FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 46, 1970; WHO Technical Report Series, No. 445, 1970. 20.x Toxicological evaluation of some food colours, emulsifiers, stabilizers, anticaking agents and certain other substances. FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 46A; WHO/Food Add/70.36. 21.x Specifications for the identity and purity of some food colours, emulsifiers, stabilizers, anticaking agents, and certain other food additives. FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 46B; WHO/Food Add/70.37. 22. Evaluation of food additives: specifications for the identity and purity of food additives and their toxicological evaluation: some extraction solvents and certain other substances; and a review of the technological efficacy of some antimicrobial agents (Fourteenth report of the Expert Committee). FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 48, 1971; WHO Technical Report Series, No. 462, 1971. 23.x Toxicological evaluation of some extraction solvents and certain other substances. FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 48A, 1971; WHO/Food Add/70.39. 24.x Specifications for the identity and purity of some extraction solvents and certain other substances. FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 48B, 1971; WHO/Food Add/70.40. 25.x A review of the technological efficacy of some antimicrobial agents. FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 48C, 1971; WHO/Food Add/70.41. 26. Evaluation of food additivies: some enzymes, modified starches, and certain other substances: toxicological evaluations and specifications and a review of the technological efficacy of some antioxidants (Fifteenth report of the Expert Committee). FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 50, 1972; WHO Technical Report Series, No. 488, 1972. 27. Toxicological evaluation of some enzymes, modified starches, and certain other substances. FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 50A, 1972; WHO Food Additives Series, No. 1, 1972. 28. Specifications for the identity and purity of some enzymes and certain other substances. FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 50B, 1972; WHO Food Additives Series, No. 2; 1972. 29. A review of the technological efficacy of some antioxidants and synergists. FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 50C, 1972; WHO Food Additives Series, No. 3, 1972. 30. Evaluation of certain food additives and the contaminants mercury, lead, and cadmium (Sixteenth report of the Expert Committee). FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 51, 1972; WHO Technical Report Series, No. 505, 1972, and corrigendum. 31. Evaluation of mercury, lead, cadmium and the food additives amaranth, diethylpyrocarbonate, and octyl gallate. FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 51A, 1972. WHO Food Additives Series, No. 4, 1972.
32. Toxicological evaluation of certain food additives with a review of general principles and of specifications (Seventeenth report of the Expert Committee). FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 53, 1974; WHO Technical Report Series, No. 539, 1974, and corrigendum. 33. Toxicological evaluation of certain food additives including anticaking agents, antimicrobials, antioxidants, emulsifiers, and thickening agents. FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 53A, 1974; WHO Food Additives Series, No. 5, 1974. 34. Evaluation of certain food additives (Eighteenth report of the Expert Committee). FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 54, 1974; WHO Technical Report Series, No. 557, 1974, and corrigendum. 35.x Toxicological evaluation of some food colours, enzymes, flavour enhancers, thickening agents, and certain other food additives. FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 54A, 1975; WHO Food Additives Series, No. 6, 1975. 36.x Specifications for the identity and purity of some food colours, flavour enhancers, thickening agents, and certain food additives. FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 54B, 1975; WHO Food Additives Series, No. 7, 1975. 37.x Evaluation of certain food additives: some food colours, thickening agents, smoke condensates, and certain other substances (Nineteenth report of the Expert Committee). FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 55, 1975; WHO Technical Report Series, No. 576, 1975. 38.x Toxicological evaluation of some food colours, thickening agents and certain other substances. FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 55A, 1975; WHO Food Additives Series, No. 8, 1975. 39.x Specifications for the identity and purity of certain food additives. FAO Nutrition Meetings Report Series, No. 55B, 1976; WHO Food Additives Series, No. 9, 1976. 40.x Evaluation of certain food additives (Twentieth report of the Expert Committee). FAO Food and Nutrition Series, No. 1, 1976; WHO Technical Report Series, No. 599, 1976. 41.x Toxicological evaluation of certain food additives. FAO Food and Nutrition Series, No. 1A, 1976; WHO Food Additives Series, No. 10, 1976. 42.x Specifications for the identity and purity of certain food additives. FAO Food and Nutrition Series, No. 1B, 1977; WHO Food Additives Series, No. 11, 1977. 43.x Evaluation of certain food additives (Twenty-first report of the Joint FAO/WHO Expert Committee on Food Additives). WHO Technical Report Series, No. 617, 1978. 44.x Summary of Toxicological data of certain food additives. WHO Food Additives Series No. 12, 1977. 45.x Specifications for identity and purity of some food additives, including antioxidants, food colours, thickeners, and others. FAO Nutrition Meeting Report Series, No. 57, 1977.
46.x Specifications for identity and purity of thickening agents, anticaking agents, antimicrobials, antioxidants and emulsifiers. FAO Food and Nutrition Paper, No. 4, 1978. 47.x Evaluation of certain food additives (Twenty-second report of the Joint FAO/WHO Expert Committee on Food Additives). WHO Technical Report Series, No. 631, 1978. 48.x Summary of toxicological data of certain food additives and contaminants. WHO Food Additives Series, No. 13, 1978. 49.x Specifications for the identity and purity of certain food additives. FAO Food and Nutrition Paper, No. 7, 1978. 50.x Evaluation of certain food additives (Twenty-third report of the Joint FAO/WHO Expert Committee on Food Additives). WHO Technical Report Series, No. 648, 1980. 51.x Toxicological evaluation of certain food additives. WHO Food Additives Series, No. 14, 1979. 52.x Specifications for identity and purity of food colours, flavouring agents, and other food additives. FAO Food and Nutrition Paper, No. 12, 1979. 53.x Evaluation of certain food additives (Twenty-fourth report of the Joint FAO/WHO Expert Committee on Food Additives). WHO Technical Report Series, No. 653, 1980. 54.x Toxicological evaluation of certain food additives. WHO Food Additives Series No. 15, 1981. 55.x Specifications for identity and purity of food additives (sweetening agents, emulsifying agents, and other food additives). FAO Food and Nutrition Paper, No. 17, 1980. 56.x Evaluation of certain food additives (Twenty-fifth report of the Joint FAO/WHO Expert Committee on Food Additives). WHO Technical Report Series, No. 669, 1981. 57.x Toxicological evaluation of certain food additives. WHO Food Additives Series, No. 16, 1982. 58.x Specifications for identity and purity of certain food additives (carrier solvents, emulsifiers and stabilizers, enzyme preparations, flavouring agents, food colours, sweetening agents, and other food additives). FAO Food and Nutrition Paper, No. 19, 1981. 59.x Evaluation of certain food additives and contaminants (Twenty-sixth report of the Joint FAO/WHO Expert Committee on Food Additives). WHO Technical Report Series, No. 683, 1982. 60.x Toxicological evaluation of certain food additives. WHO Food Additives Series, No. 17, 1983. 61.x Specifications for identity and purity of certain food additives (buffering agents, emulsifiers, thickening agents, stabilizers, flavouring agents, food colours, sweetening
agents, and miscellaneous food additives). FAO Food and Nutrition Paper, No. 25, 1982. 62.x Evaluation of certain food additives and contaminants (Twenty-seventh report of the Joint FAO/WHO Expert Committee on Food Additives). WHO Technical Report Series, No. 696, 1983. 63.x Toxicological evaluation of certain food additives. WHO Food Additives Series, No. 18, 1983. 64.x Specifications for identity and purity of certain food additives (buffering agents, salts, emulsifiers, stabilizers, thickening agents, extraction solvents, flavouring agents, sweetening agents, and miscellaneous food additives). FAO Food and Nutrition Paper, No. 28, 1983. 65. Evaluation of certain food additives and contaminants (Twenty-eighth report of the Joint FAO/WHO Expert Committee on Food Additives). WHO Technical Report Series, No. 710, 1984, and corrigendum. 66. Toxicological evaluation of certain food additives and contaminants. WHO Food Additives Series, No. 19, 1984. 67. Specifications for the identity and purity of food colours. FAO Food and Nutrition Paper, No. 31/1, 1984. 68. Specifications for the identity and purity of food additives. FAO Food and Nutrition Paper, No. 31/2, 1984. 69. Evaluation of certain food additives and contaminants (Twenty-ninth report of the Joint FAO/WHO Expert Committee on Food Additives). WHO Technical Report Series, No. 733, 1986, and corrigendum. 70. Specifications for the identity and purity of certain food additives. FAO Food and Nutrition Paper, No. 34, 1986. 71. Toxicological evaluation of certain food additives and contaminants. Cambridge, Cambridge University Press, 1987 (WHO Food Additives Series, No. 20). 72. Evaluation of certain food additives and contaminants (Thirtieth report of the Joint FAO/WHO Expert Committee on Food Additives). WHO Technical Report Series, No. 751, 1987. 73. Toxicological evaluation of certain food additives and contaminants. Cambridge, Cambridge University Press, 1987 (WHO Food Additives Series, No. 21). 74. Specifications for the identity and purity of certain food additives. FAO Food and Nutrition Paper, No. 37, 1986. 75. Principles for the safety assessment of food additives and contaminants in food. Geneva, World Health Organization, 1987 (WHO Environmental Health Criteria, No. 70).
76. Evaluation of certain food additives and contaminants (Thirty-first report of the Joint FAO/WHO Expert Committee on Food Additives). WHO Technical Report Series, No. 759, 1987, and corrigendum. 77. Toxicological evaluation of certain food additives. Cambridge, Cambridge University Press, 1988 (WHO Food Additives Series, No. 22). 78. Specifications for the identity and purity of certain food additives. FAO Food and Nutrition Paper, No. 38, 1988. 79. Evaluation of certain food additives and contaminants (Thirty-third report of the Joint FAO/WHO Expert Committee on Food Additives). WHO Technical Report Series, No. 776, 1989. 80. Toxicological evaluation of certain food additives and contaminants. Cambridge, Cambridge University Press, 1989 (WHO Food Additives Series, No. 24). 81. Evaluation of certain food additives and contaminants (Thirty-sixth report of the Joint FAO/WHO Expert Committee on Food Additives). WHO Technical Report Series, No. 799, 1990. 82. Evaluation of certain food additives and contaminants (Thirty-seventh Report of the Joint FAO/WHO Expert Committee on Food Additives). WHO Technical Report Series, No. 806, 1991. 83. Specifications for the identity and purity of certain food additives. FAO Food and Nutrition Paper, No. 49, 1990. 84. Toxicological evaluation of certain food additives and contaminants. Cambridge, Cambridge University Press, 1990 (WHO Food Additives Series, No. 26).